Siemens Power Engineering Guide
Siemens Power Engineering Guide
Siemens Power Engineering Guide
4th Edition
Power Engineering Guide
Transmission and Distribution
Distributed by:
Siemens Aktiengesellschaft
Power Transmission and Distribution Group
International Business Development,
Dept. EV IBD
This Power Engineering Guide is de- Siemens AG is one of the world’s Siemens Power Transmission and
vised as an aid to electrical engineers leading international electrical and Distribution Group offers intelligent so-
who are engaged in the planning and electronics companies. lutions for the transmission and distri-
specifying of electrical power genera- With 416 000 employees in more than bution of power from generating plants
tion, transmission, distribution, control, 190 countries worldwide, the company to customers. The Group is a product
and utilization systems. Care has been is divided into various Groups. supplier, systems integrator and service
taken to include the most important One of them is Power Transmission and provider, and specializes
application, performance, physical and Distribution. in the following systems and services:
shipping data of the equipment listed in ■ High-voltage systems
the guide which is needed to perform The Power Transmission and
■ Medium-voltage systems
preliminary layout and engineering Distribution Group of Siemens with
tasks for industrial and utility-type 24 700 employees around the world ■ Metering
installations. plans, develops, designs, manufactures ■ Secondary systems
and markets products, systems and
The equipment listed in this guide is ■ Power systems control and
complete turn-key electrical infrastruc-
designed, rated, manufactured and energy management
ture installations.
tested in accordance with the Interna- ■ Power transformers
tional Electrotechnical Commission The group owns a growing number
of engineering and manufacturing ■ Distribution transformers
(IEC) recommendations.
However, a number of standardized facilities in more than 100 countries ■ System planning
equipment items in this guide are de- throughout the world. All plants are, ■ Decentralized power supply systems.
signed to take other national standards or are in the process of being certified
Siemens’ service includes the setting
into account besides the above codes, to ISO 9000/9001 practices. This is of
up of complete turnkey installations,
and can be rated and tested to ANSI/ significant benefit for our customers.
offers advice, planning, operation and
NEMA, BS, CSA, etc. On top of that, we Our local manufacturing capability
training and provides expertise and
manufacture a comprehensive range of makes us strong in global sourcing,
commitment as the complexity of this
transmission and distribution equipment since we manufacture products to IEC
task requires.
specifically to ANSI/NEMA codes and as well as ANSI/NEMA standards in
regulations. plants at various locations around the Backed by the experience of worldwide
world. projects, Siemens can always offer its
Two thirds of our product range is customers the optimum cost-effective
less than five years old. For our cus- Siemens Power Transmission and
concept individually tailored to their
tomers this means energy efficiency, Distribution Group (EV) is capable of
needs.
environmental compatibility, reliability providing everything you would expect
and reduced life cycle cost. from an electrical engineering company We are there – wherever and when-
with a global reach. ever you need us – to help you build
For details, please see the individual plants better, cheaper and faster.
product listings or inquire. The Power Transmission and Distribu-
tion Group is prepared and competent,
Whenever you need additional infor-
to perform all tasks and activities in-
mation to select suitable products from
volving transmission and distribution
this guide, or when questions about
of electrical energy.
their application arise, simply call your
local Siemens office.
Siemens Aktiengesellschaft
Power Transmission and Distribution
Certified quality
Siemens Quality Management and Environ-
mental Management System gives our
customers confidence in the quality of
Siemens products and services.
Certified to be in compliance with
DIN EN ISO 9001 and DIN EN ISO 1400,
it is the registered proof of our reliabilty.
General Introduction
Energy Needs Intelligent Solutions
High Voltage 2
Medium Voltage 3
Low Voltage 4
Transformers 5
Metering 8
Services 9
System Planning 10
Long-distance DC transmission
Wind energy
Power plants
Solar energy Converter station Pumping station
Energy store
Fig. 8: The mega-cities of the 21st century and the open countryside will need different solutions – very high values of connection density in the former and decentralised
configurations in the latter
This has been achieved by laying the tubu- ers are demanding a more reasonable re- nies and independent operating utilities will
lar conductor using methods similar to those turn on their investment. Deregulation gen- no longer confine their activities to just en-
employed with pipelines. Savings were erally means privatization; profit orientation ergy production; they will be expected to
also made by simplifying and standardizing is therefore clearly going to take over from become increasingly involved in energy dis-
the individual components and by using a concern with cost. In addition this means tribution too.
gas mixture consisting of sulfur hexafluo- that competition will inevitably produce
ride (SF6) and nitrogen (N2). some concessions in the price of electrici- Potential for the future
The advantages of this new technology ty, which will increase the pressure on en- The ongoing development of high-temper-
are low resistive and capacitive losses. The ergy suppliers. Many power supply compa- ature superconductors will doubtless ena-
electric field outside of the enclosure is zero, nies are striving to introduce additional ble much to be achieved. Major operational
and the magnetic field is negligibly small. energy services, thereby making the pure innovations will, nonetheless, come from
No cooling and no phase angle compensa- price of energy not the only yardstick their the more pervasive use of communications
tion are required. GILs are not a fire hazard customers apply when deciding how to and data systems – two areas of technolo-
and are simple to repair. make their purchases. gy where innovations can be seen every
18 months. Consequently, it will be from
Energy trade these areas that the enabling impetus for
The new “rules of the game” that are being Siemens – the energy systems house significant advances in power engineering
introduced in power supply business eve- Siemens is offering solutions to the prob- will come.
rywhere are demanding more capability lems that are governed by the new “rules
from utility IT systems, especially in areas of the game”. The company possesses con-
such as energy trading. Siemens has been siderable expertise, mainly because it is a
in the fortunate position of being able to global player, but also because it covers the
accumulate early practical experience in total spectrum of products necessary for the
this field in markets where deregulation is efficient transmission and distribution of
being introduced very quickly – such as the electricity. As with other Groups within the
United Kingdom, Scandinavia and the USA company, Power Transmission and Distribu-
– and so is now able to offer sophisticated tion no longer regards itself as simply a pur-
systems and expertise with which utilities veyor of hardware. In future Siemens will
can get to grips with the demands of the be more of a provider of services and total
new commercial environment. solutions. This will mean embracing many
In the past it was always security of supply new disciplines and skills, not least finan-
that took the highest priority for a utility. cial control and complete project manage-
Now, however, although it remains an im- ment. One of the reasons is that in future
portant subject, more and more sharehold- “BOT” (Build, Operate & Transfer) compa-
Contents Page
Introduction ...................................... 2/2
Air-Insulated
Outdoor Substations ....................... 2/4
Circuit-Breakers
General ............................................. 2/10
Circuit-Breakers
72 kV up to 245 kV .......................... 2/12
Circuit-Breakers
245 kV up to 800 kV ........................ 2/14
Live-Tank Circuit-Breakers .......... 2/16
Dead-Tank Circuit-Breakers ........ 2/20
Surge Arresters .............................. 2/24
Gas-Insulated Switchgear
for Substations
Introduction ..................................... 2/28
Main Product Range ..................... 2/29
Special Arrangements .................. 2/33
Specification Guide ....................... 2/34
Scope of Supply ............................. 2/37
Gas-insulated
Transmission Lines (GIL) .............. 2/38
Overhead Power Lines ................. 2/40
High-Voltage Direct
Current Transmission .................... 2/49
Power Compensation in
Transmission Systems .................. 2/52
2
High-Voltage Switchgear for Substations
Introduction
1
High-voltage substations form an important
link in the power transmission chain be-
tween generation source and consumer.
Two basic designs are possible:
2
Air-insulated outdoor switchgear
of open design (AIS)
AIS are favorably priced high-voltage sub-
stations for rated voltages up to 800 kV
3 which are popular wherever space restric-
tions and environmental circumstances do
not have to be considered. The individual
electrical and mechanical components of
an AIS installation are assembled on site.
Air-insulated outdoor substations of open
4 design are not completely safe to touch
and are directly exposed to the effects of
weather and the environment (Fig. 1). Fig. 1: Outdoor switchgear
10
2/2 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
High-Voltage Switchgear for Substations
Turnkey Installations
High-voltage switchgear is normally com-
bined with transformers and other equip- 1
ment to complete transformer substations
in order to Major com- Structural
■ Step-up from generator voltage level ponents, Steelwork
to high-voltage system (MV/HV) e.g. trans- Gantries and
■ Transform voltage levels within the former substructures 2
high-voltage grid system(HV/HV) Substation
■ Step-down to medium-voltage level Control Civil
of distribution system (HV/MV) Control and Engineering
The High Voltage Division plans and con- monitoring, Buildings,
structs individual high-voltage switchgear measurement, roads, 3
installations or complete transformer sub- protection, etc. foundations
Design
stations, comprising high-voltage switch- Fire
gear, medium-voltage switchgear, major AC/DC es protection
ri
components such as transformers, and auxililia Env
iron
all ancillary equipment such as auxiliaries,
rge s Ancillary pro menta 4
control systems, protective equipment, Su erter equipment
tec
tion l
etc., on a turnkey basis or even as general div g Li
in gh
les
contractor. rth e m tn
Carrier- ent
ables
ab
in
Ve
a
l and
E st g
The spectrum of installations supplied equipm
rc
sy
n ti
we
lat
signal c
Contro
frequ. 5
ion
busbar to regional transformer substations
Po
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 2/3
Design of Air-Insulated Outdoor Substations
2/4 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Design of Air-Insulated Outdoor Substations
–0.6
7
–0.8 – Q0 – Q0
–1.0 M – Q1 – Q1 M
– T5 – T5
–1.2 8
– T1 – T1
–1.4
– T1 – T1
M M
–1.6
– Q1 M – Q10 – Q11 M – Q1
9
–1.8
– Q0 – Q0
Horizontal
–2.0 displacement in m
– F1 – F1
–2.2
–1.4 –1.0 –0.6 –0.2 0 0.2 0.6 1.0 1.4 10
= T1 = T1
Fig. 4: FEM calculation of deflection of wire conductors in the event of short circuit Fig. 5: Module plan view
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 2/5
Design of Air-Insulated Outdoor Substations
Withdrawable circuit-breaker without disconnectors). The isolating dis- tance. An electromechanical motive unit
tance is reached with the moving of the ensures the uninterrupted constant moving
General
1 circuit-breaker along the rails, similar to the motion to both end positions. The circuit-
For 123/145 kV substations with single well-known withdrawable-unit design tech- breaker can only be operated if one of the
busbar system a suitable alternative is the nique of medium-voltage switchgear. In end positions has been reached. Move-
withdrawable circuit-breaker. In this kind of disconnected position busbar, circuit-break- ment with switched-on circuit-breaker is
switchgear busbar- and outgoing discon- er and outgoing circuit are separated from impossible. Incorrect movement, which
nector become inapplicable (switchgear each other by a good visible isolating dis- would be equivalent to operating a discon-
2 nector under load, is interlocked. In the
6300 event of possible malfunction of the posi-
2500 2500
tion switch, or of interruptions to travel
17001700
between disconnected position and operat-
ing position, the operation of the circuit-
3 breaker is stopped.
7600 The space required for the switchgear is
2247 reduced considerably. Due to the arrange-
ment of the instrument transformers on
-Q11 -T1/ 1050
-Q12 -Q9 -T5 -Q0 the common steel frame a reduction in the
-Q11-Q12 =T1 -F1 -Q0 -T1 required space up to about 45% in compar-
4 2530 3000 2530 3100 625 7000 625 3100 ison to the conventional switchgear sec-
7000 6400 7000 2500 4500 14450 tion is achieved.
21450
Description
A common steel frame forms the base for
all components necessary for reliable oper-
5 ation. The withdrawable circuit-breaker
contains:
■ Circuit-breaker type 3AP1F
■ Electromechanical motive unit
■ Measuring transformer for protection
6 and measuring purposes
■ Local control cubicle
All systems are preassembled as far as
possible. Therefore the withdrawable CB
can be installed quite easily and efficiently
7 on site.
The advantages at a glance
■ Complete system and therefore lower
Fig. 6a: H arrangement with withdrawable circuit-breaker, plan view and sections costs for coordination and adaptation.
■ A reduction in required space by about
8 45% compared with conventional
switchbays
■ Clear wiring and cabling arrangement
■ Clear circuit state
■ Use as an indoor switchbay is also pos-
9 sible.
Technical data
Fig. 6b: H arrangement with withdrawable circuit-breaker, ISO view Fig. 7: Technical data
2/6 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Design of Air-Insulated Outdoor Substations
7500 11500
7
8000
8
9500
19000 3000
A 9
A
9500
8000 10
7500 11500
19000
Fig. 8: Plan view and side view of H arrangement with modular switchbays
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 2/7
Design of Air-Insulated Outdoor Substations
8
Fig.11: Central tower design
Top view
5000
18000 4000
4000
5000
Fig. 12: Busbar area with pantograph disconnector of diagonal design, rated voltage 420 kV
2/8 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Design of Air-Insulated Outdoor Substations
10
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 2/9
Circuit-Breakers for 72 kV up to 800 kV
General
Circuit-breaker for air-insulated switchgear
1
Circuit-breakers are the main module of
both AIS and GIS switchgear. They have to
meet high requirements in terms of:
■ Reliable opening and closing
2 ■ Consistent quenching performance with
rated and short-circuit currents even
after many switching operations
■ High-performance, reliable maintenance-
free operating mechanisms.
Technology reflecting the latest state of
3 the art and years of operating experience
are put to use in constant further develop-
ment and optimization of Siemens circuit-
breakers. This makes Siemens circuit-
breakers able to meet all the demands
4 placed on high-voltage switchgear.
The comprehensive quality system,
ISO 9001 certified, covers development,
manufacture, sales, installation and after-
sales service. Test laboratories are accred-
ited to EN 45001 and PEHLA/STL.
5
Main construction elements
Each circuit-breaker bay for gas-insulated
6 switchgear includes the full complement
of isolator switches, grounding switches Control Interrupter
Operating
(regular or proven), instrument transform- elements unit
mechanism
ers, control and protection equipment, in-
terlocking and monitoring facilities com-
monly used for this type of installation
7 (See chapter GIS, page 2/30 and following).
Circuit-breakers for air-insulated switch-
gear are individual components and are
assembled together with all individual
electrical and mechanical components of
8 an AIS installation on site.
All Siemens circuit-breaker types, whether
air or gas-insulated, are made up of the
same range of components, i.e.:
■ Interrupter unit
9 ■ Operating mechanism
■ Sealing system
■ Operating rod
■ Control elements.
10
2/10 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Circuit-Breakers for 72 kV up to 800 kV
The twin-nozzle system has also proven Specific use of the electrohydraulic
Interrupter unit – itself in special applications. Its specific mechanism
two arc-quenching principles properties support switching without re-
The actuating energy required for the 3AQ
1
striking of small inductive and capacitive
currents. By virtue of its high arc resist- and 3AT high-voltage circuit-breakers at
The Siemens product range includes high- ance, the twin-nozzle system is particularly higher voltage levels is provided by proven
voltage circuit-breakers with self-compres- suitable for breaking certain types of short electrohydraulic mechanisms. The inter-
sion interrupter chambers and twin-nozzle circuit (e.g. short circuits close to genera- rupter chambers of these switching devic-
interrupter chambers – for optimum tor terminals) on account of its high arc re- es are based on the graphite twin-nozzle 2
switching performance under every operat- sistance. system.
ing condition for every voltage level.
Advantages of the electrohydraulic
Self-compression breakers Operating mechanism – mechanism at a glance:
3AP high-voltage circuit-breakers for the two principles for all ■ Electrohydraulic mechanisms provide the 3
lower voltage range ensure optimum use specific requirements high actuating energy that makes it pos-
of the thermal energy of the arc in the sible to have reliable control even over
contact tube. This is achieved by the self- very high switching capacities and to be
compression switching unit. The operating mechanism is a central mod- in full command of very high loads in the
Siemens patented this arc-quenching prin- ule of the high-voltage circuit-breakers. shortest switching time.
ciple in 1973. Since then, we have contin- Two different mechanism types are availa- 4
■ The switch positions are held safely
ued to develop the technology of the self- ble for Siemens circuit-breakers: even in the event of an auxiliary power
compression interrupter chamber. One of ■ Stored-energy spring actuated failure.
the technical innovations is that the arc en- mechanism, ■ A number of autoreclosing operations
ergy is being increasingly used to quench ■ Electrohydraulic mechanism, are possible without the need for
the arc. In short-circuit breaking operations
depending on the area of application and recharging. 5
the actuating energy required is reduced to
voltage level, thus every time ensuring the ■ Energy reserves can be reliably con-
that needed for mechanical contact move-
best system of actuation. The advantages trolled at any time.
ment. That means the operating energy is
are trouble-free, economical and reliable ■ Electrohydraulic mechanisms are mainte-
truly minimized. The result is that the self-
circuit-breaker operation for all specific re- nance-free, economical and have a long
compression interrupter chamber allows
the use of a compact stored-energy spring
quirements. service life. 6
mechanism with unrestrictedly high de- ■ They satisfy the most stringent require-
pendability. Specific use of the stored-energy ments regarding environmental safety.
spring mechanism This has been proven by electrohydraulic
mechanisms in Siemens high-voltage
Twin-nozzle breakers The actuation concept of the 3AP high-volt- circuit-breakers over many years of serv-
On the 3AQ and 3AT switching devices, a
age circuit-breaker is based on the stored- ice. 7
energy spring principle. The use of such an
contact system with graphite twin-nozzles
operating mechanism in the lower voltage
ensures consistent arc-quenching behavior
range became appropriate as a result of
and constant electric strength, irrespective
development of a self-compression inter-
of pre-stressing, i.e. the number of breaks
rupter chamber that requires only minimal
and the switched current. The graphite
actuation energy. 8
twin-nozzles are resistant to burning and
thus have a very long service life. As a
consequence, the interrupter unit of the Advantages of the stored-energy spring
twin-nozzle breaker is particularly mechanism at a glance:
powerful.
Moreover, this type of interrupter chamber
■ The stored-energy spring mechanism of- 9
fers the highest degree of operational
offers other essential advantages. General- safety. It is of simple and sturdy design
ly, twin-nozzle interrupter chambers oper- – with few moving parts. Due to the
ate with low overpressures during arc- self-compression principle of the inter-
quenching. Minimal actuating energy is rupter chamber, only low actuating forc-
adequate in this operating system as well. es are required. 10
The resulting arc plasma has a compara- ■ Stored-energy spring mechanisms are
tively low conductivity, and the switching readily available and have a long service
capacity is additionally favourably influ- life: Minimal stressing of the latch mech-
enced as a result. anisms and rolling-contact bearings in
the operating mechanism ensure reliable
and wear-free transmission of forces.
■ Stored-energy spring mechanisms are
maintenance-free: the spring charging
gear is fitted with wear-free spur gears,
enabling load-free decoupling.
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 2/11
Circuit-Breakers for 72 kV up to 245 kV
Siemens circuit-breakers for the lower Breaking operating currents Major features:
voltage levels 72 kV up to 245 kV, whether
During the opening process, the main con- ■ Self-compression interrupter chamber
1 for air-insulated or gas-insulated switch-
tact (4) opens first and the current commu- ■ Use of the thermal energy of the arc
gear, are equipped with self-compression
tates on the still closed arcing contact. If ■ Minimized energy consumption
switching units and spring-stored energy
this contact is subsequently opened, an
operating mechanisms. ■ High reliability for a long time
arc is drawn between the contacts (5). At
the same time, the contact cylinder (6)
2 moves into the base (7) and compresses
the quenching gas there. The gas then
The interrupter unit flows in the reverse direction through the
contact cylinder (6) towards the arcing con-
Self-compression system tact (5) and quenches the arc there.
1 Terminal plate
1 2 Contact support
2 3 Nozzle
7
4 Main contact
3
5 Arc contact
4
6 Contact
5 cylinder
8 7 Base
6 8 Terminal plate
9
7
8
10
2/12 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Circuit-Breakers for 72 kV up to 245 kV
Fig. 16
10
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 2/13
Circuit-Breakers for 245 kV up to 800 kV
1
1 Upper terminal
8 plate
2 2 Fixed tubes
3 Moving contact
3
tube
6 Arc 4 Blast cylinder
9
5 Blast piston
4
6 Arc-quenching
5 nozzles
7 Lower terminal
10 2 plate
8 8 Operating rod
2/14 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Circuit-Breakers for 245 kV up to 800 kV
Auxiliary
switch Pilot control
Releases On Off
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 2/15
Live-Tank Circuit-Breakers for 72 kV up to 800 kV
Circuit-breakers
1 for air-insulated switchgear
Standard live-tank breakers
The construction
2 All live-tank circuit-breakers are of the
same general design, as shown in the illus-
trations. They consist of the following main
components:
1) Interrupter unit
2) Closing resistor (if applicable)
3 3) Operating mechanism
4) Insulator column (AIS)
5) Operating rod
6) Breaker base
4 7) Control unit
The uncomplicated design of the breakers
and the use of many similar components,
such as interrupter units, operating rods
and control cabinets, ensure high reliability Fig. 22: 145 kV circuit-breaker 3AP1FG with triple-pole Fig. 23: 800 kV circuit-breaker 3AT5
because the experience of many breakers spring stored-energy operating mechanism
5 in service has been applied in improvement
of the design. The twin nozzle interrupter
unit for example has proven its reliability in
more than 60,000 units all over the world.
The control unit includes all necessary
6 devices for circuit-breaker control and mon-
itoring, such as:
■ Pressure/SF6 density monitors
■ Gauges for SF6 and hydraulic pressure
(if applicable)
7 ■ Relays for alarms and lockout
■ Antipumping devices
■ Operation counters (upon request)
■ Local breaker control (upon request)
■ Anticondensation heaters.
8
Transport, installation and commissioning
are performed with expertise and effi-
ciency.
The tested circuit-breaker is shipped in
9 the form of a small number of compact
units. If desired, Siemens can provide
appropriately qualified personnel for instal-
lation and commissioning.
10
2/16 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Live-Tank Circuit-Breakers for 72 kV up to 800 kV
1 2 7 3 5 6
1 2 2
8
5
1 Interrupter unit
3
2 Closing resistor 9
3 Valve unit
4 Electrohydraulic
operating 13
mechanism 12 4
5 Insulator columns
6 Breaker base 10
7 Control unit 11
4
3 5
4
1 Interrupter unit
7 2 Arc-quenching nozzles
3 Moving contact 6
6 4 Filter
5 Blast piston
Fig. 25: Type 3AT4/5
6 Blast cylinder
7 Bell-crank mechanism
8 Insulator column
9 Operating rod
7
10 Hydraulic operating mechanism
1 11 ON/OFF indicator
12 Oil tank
13 Control unit
8
Fig. 27: Type 3AQ2
9
2
10
3
5 1 Interrupter unit
2 Post insulator
4 3 Circuit-breaker base
4 Operating mechanism
and control cubicle
5 Pillar
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 2/17
Live-Tank Circuit-Breakers for 72 kV up to 800 kV
Technical data
1
Rated voltage [kV] 72.5 123 145 170 245/300 362 420
Number of interrupter units per pole 1 1 1 1 1 2 2
5 Rated power-frequency withstand [kV] 140 230 275 325 460 520 610
voltage 1 min.
Rated lightning impulse withstand [kV] 325 550 650 750 1050 1175 1425
voltage 1.2 / 50 µs
Rated switching impulse [kV] – – – – –/850 950 1050
6 withstand voltage
Rated current up to [A] 4000 4000 4000 4000 4000 4000 4000
Rated short-time current (3 s) up to [kA] 40 40 40 40/50 50 63 63
Rated peak withstand current up to [kA] 108 108 108 135 135 170 170
7 Rated short-circuit-breaking [kA] 40 40 40 40/50 50 63 63
current up to
Rated short-circuit making [kA] 108 108 108 135 135 170 170
current up to
Rated duty cycle O - 0.3 s - CO - 3 min - CO or CO - 15 s - CO
8 Break time [cycles] 3 3 3 3 3 3 3
Frequency [Hz] 50/60 50/60 50/60 50/60 50/60 50/60 50/60
Operating mechanism type Spring-stored energy mechanism/Electrohydraulic mechanism
Control voltage [V, DC] 60…250
9 Motor voltage [V, DC] 60…250
[V, DC] 120…240, 50/60 Hz
Design data of the basic version:
Clearance Phase/earth [mm] 700 1250 1250 1500 2200 2750 3400
in air across the contact gap [mm] 1200 1200 1200 1400 1900/2200 2700 3200
10 Minimum creepage Phase/earth [mm] 2248 3625 3625 4250 6150/7626 7875 10375
distance across the contact gap [mm] 3625 3625 3625 4250 6125/7500 9050 10500
Dimensions
Height [mm] 2750 3300 3300 4030 5220/5520 4150 4800
Width [mm] 3200 3900 3900 4200 6600/7000 8800 9400
Depth [mm] 660 660 660 660 800 3500 4100
Distance between pole centers [mm] 1350 1700 1700 1850 2800/3000 3800 4100
Weight of circuit-breaker [kg] 1350 1500 1500 1600 3000 4700 5000
Inspection after 25 years
Fig. 28a
2/18 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Live-Tank Circuit-Breakers for 72 kV up to 800 kV
3AT2/3AT3* 3AT4/3AT5* 4
O - 0.3 s - CO - 3 min - CO or CO - 15 s - CO
2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 8
50/60 50/60 50/60 50/60 50/60 50/60 50/60 50/60 50/60
Electrohydraulic mechanism
48…250
48…250 or 9
208/120…500/289 50/60 Hz
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 2/19
Dead-Tank Circuit-Breakers for 72 kV up to 245 kV
Circuit-breakers
1 in dead-tank design
For certain substation designs, dead-tank
circuit-breakers might be required instead
of the standard live-tank breakers. For
these purposes Siemens can offer the
2 dead-tank circuit breaker types.
Individual service
2/20 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Dead-Tank Circuit-Breakers for 72 kV up to 245 kV
Subtransmission breaker Operating mechanism Included in the control cabinet are neces-
sary auxiliary switches, cutoff switch, latch
Type SPS-2 and 3AP1-DT The type FA2/4 mechanically and electrical-
ly trip-free spring mechanism is used on check switch, alarm switch and operation 1
counter. The control relays and three con-
type SPS-2 breakers. The type FA2/4 clos-
Type SPS-2 power circuit-breakers trol knife switches (one each for the con-
ing and opening springs hold a charge for
(Fig. 29a/b) are designed as general, defi- trol, heater and motor) are mounted on a
storing ”open-close-open“ operations
nite-purpose breakers for use at maximum control panel. Terminal blocks on the side
A weatherproof control cabinet has a large and rear of the housing are available for
rated voltages of 72.5 and 245 kV. door, sealed with rubber gaskets, for easy control and transformer wiring. 2
access during inspection and maintenance.
Condensation is prevented by units offer- For non US markets the control cabinet is
The construction also available similar to the 3AP cabinet
ing continuous inside/outside temperature
The type SPS-2 breaker consists of three differential and by ventilation. (3AP1-DT).
identical pole units mounted on a common
support frame. The opening and closing 3
force of the FA2/4 spring operating mecha-
nism is transferred to the moving contacts
of the interrupter through a system of con-
necting rods and a rotating seal at the side
of each phase.
4
The tanks and the porcelain bushings Technical data
are charged with SF6 gas at a nominal
pressure of 6.0 bar. The SF6 serves as both
insulation and arc-quenching medium.
A control cabinet mounted at one end
of the breaker houses the spring operating 5
mechanism and breaker control compo-
nents.
Interrupters are located in the aluminum
housings of each pole unit. The interrupt-
ers use the latest Siemens puffer arc- 6
quenching system.
The spring operating mechanism is the
same design as used with the Siemens
3AP breakers. This design has been in ser-
vice for years, and has a well documented 7
reliability record.
Customers can specify up to four (in some
cases, up to six) bushing-type current Type SPS-2/3AP1-DT
transformers (CT) per phase. These CTs,
mounted externally on the aluminum hous-
ings, can be removed without disturbing
Rated voltage [kV] 38 48.3 72.5 121 145 169 242 8
the bushings. Rated power-frequency [kV] 80 105 160 260 310 365 425
withstand voltage
Rated lighting impulse [kV] 200 250 350 550 650 750 900/1050
withstand voltage
9
Rated switching impulse [kV] – – – – – – –/850
withstand voltage
Rated nominal current up to [A] 4000 4000 4000 4000 4000 4000 4000
Rated breaking current up to [kA] 40 40 40 63 63 63 63 10
Operating mechanism type Spring-stored-energy mechanism
Fig. 30
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 2/21
Dead-Tank Circuit-Breakers for 550 kV
6 Interrupter unit
The 3AT2/3-DT pole consists of two break-
ing units in series impressive in the sheer
simplicity of their design. The proven Siemens
contact system with double graphite noz-
zles assures faultless operation, consist-
7 ently high arc-quenching capacity and a
long operating life, even at high switching
frequencies. Thanks to constant further de-
velopment, optimization and consistent
quality assurance, Siemens arc-quencing
8 systems meet all the requirements placed
on modern high-voltage technology. Type 3AT 2/3-DT
Fig. 31
2/22 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Dead-Tank Circuit-Breakers for 550 kV
Fig. 32: The 3AT2/3-DT circuit-breaker with SIMOTEC composite insulator bushings
10
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 2/23
Surge Arresters
2
9
10 1
20 °C
Fig. 34: Measurement of residual voltage on
115 °C porcelain-housed (foreground) and polymer-housed
(background) arresters
150 °C
0
10-4 10-3 10-2 10-1 1 10 102 103 104
Current through arrester Ia [A]
2/24 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Surge Arresters
Fig. 35 shows the sectional view of such The polymer-housed high-voltage arrest- be limited more effectively. Secondly, com-
an arrester. The housing consists of a fiber- er design chosen by Siemens and the high- pared with the outdoor type, inductance of
glass-reinforced plastic tube with insulating quality materials used by Siemens provide the installation is lower (both that of the 1
sheds made of silicon rubber. The advan- a whole series of advantages including connecting conductors and that of the ar-
tages of this design which has the same long life and suitability for outdoor use, rester itself). This means that the protec-
pressure relief device as an arrester with high mechanical stability and ease of dis- tion offered by GIS arresters is much better
porcelain housing are absolutely safe and posal. than by any other method, especially in the
reliable pressure relief characteristics, high Another important design shown in Fig. 36 case of surges with a very steep rate of
mechanical strength even after pressure are the gas-insulated metal-enclosed surge rise or high frequency, to which gas-insu- 2
relief and excellent pollution-resistant prop- arresters (GIS arresters) which have been lated switchgear is exceptionally sensitive.
erties. The very good mechanical features made by Siemens for more then 25 years. Please find an overview of the complete
mean that Siemens arresters with polymer There are two reasons why, when GIS ar- range of Siemens arresters in Figs. 37 and 38,
housing (type 3EQ/R) can serve as post resters are used with gas-insulated switch- pages 26 and 27.
insulators as well. The pollution-resistant gear, they usually offer a higher protective 3
properties are the result of the water-repel- safety margin than when outdoor-type ar-
lent effect (hydrophobicity) of the silicon resters are used (see also IEC 60099-5,
rubber, which even transfers its effects to For further information please contact:
1996-02, Section 4.3.2.2.): Firstly, they can
pollution. be installed closer to the item to be pro- Fax: ++ 49 - 3 03 86 -2 67 21
tected so that traveling wave effects can e-mail: [email protected]
4
SF6-SF6 bushing
(SF6 -Oil bushing on request) 5
Flange with gas diverter nozzle
Access cover with
Seal pressure relief
device and filter
10
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 2/25
Low-Voltage and Medium-Voltage Arresters
and Limiters (230/400 V to 52 kV)
Applications Low- Motors, DC sys- Gene- Distri- Distri- Distri- Distri- AC and DC
voltage dry-type tems (loco- rators, bution bution bution bution locomotives,
over- transformers, motives, motors, systems systems systems systems overhead
head airfield light- overhead melting metal- and and and contact lines
3 line sys- ing systems, contact furnaces, enclosed medium- medium- medium-
tems sheath voltage lines) 6-arrester gas-in- voltage voltage voltage
limiters, connec- sulated switch- switch- switch-
protection tions, switch- gear gear gear
of converters power gear
for drives plants with
4 plug-in
connec-
tion
2/26 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
High-Voltage Arresters
(72.5 to 800 kV)
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 2/27
Gas-Insulated Switchgear for Substations
Introduction Protection of the environment Each circuit-breaker bay includes the full
complement of disconnecting and ground-
1 The necessity to protect the environment ing switches (regular or make-proof),
Common characteristic features of often makes it difficult to erect outdoor instrument transformers, control and pro-
switchgear installation switchgear of conventional design, where- tection equipment, interlocking and moni-
as buildings containing compact SF6-insu- toring facilities commonly used for this
Because of its small size and outstanding lated switchgear can almost always be
compatibility with the environment, SF6 - type of installation (Fig. 39).
designed so that they blend well with the
2 insulated switchgear (GIS) is gaining con- surroundings. Beside the conventional circuit-breaker
stantly on other types. Siemens has been bay, other arrangements can be supplied
a leader in this sector from the very start. SF6-insulated metal-enclosed switchgear such as single-bus, ring cable with load-break
is, due to the modular system, very flexible switches and circuit-breakers, single-bus
The concept of SF6 - insulated metal-en- and can meet all requirements of configu-
closed high-voltage switchgear has proved arrangement with bypass-bus, coupler and
ration given by network design and operat- bay for triplicate bus. Combined circuit-
itself in more than 70,000 bay operating ing conditions.
3 years in over 6,000 installations in all parts breaker and load-break switch feeder, ring
of the world. It offers the following out- cable with load-break switches, etc. are
standing advantages. furthermore available for the 145 kV level.
Full protection
against contact with live parts
7 The all-round metal enclosure affords
maximum safety for personnel under
all operating and fault conditions.
2/28 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Gas-Insulated Switchgear for Substations
Main product range of GIS This objective is attained only by incorpo- Minimal-weight construction
rating all processes in the quality manage- through the use of aluminum alloy and the
for substations ment system, which has been introduced 1
exploitation of innovations in development
and certified according to DIN EN ISO such as computer-aided design tools.
SF6 switchgear up to 550 kV 9001 (EN 29001).
(the total product range covers GIS from Siemens GIS switchgear meets all Safe encapsulation
66 up to 800 kV rated voltage): Fig. 40. the performance, quality and reliability means an outstanding level of safety
The development of the switchgear is demands such as: based on new manufacturing methods 2
always based on an overall production con- and optimized shape of enclosures.
Compact space-saving design
cept, which assures the achievement of Environmental compatibility
the high technical standards required means uncomplicated foundations, a wide
of the HV switchgear whilst providing the range of options in the utilization of space, means no restrictions on choice of location
maximum customer benefit. less space taken up by the switchgear. through minimal space requirement, ex-
tremely low noise emission and effective 3
gas sealing system (leakage < 1% per year
per gas compartment).
Economical transport
5170 means simplified and fast transport and
reduced costs because of maximum possi-
4
ble size of shipping units.
3470
4480
2850
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 2/29
Gas-Insulated Switchgear for Substations
SF6-insulated switchgear
up to 145 kV, type 8DN8 1 7 2 8 6
1 Gas-tight bushing
Gas-permeable bushing
Three-phase enclosures are used for type
8DN8 switchgear in order to achieve ex-
tremely low component dimensions. The
2 low bay weight ensures minimal floorload-
ing and eliminates the need for complex
foundations. Its compact dimensions and
low weight enable it to be installed almost 10
anywhere. This means that capital costs can
be reduced by using smaller buildings, or
3 by making use of existing ones, for instance
when medium voltage switchgear
is replaced by 145 kV GIS. 5
The bay ist based on a circuit-breaker
mounted on a supporting frame (Fig. 41). 4
A special multifunctional cross-coupling
4 module combines the functions of the dis-
connector and earthing switch in a three-
position switching device. It can be used as
■ an active busbar with integrated discon-
nector and work-in-progress earthing 9
5 switch (Fig. 41/Pos. 3 and 4),
3
■ outgoing feeder module with integrated
disconnector and work-in-progress earth-
ing switch (Fig. 41/Pos. 5),
■ busbar sectionalizer with busbar earthing.
6 For cable termination, a cable termination
module can be equipped with either con-
ventional sealing ends or the latest plug-in
connectors (Fig. 41/Pos. 9). Flexible single-
pole modules are used to connect overhead 1 Interrupter unit of the 5 Outgoing feeder module
lines and transformers by using a splitting circuit-breaker with disconnector and
7 module which links the 3-phase encapsulated 2 Spring-stored energy earthing switch
3 4
switchgear to the single pole connections. mechanism with circuit-breaker 6 Make-proof earthing switch
Thanks to the compact design, up to three control unit (high-speed) 1
completely assembled and works-tested 3 Busbar I with disconnector 7 Current transformer 7
bays can be shipped as one transport unit. and earthing system 5
8 Voltage transformer
Fast erection and commissioning on site 4 Busbar II with disconnector 8
8 ensure the highest possible quality.
9 Cable sealing end 6
and earthing system
10 Integrated local control cubicle 9
The feeder control and protection can be
located in a bay-integrated local control Fig. 41: Switchgear bay 8DN8 up to 145 kV
cubicle, mounted in the front of each bay
(Fig. 42). It goes without saying that we
9 supply our gas-insulated switchgear with all
types of currently available bay control sys-
tems – ranging from contactor circuit con-
trols to digital processor bus-capable bay
control systems, for example the modern
10 SICAM HV system based on serial bus
communication. This system offers
■ Online diagnosis and trend analysis ena-
bling early warning, fault recognition and
condition monitoring.
■ Individual parameterization, ensuring the
best possible incorporation of customized
control facilities.
■ Use of modern current and voltage sensors.
This results in a longer service life and lower
operating costs, in turn attaining a consider-
able reduction in life cycle costs.
Fig. 42: 8DN8 switchgear for rated voltage 145 kV Fig. 43
2/30 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Gas-Insulated Switchgear for Substations
SF6-insulated switchgear
Gas-tight bushing 7 3 10 9 12
up to 245 kV, type 8DN9 1
Gas-permeable bushing
The clear bay configuration of the light-
weight and compact 8DN9 switchgear is 14 4 6 5
evident at first sight. Control and monitoring
facilities are easily accessible in spite of 2
the compact design of the switchgear.
The horizontally arranged circuit-breaker
forms the basis of every bay configuration.
The operating mechanism is easily acces-
sible from the operator area. The other bay
modules – of single-phase encapsulated
3
design like the circuit-breaker module – are
located on top of the circuit-breaker. The
three-phase encapsulated passive busbar
is partitioned off from the active equipment.
Thanks to “single-function” assemblies 4
(assignment of just one task to each module)
and the versatile modular structure, even
unconventional arrangements can be set
up out of a pool of only 20 different modules.
The modules are connected to each other 5
by a standard interface which allows an
extensive range of bay structures. The
switchgear design with standardized mod-
ules and the scope of services mean that
all kinds of bay structures can be set up in 2 1 11 8 13
a minimal area. 6
The compact design permits the supply of 1 Circuit-breaker interrupter unit 8 Earthing switch
double bays fully assembled, tested in the 2 Spring-stored energy (work-in-progress)
factory and filled with SF6 gas at reduced mechanism with circuit-breaker 9 Outgoing-disconnector
pressure, which assures smooth and effi- 3 5
control unit 10 Make-proof earthing switch
cient installation and commissioning. 3 Busbar disconnector I (high-speed) 7 7
The following major feeder control level 4 Busbar I 11 Current transformer
functions are performed in the local control 1
5 Busbar disconnector II 12 Voltage transformer 11
cubicle for each bay, which is integrated in 8
the operating front of the 8DN9 switch-
6 Busbar II 13 Cable sealing end
7 Earthing switch 14 Integrated local control cubicle 9 12
gear:
(work-in-progress) 10 8
■ Fully interlocked local operation and 13
state-indication of all switching devices
managed reliably by the Siemens digital
switchgear interlock system Fig. 44: Switchgear bay 8DN9 up to 245 kV
■ Practical dialog between the digital feed-
er protection system and central proces- 9
sor of the feeder control system
■ Visual display of all signals required for
operation and monitoring, together with
measured values for current, voltage and
power 10
■ Protection of all auxiliary current and
voltage transformer circuits
■ Transmission of all feeder information to
the substation control and protection
system
Factory assembly and tests are significant
parts of the overall production concept
mentioned above. Two bays at a time un-
dergo mechanical and electrical testing
Fig. 45: 8DN9 switchgear for
with the aid of computer-controlled stands. rated voltage 245 kV
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 2/31
Gas-Insulated Switchgear for Substations
SF6-insulated switchgear
1 up to 550 kV, type 8DQ1 12 11 10 9 8 7 1 6
10
2/32 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Gas-Insulated Switchgear for Substations
8
Mobile containerized switchgear –
even for high voltage 9
4
At medium-voltage levels, mobile contain-
erized switchgear is the state of the art.
10
But even high-voltage switching stations
can be built in this way and economically
operated in many applications. 11
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 2/33
Gas-Insulated Switchgear for Substations
General
These specifications cover the technical
23.20 data applicable to metal-enclosed SF6 gas-
3 insulated switchgear for switching and
distribution of power in cable and/or over-
head line systems and at transformers.
Key technical data are contained in the
data sheet and the single-line diagram
attached to the inquiry.
4 A general “Single-line diagram” and a
Gas-insulated sketch showing the general arrangement
switchgear type of the substation and the transmission line
Grounding
8DN9 exist and shall form part of a proposal.
resistor
The switchgear quoted shall be complete
5 to form a functional, safe and reliable sys-
tem after installation, even if certain parts
15.95 required to this end are not specifically
called for.
13.8 kV
switchgear Applicable standards
6
Shunt All equipment shall be designed, built,
reactor tested and installed to the latest revisions
of the applicable IEC 60 standards (IEC
Publ. 60517 “High-voltage metal-enclosed
11.50 switchgear for rated voltages of 72.5 kV
7 and above”, IEC Publ. 60129 “Alternating
current disconnectors (isolators) and
grounding switches”, IEC Publ. 60056
Cable duct “High-voltage alternating-current circuit-
8.90 breakers”), and IEC Publ. 60044 for instru-
8 ment transformers.
2/34 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Gas-Insulated Switchgear for Substations
Work, material and design Each gas-filled compartment shall be The circuit breaker shall be designed to
equipped with static filters of a capacity withstand at least 18–20 operations
Aluminium or aluminium alloys shall be
used preferabely for the enclosures.
to absorb any water vapor penetrating into (depending on the voltage level) at full 1
the switchgear installation over a period short-circuit rating without the necessity
Maximum reliability through minimum of at least 25 years. to open the circuit-breaker for service or
amount of erection work on site is re- maintenance.
Long intervals between the necessary in-
quired. Subassemblies must be erected
spections shall keep the maintenance cost The maximum tolerance for phase dis-
and tested in the factory to the maximum
to a minimum. A minor inspection shall agreement shall be 3 ms, i.e. until the last 2
extent. The size of the subassemblies shall
only become necessary after ten years and pole has been closed or opened respec-
be limited only by the transport conditions.
a major inspection preferably after a period tively after the first.
The material and thickness of the enclo- exceeding 25 years of operation, unless A standard station battery required for
sure shall be selected to withstand an in- the permissible number of operations is control and tripping may also be used for
ternal arc and to prevent a burn-through or met at an earlier date. recharging the operating mechanism.
puncturing of the housing within the first
The energy storage system (hydraulic or
3
stage of protection, referred to a short-
circuit current of 40 kA. Arrangement and modules spring operating system) will hold suf-
Arrangement ficient energy for all standard IEC close-
Normally exterior surfaces of the switch-
open duty cycles.
gear shall not require painting. If done for The arrangement shall be single-phase or The control system shall provide alarm
aesthetic reasons, surfaces shall be appro- three-phase enclosed.
priately prepared before painting, i.e. all signals and internal interlocks, but inhibit 4
The assembly shall consist of completely tripping or closing of the circuit-breaker
enclosures are free of grease and blasted.
separate pressurized sections designed when there is insufficient energy capacity
Thereafter the housings shall be painted
to minimize the risk of damage to person- in the energy storage system, or the
with no particular thickness required but
nel or adjacent sections in the event of a SF6 density within the circuit-breaker has
to visually cover the surface for decorative
failure occurring within the equipment. dropped below a minimum permissible
reasons only. The interior color shall be
Rupture diaphragms shall be provided to level. 5
light (white or light grey).
prevent the enclosures from uncontrolled
All joints shall be machined and all cast- Disconnectors
bursting and suitable deflectors provide
ings spotfaced for bolt heads, nuts and protection for the operating personnel. All isolating switches shall be of the single-
washers. In order to achieve maximum operating break type. DC motor operation (110, 125,
Assemblies shall have reliable provisions reliability, no internal relief devices may 220 or 250 V), completely suitable for re-
to absorb thermal expansion and contrac- be installed because adjacent compart- mote operation, and a manual emergency 6
tions created by temperature cycling. For ments would be affected. drive mechanism is required.
this purpose metal bellows-type compen- Modular design, complete segregation, Each motor-drive shall be self-contained
sators shall be installed. They must be arc-proof bushings and “plug-in” connec- and equipped with auxiliary switches in
provided with adjustable tensioners. tion pieces shall allow ready removal of addition to the mechanical indicators.
All solid post insulators shall be provided any section and replacement with mini- Life lubrication of the bearings is required. 7
with ribs (skirts). mum disturbance of the remaining pres-
surized switchgear. Grounding switches
For supervision of the gas within the en- Work-in-progress grounding switches shall
closures, density monitors with electrical Busbars generally be provided on either side of the
contacts for at least two pressure levels All busbars shall be three-phase or single- circuit-breaker. Additional grounding switch-
shall be installed. The circuit-breakers, phase enclosed and be plug-connected es may be used for the grounding of bus 8
however, might be monitored by density from bay to bay. sections or other groups of the assembly.
gauges fitted in circuit-breaker control
Circuit-breakers DC motor operation (110, 125, 220 or
units.
The circuit-breaker shall be of the single 250 V), completely suitable for remote
The manufacturer assures that the pres- operation, and a manual emergency drive
sure loss within each individual gas com- pressure (puffer) type with one interrupter
partment – and not referred to the per phase*. Heaters for the SF6 gas are mechanism is required. 9
not permitted. Each motor drive shall be self-contained
total switchgear installation only – will be
The arc chambers and contacts of the and equipped with auxiliary position
not more than 1% per year per gas com-
circuit-breaker shall be freely accessible. switches in addition to the mechanical in-
partment.
The circuit-breaker shall be designed to dicators. Life lubrication of the bearings
is required.
minimize switching overvoltages and also 10
to be suitable for out-of-phase switching.
The specified arc interruption performance
must be consistent over the entire operat-
ing range, from line-charging currents to
full short-circuit currents.
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 2/35
Gas-Insulated Switchgear for Substations
Control
An electromechanical or solid-state inter-
locking control board shall be supplied as a
10 standard for each switchgear bay. This fail-
safe interlock system will positively pre-
vent maloperations. Mimic diagrams and
position indicators shall give clear demon-
stration of the operation to the operating
Fig. 53: Outdoor termination module – personnel.
High-voltage bushings are used for transition from Provisions for remote control shall be
SF6-to-air as insulating medium. The bushings can be supplied.
matched to the particular requirements with regard
to arcing and creepage distances. The connection
Fig. 51: Three phase cable termination module. with the switchgear is made by means of variable-
Example for plug-in type cables. design angular-type modules.
2/36 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Gas-Insulated Switchgear for Substations
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 2/37
Gas-Insulated Transmission Lines (GIL)
Siemens experience
7
Back in the 1960s with the introduction of
sulphur hexafluoride (SF6) as an insulating
and switching gas, the basis was found for
the development of gas-insulated switch-
gear (GIS).
8 On the basis of GIS experience, Siemens
developed SF6 gas-insulated lines to trans-
mit electrical energy too. In the early 1970s
initial projects were planned and imple-
mented. Such gas-insulated lines were Fig. 58: Long-term test set-up at the IPH, Berlin
9 usually used within substations as busbars
Reduction of SF6 content
or bus ducts to connect gas-insulated The characteristics of N2/SF6 gas mixtures
switchgear with overhead lines, the aim Several tests have been carried out in show that with an SF6 content of only
being to reduce clearances in comparison Siemens facilities as well as in other test 15–25% and a slightly higher pressure,
to air-insulated overhead lines. laboratories world-wide since many years. the insulating capability of pure SF6 can be
Implemented projects include GIL laying in attained. Besides, the arcing behavior is
Results of these investigations show that
10 tunnels, in sloping galleries, in vertical
the bulk of the insulating gas for industrial improved through this mixture. Tests have
shafts and in open air installation. proven that there would be no external
projects involving a considerable amount
Flanging as well as welding has been ap- damage or fire caused by an internal fail-
of gas should be nitrogen, a nontoxic nat-
plied as jointing technique. ure.
ural gas.
However, another insulating gas should be The technical data of the GIL are shown in
added to nitrogen in order to improve the Fig. 59.
insulating capability and to minimize size
and pressure. A N2/SF6 gas mixture with
high nitrogen content (and sulphur hexa-
fluoride portion as low as possible) was
finally chosen as insulating medium.
2/38 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Gas-Insulated Transmission Lines (GIL)
Technical data
1
Rated voltage up to 550 kV
Rated current lr 2000 – 4600 A
Transmission 1500 – 3000 MVA
capacity 2
Capacitance ≈ 60 nF/km
Typical length 1–100 km
Gas mixture SF6/N2 10%/90%
ranging from up to 35%/65% 3
D
Laying directly buried Fig. 60: GIL laying technique
in tunnels/ clean assembly and productivity is enhan- dures for power cables. The test proce-
sloping galleries/ ced by a high level of automation of the dure consisted of load cycles with doubled
voltage and increased current as well as
vertical shafts overall process.
frequently repeated high-voltage tests.
4
open air Anti-corrosion protection The assembly and repair procedures under
installation Directly buried gas-insulated transmission realistic site conditions were examined
lines will be safeguarded by a passive and too. The Siemens GIL is the first one in
Fig. 59: GIL technical data active corrosion protection system. The the world that has passed these tests,
passive corrosion protection system com- without any objection. Fig. 58 shows the 5
Jointing technique prises a PE or PP coating and assures at test setup arranged in a tunnel of 3 m di-
In order to improve the gas-tightness least 40 years of protection. The active cor- ameter, corresponding to the tunnel used
and to facilitate laying, flanges have been rosion protection system provides protec- in Berlin for installing a 420 kV transmis-
avoided as jointing technique. Instead, tion potential in relation to the aluminum sion link through the city.
welding has been chosen to join the vari- sheath. An important requirement taken
ous GIL construction units. into account is the situation of an earth
References 6
fault with a high current of up to 63 kA to Siemens has gathered experience with
The welding process is highly automated,
earth. gas-insulated transmission lines at rated
with the use of an orbital welding machine voltages of up to 550 kV and with system
to ensure high quality of the joints. This Testing lengths totalling more than 30 km.
orbital welding machine contributes to high
The GIL is already tested according to The first GIL stretch built by Siemens was 7
productivity in the welding process and
the report IEC 61640 (1998) “Rigid high- the connection of the turbine generator/
therefore speeds up laying. The reliability
voltage, gas-insulated transmission lines pumping motor of a pumped storage
of the welding process is controlled by an
for voltages of 72.5 kV and above.” station with the switchyard. The 420 kV
integrated computerized quality GIL is laid in a tunnel through a mountain
assurance system. Long-term performances and has a length of 4000 m (Fig. 57). This
Laying Besides nearly 25 years of field experience connection was commissioned in 1975 at 8
with GIL installations world wide, the long- the Wehr pumped storage station in the
The most recently developed Siemens term performance of the GIL for long-dis- Black Forest in Southern Germany.
GILs are scheduled for directly buried tance installations has been proven by the
laying. For further information please contact:
independent test laboratory IPH, Berlin,
The laying technique must be as compat- Fax: ++ 49-9131-7-3 44 98
ible as possible with the landscape and
Germany and the Berlin power utility 9
BEWAG according to long-term test proce- e-mail: [email protected]
must take account of the sequence of
seasons. The laying techniques for pipe-
lines have been improved over many years
and they are applicable for GIL as a ”pipe-
line for electrical current“too. However, 10
the GIL needs slightly different treatment
where the pipeline technique has to be
adapted.The laying process is illustrated
in Fig. 60.
The assembly area needs to be protected
against dust, particles, humidity and other
environmental factors that might disturb
the dielectric system. Clean assembly
therefore plays an important role in setting
up cross-country GILs under normal envi-
ronmental conditions. The combination of Fig. 61: Siemens lab prototype for dielectric tests
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 2/39
Overhead Power Lines
Introduction
1 2000
Since the very beginning of electric power,
overhead lines have constituted the most
important component for transmission and
distribution. Their portion of overall length MW Power per circuit
of electric circuits depends on the voltage
2 level as well as on local conditions and 1000
practice. In densely populated areas like
Central Europe, underground cables prevail
in the distribution sector and overhead
power lines in the high-voltage sector. In
other parts of the world, for example in 750 kV
3 North America, overhead lines are often
500
used also for distribution purposes within
cities. Siemens has planned, designed and
erected overhead power lines on all impor-
tant voltage levels in many parts of the
4 world.
200
Selection of line voltage 380 kV
2/40 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Overhead Power Lines
Selection of conductors
Rated voltage
and ground wires 1
[kV] 20 110 220 380 750
Conductors represent the most important
components of an overhead power line
Highest system voltage [kV] 24 123 245 420 800 since they have to ensure economical and
reliable transmission and contribute con- 2
siderably to the total line costs.
Nominal bundle bundle bundle bundle For many years aluminum and its alloys
cross-section [mm2] 50 120 150 300 435 2x240 4x240 2x560 4x560 have been the prevailing conducting mate-
rials for power lines due to the favorable
price, the low weight and the necessity of
Conductor diameter [mm] 9.6 15.5 17.1 24.5 28.8 2x21.9 4x21.9 2x32.2 4x32.2
certain minimum cross-sections. 3
The conductors are prone to corrosion.
Aluminum, in principle, is a very corrosive
Ampacity (at 80 °C con-
210 410 470 740 900 1290 2580 2080 4160 metal. However, a dense oxide layer is
ductor temperature) [A]
formed which stops further corrosive at-
tacks. Therefore, aluminum conductors 4
Thermal capacity [MVA] 7 14 90 140 340 490 1700 1370 5400 are well-suited also for corrosive areas, for
example a maritime climate.
For aluminum conductors there are a num-
Resistance at 20 °C [Ω/km] 0.59 0.24 0.19 0.10 0.067 0.059 0.030 0.026 0.013 ber of different designs in use. All-aluminum
conductors (AAC) have the highest conduc-
tivity for a given cross-section, however 5
Reactance at 50 Hz [Ω/km] 0.39 0.34 0.41 0.38 0.4 0.32 0.26 0.27 0.28 possess only a low mechanical strength,
which limits their application to short
spans and low tensile forces. To increase
Effective the mechanical strength, wires made of
capacitance [nF/km] 9.7 11.2 9.3 10 9.5 11.5 14.4 13.8 13.1 aluminum-magnesium-silicon alloys are 6
adopted, the strength of which is twice
that of pure aluminum.
Capacitance All-aluminum and aluminum alloy con-
to ground [nF/km] 3.4 3.6 4.0 4.2 4.8 6.3 6.5 6.4 6.1 ductors have shown susceptibility against
eolian vibrations. Compound conductors
Charging power [kVA/km] 1.2 1.4 35 38 145 175 650 625 2320
with a steel core, so-called aluminum 7
cables, steel reinforced (ACSR), avoid this
disadvantage. The ratio between aluminum
Ground-fault current [A/km] 0.04 0.04 0.25 0.25 0.58 0.76 1.35 1.32 2.48 and steel ranges from 4.3:1 to 11:1. Expe-
rience has demonstrated that ACSR has a
long life, too.
Surge impedance [Ω] 360 310 375 350 365 300 240 250 260 Conductors are selected according to elec-
8
trical, thermal, mechanical and economic
aspects. The electric resistance as a result
Surge of the conducting material and its cross-
impedance load [MVA] – – 32 35 135 160 600 577 2170 section is the most important feature
affecting the voltage drop and the energy 9
losses along the line and, therefore, the
Fig. 63: Electric characteristics of AC overhead power lines (Data refer to one circuit of a double-circuit line)
transmission costs. The cross-section has
to be selected such that the permissible
Overhead power lines with voltages high- The voltage level has to be selected based temperatures will not be exceeded during
er than 420 kV are needed to economically on the duty of the line within the network normal operation as well as under short
transmit bulk electric power over long dis- or on results of network planning. Siemens circuit. With increasing cross-section the 10
tances, a task typically arising when utiliz- has carried out such studies for utilities all line costs increase, while the costs for
ing hydro energy potentials far away from over the world. losses decrease. Depending on the duty
consumer centers. Fig. 62 depicts sche- of a line and its power, a cross-section can
matically the range of application for the be determined which results in lowest
individual voltage levels depending transmission costs. This cross-section
on the distance of transmission and the should be aimed for. The heat balance of
power rating. ohmic losses and solar radiation against
convection and radiation determines the
conductor temperature. A current density
of 0.5 to 1.0 A /mm2 has proven to be an
economical solution.
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 2/41
Overhead Power Lines
2/42 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Overhead Power Lines
Cross arm
1
Conductor
7
Fig. 66a: I-shaped suspension insulator set for 245 kV
Cross arm
8
10
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 2/43
Overhead Power Lines
2/44 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Overhead Power Lines
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 2/45
Overhead Power Lines
8
255.00
232.50
9 175.00 o. D. 286.50 276.50 273.50 280.00 283.00 275.50 270.50 270.00 265.00 263.
281.50 273.00 280.50 284.50 275.00 270.50 272.50 267.50 264.00
2/46 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Overhead Power Lines
1
3
T+8 Arable land Stream
f40=17.46
DH
fE =16.52 Meadow Road
Fallow land Forest
284.20 2
17.30 16.75
16.38 15.86 Ground wire: ACSR 265/35 * 80.00 N/mm2
Conductor: ACSR 265/35 * 80.00 N/mm2
Equivalent sag: 11.21 m at 40 °C
3
7.55 Equivalent span: 340.44 m
11.38 8.44
12.29
Bushes, height
263.00 up to 5 m
24.20 4
f40=5.56
fE =5.87
4
WA+0
DA
6
223.00
7
1.45
16.00
8
270.00
292.50
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 2/47
Overhead Power Lines
37.5
124 124
9
27.5
10
112 119 70 125 162.5
Dimensions in m
2/48 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
High-Voltage Direct Current Transmission
HVDC
1
When technical and/or economical feasibility
of conventional high voltage AC transmis-
sion technology reach their limits, high
voltage DC can offer the solution, namely
■ For economical transmission of bulk
power over long distances
2
■ For interconnection of asynchronous
power grids
■ For power transmission across the sea,
when a cable length is long
■ For interconnection of synchronous but 3
weak power grids, adding to their stability
■ For additional exchange of active power
with other grids without having to increase
the short-circuit power of the system
■ For increasing the transmission capacity 4
of existing rights-of-way by changing
from AC to DC transmission system
Siemens offers HVDC systems as Fig. 76: Earthquake-proof, fire-retardant thyristor valves in Sylmar East, Los Angeles
■ Back-to-Back (B/B) stations to interconnect
asynchronous networks, without any DC systems for all functions. 5
transmission line in between Redundant design for fault-tolerant
■ Power transmission via Dc submarine systems.
cables
Fig. 75: Long-distance transmission Filter technology
■ Power transmission via long-distance DC
overhead lines Single, double and triple-tuned as well
Special features as high-pass passive filters, or any combi- 6
nation thereof, can be installed.
Back-to-Back (B/B): Valve technology Active filters, mainly for the DC circuit,
To connect asynchronous high voltage ■ Simple, easy-to-maintain mechanical are available.
power systems or systems with different design Wherever possible, identical filters are
frequencies. selected so that the performance does not
To stabilize weak AC links or to supply
■ Use of fire-retardant, self-extinguish-
significantly change when one filter has 7
ing material
even more active power, where the AC to be switched off.
■ Minimized number of electrical
system reaches the limit of short-circuit Turnkey service
capability. connections
■ Minimized number of components Our experienced staff are prepared to de-
■ Avoidance of potential sources of sign, install and commission the whole
failure HVDC system on a turnkey basis. 8
■ ”Parallel“ cooling for the valve levels Project financing
■ Oxygen-saturated cooling water. We are in a position to assist our custom-
Fig. 73: Back-to-back link between asynchronous grids After more than 20 years of operation, thy- ers in finding proper project financing, too.
ristor valves based on this technology have
demonstrated their excellent reliability.
General services 9
Cable transmission (CT):
■ Extended support to customers from the
To transmit power across the sea with ■ The recent introduction of direct light-
very beginning of HVDC system plan-
cables to supply islands/offshore platforms triggered thyristors with integrated over-
ning including
from the mainland and vice-versa. voltage protection further simplifies the
valve and reduces maintenance require- – Feasibility studies
ments. – Drafting the specification 10
Control system – Project execution
– System operation and
In our HVDC control system, high-perform-
ance components with proven records in – Long-term maintenance
Fig. 74: Submarine cable transmission – Consultancy on upgrading/replace-
many other standard fields of application
have been integrated, thus adding to the ment of components/redesign of older
Long-distance transmission (LD): schemes, e.g. retrofit of mercury-arc
overall reliability of the system.
For transmission of bulk power over long Use of ”state-of-the-art“ microprocessor valves or relay-based controls
distances (beyond approx. 600 km, consid-
ered as the break-even distance).
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 2/49
High-Voltage Direct Current Transmission
Typical ratings
Some typical ratings for HVDC schemes
3 are given below for orientation purposes only:
B/B: 100 ... 600 MW
CT: 100 ... 800 MW
LD: 300 ... 3000 MW (bipolar),
whereby the lower rating is mainly deter-
4 mined by economic aspects and the higher
one limited by the constraints of the inter-
connected networks.
Innovations
5 In recent years, the following innovative
technologies and equipment have for ex-
ample been successfully implemented by Fig. 78: HVDC outdoor valves, 533 kV (Cahora Bassa Rehabilitation, Southern Africa)
Siemens in diverse HVDC projects world-
wide:
■ Direct light-triggered thyristors
Rehabilitation and
6 (already mentioned above) modernization of existing
■ Hybrid-optical DC measuring system
(Fig. 77)
HVDC stations (Fig. 78)
■ Active harmonic filters
■ Advanced eletrode line monitoring of The integration of state-of-the-art micro-
7 bipolar HVDC systems processor systems or thyristors allows the
■ An SF6 HVDC circuit-breaker for use as
owner better utilization of his investment,
Metallic Return Transfer Breaker, devel- e.g.
oped from a standard AC high-voltage ■ Higher availability
breaker. ■ Fewer outages
8 ■ Lower losses
■ Better performance values
■ Less maintenance.
Higher availability means more operating
2 hours, better utilization and higher profits
9 for the owner.
The new Human-Machine Interface (HMI)
system enhances the user-friendliness and
3
increases the reliability considerably due
to the operator guidance. This rules out
1 maloperation by the operator, because an
10 incorrect command will be ignored by the
HMI.
2/50 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
High-Voltage Direct Current Transmission
HMI GPS
6
LAN
7
VCS OLC OLC OLC VCS
SER
Pole 1 Pole 1 SC Pole 2 Pole 2
Communi-
8
CLC CLC cation link to
VBE VBE
HMI Human-machine Interface the load dis-
Pole 1 Pole 2 patch center
GPS Global Positioning System
OLC Open-Loop Control
CLC Closed-Loop Control
9
VBE Valve Base Electronics Communi- Communi-
VCS Valve Cooling Systems cation link to TFR DC Protection TFR cation link to
the remote the remote
SER Sequence of Event
station station
Recording
TFR Transient Fault Recording 10
LAN Local Area Network DC Yard
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 2/51
Power Compensation in Transmission Systems
Introduction
1
In many countries increasing power
consumption leads to growing and more
interconnected AC power systems. These
complex systems consist of all types of
electrical equipment, such as power plants,
2 transmission lines, switchgear transform-
ers, cables etc., and the consumers.
Since power is often generated in those
areas of a country with little demand, the
transmission and distribution system has
3 to provide the link between power gener-
ation and load centers.
Wherever power is to be transported, the
same basic requirements apply:
■ Power transmission must be economical
4 ■ The risk of power system failure must
be low
■ The quality of the power supply must
be high
However, transmission systems do not
5 behave in an ideal manner. The systems
react dynamically to changes in active and
reactive power, influencing the magnitude
and profile of the power systems voltage.
Fig. 80: STATCOM inverter hall
Examples:
6
■ A load rejection at the end of a long-dis- Further information please contact:
tance transmission line will cause high
Fax: ++ 49 - 9131- 73 45 54
overvoltages at the line end. However, a
high load flow across the same line will e-mail: [email protected]
decrease the voltage at its end.
7 ■ The transport of reactive power through
a grid system produces additional losses
and limits the transmission of active
power via overhead lines or cables.
■ Load-flow distribution on parallel lines is
8 often a problem. One line could be load-
ed up to its limit, while another only car-
ries half or less of the rated current.
Such operating conditions limit the actu-
al transmittable amount of active power.
■ In some systems load switching and/or
9 load rejection can lead to power swings
which, if not instantaneously damped,
can destabilize the complete grid system
and then result in a “Black Out”.
Reactive power compensation helps to
10 avoid these and some other problems.
In order to find the best solution for a grid
system problem, studies have to be car-
ried out simulating the behavior of the sys-
tem during normal and continuous operat-
ing conditions, and also for transient
events. Study facilities which cover digital
simulations via computer as well as analog
ones in a transient network analyzer labo-
ratory are available at Siemens.
2/52 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Power Compensation in Transmission Systems
Id
Iind Icap
UD
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 2/53
Power Compensation in Transmission Systems
7
Concept Operating diagram
Bypass switch
9 Capacitors Damping
circuit
10 Thyristor
valve
Thyristor controlled
reactor
Fig. 84: Thyristor controlled Series Compensation (TCSC). Example: Single line diagram TCSC S. da Mesa
2/54 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Power Compensation in Transmission Systems
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 2/55
Power Compensation in Transmission Systems
Parallel compensation
2
2 Shunt Little Voltage Little High Voltage stabilization
capacitor influence rise influence at high load
E U
3
3 Shunt Little Voltage Little Low Reactive power
reactor influence drop influence compensation at low
E U load; limitation of
temporary overvoltage
4
4 Static Little Controlled Little Limited by Reactive power and
VAr com- influence influence control voltage control,
pensator SVC damping of power
E U
5 (SVC) swings to improve
system stability
Series compensation
7
6 Series Increased Very good Much (Very) low Long transmission lines
capacitor smaller with high transmission
E U power rating
8
7 Series Reduced (Very) slight (Much) (Very) high Short lines, limitation
reactor larger of SC power
E U
9
8 Thyristor Variable Very good Much (Very) low Long transmission lines,
Controlled TCSC smaller power flow distribution
SeriesCom- between parallel lines
10 pensation
E U
and SSR damping
(TCSC)
2/56 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Medium-Voltage
Switchgear
Contents Page
Introduction ...................................... 3/2
Primary Distribution
Selection Criteria and
Explanations ...................................... 3/4
Selection Matrix ............................... 3/6
Air-Insulated Switchgear ............... 3/8
SF6-Insulated Switchgear ............ 3/24
Secondary Distribution
General ............................................. 3/46
Selection Matrix ............................. 3/48
Ring-Main Units ............................. 3/50
Consumer Substations .................. 3/60
Transformer Substations .............. 3/66
Medium-Voltage Devices
Product Range ................................ 3/72
Vacuum Circuit-Breakers
and Contactors ............................... 3/74
Vacuum Interrupters ..................... 3/85
Disconnectors/
Grounding Switches ...................... 3/86
HRC Fuses ....................................... 3/88
Insulators and Bushings .............. 3/89
Current Transformers/
Voltage Transformers .................... 3/90
Surge Arresters .............................. 3/90
3
Medium-Voltage Switchgear
Introduction ‘Primary distribution’ means the switch- ‘Secondary distribution’ is the local area
gear installation in the HV/MV transformer supply of the individual MV/LV substations
1 main substations. The capacity of equip- or consumer connecting stations.
Primary and secondary distribution stands ment must be sufficient to transport the The power capacity of MV/LV substa-
for the two basic functions of the medium- electrical energy from the HV/MV trans- tions depends on the requirements of the
voltage level in the distribution system. former input (up to 63 MVA) via busbar LV system. To reduce the network losses,
‘Power Supply Systems’ (PSS) includes the to the outgoing distribution lines or cable the transformer substations should be
equipment of the Primary and Secondary feeders. The switchgear in these main installed directly at the load centers with
2 Distribution, all interconnecting equipment substations is of high importance for the typical transformer ratings of 400 kVA to
(cables, transformers, control systems, safe and flexible operation of the distribu- max. 1000 kVA. Due to the great number
etc.) down to LV consumer distributions as tion system. It has to be very reliable dur- of stations, they must be space-saving and
well as all the relating planning, engineer- ing its lifetime, flexible in configuration, maintenance-free.
ing, project/site management, installation and easy to operate with a minimum of For high availability, MV/LV substations are
3 and commissioning work involved, includ- maintenance. mostly looped in by load-break switches.
ing turnkey projects with all necessary The type of switchgear insulation (air or The line configuration is mostly of the
electrical and civil works equipment (Fig. 1). SF6) is determined by local conditions, e.g. open-operated ring type or of radial strands
space available, economic considerations, with opposite switching station. In the
building costs, environmental conditions event of a line fault, the disturbed section
and the relative importance of mainte- will be switched free and the supply is
4 nance. continued by the second side of the line.
Design and configuration of the busbar This calls for reliable switchgear in the sub-
are determined by the requirements of the stations. Such transformer substations can
local distribution system. be prefabricated units or single compo-
nents, installed in any building or rooms
These are: existing on site, consisting of medium-volt-
5 ■ The number of feeders is given by the age switchgear, transformers and low-volt-
outgoing lines of the system age distri-bution.
■ The busbar configuration depends on Because of the extremely high number
the system (ring, feeder lines, opposite of units in the network, high standardiza-
station, etc.) tion of equipment is necessary. The most
6 ■ Mode of operation under normal condi- economical solution for such substations
tions and in case of faults should have climate-independent and
■ Reliability requirements of consumers, maintenance-free equipment, so that oper-
etc. ation of equipment does not require any
Double busbars with longitudinal sectional- maintenance during its lifetime.
7 izing give the best flexibility in operation. Consumers with high power requirements
However, for most of the operating situa- have mostly their own distribution system
tions, single busbars are sufficient if the on their building area. In this case, a con-
distribution system has adequate redun- sumer connection station with metering is
dancy (e.g. ring-type system). necessary. Depending on the downstream
If there are only a few feeder lines which consumer system, circuit breakers or load-
8 call for higher security, a mixed configura- break switches have to be installed.
tion is advisable. For such transformer substations nonex-
It is important to prepare enough spare tensible and extensible switchgear, for in-
feeders or at least space in order to extend stance RMUs, has been developed using
the switchgear in case of further develop- SF6 gas as insulation and arc-quenching
9 ment and the need for additional feeders. medium in the case of load-break systems
As these substations, especially in densely (RMUs), and SF6-gas insulation and vacu-
populated areas, have to be located right in um (for vcb feeders) as arc-quenching me-
the load center, the switchgear must be dium in the case of extensible modular
space-saving and easy to install. switchgear, consisting of load-break panels
The installation of this switchgear needs with or without fuses, circuit-breaker pan-
10 thorough planning in advance, including the els and measuring panels.
system configuration and future area de-
velopment. Especially where existing in-
stallations have to be upgraded, the situa-
tion of the distribution system should be
analyzed for simplification (system plan-
ning and architectural system design).
3/2 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Medium-Voltage Switchgear
2
HV/MV transformers up to 63 MVA
Primary distribution 3
MV up to 36 kV
Secondary distribution
open ring 7
closed ring
8
Diagram 1: Diagram 2: Diagram 3:
10
Fig. 1: Medium voltage up to 36 kV – Distribution system with two basic functions: Primary distribution and secondary distribution
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 3/3
Primary Distribution
Selection Criteria and Explanations
3/4 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Primary Distribution
Selection Criteria and Explanations
Enclosure, Compartmentalization
Single busbar Double busbar
IEC Publ. 60 298 subdivides metal-en-
closed switchgear and controlgear into !
Percentage (8BK20 = 100)
!
Percentage (8BK20 = 100)
1
three types:
160 160
■ Metal-clad switchgear and controlgear
■ Compartmented switchgear and con-
trolgear 130 130
■ Cubicle switchgear and controlgear. 2
120 8DA10 120
Thus “metal-clad” and “cubicle” are sub- 110
divisions of metal-enclosed switchgear, NX PLUS 110
100 100 8BK20
further describing construction details. 8BK20
90 90
In metal-clad switchgear the components NX AIR
80 80 8DB10
are arranged in 3 separate compartments: 70 8DC11 70 8DC11
3
■ Busbar compartment 0 0
■ Circuit-breaker compartment 7.2 12 15 24 kV 36 Voltage 7.2 12 15 24 kV 36 Voltage
■ Feeder-circuit compartment Fig. 3: Price relation Fig. 4: Price relation
with earthed metal partitions between
each compartment. 4
to dielectric stressing by high voltage, able in all ratings – see selection matrix on
IEC 60 298-1990-12 Annex AA specifies a it is possible and safe to utilize totally en- pages 3/72–3/73 for all power switchgear
“Method for testing the metal-enclosed closed, fixed-mounted and gas-insulated listed in this section. Due to their mainte-
switchgear and controlgear under condi- switchgear. Models 8DA, 8DB, 8DC and nance-free design these breakers can be
tions of arcing due to an internal fault”. NX PLUS described in this section are of installed inside totally enclosed and gas-
Basically, the purpose of this test is to this design. Due to far fewer moving parts insulated switchgear. 5
show that persons standing in front of, or and their total shielding from the environ-
adjacent to a switchboard during internal ment, they have proved to be much more To 2: Vacuum contactors
arcing are not endangered by the effects reliable. Vacuum contactors are used for frequent
of such arcs. All switchboards described switching operations in motor, transformer
All air-insulated switchgear models in this
in this section have successfully passed and capacitor bank feeders. They are type-
these type tests.
section are of the withdrawable type.
tested, extremely reliable and compact de-
6
vices and they are totally maintenance-free.
Switching device Since contactors cannot interrupt fault cur-
Isolating method
Depending on the switching duty in indi- rents, they must always be used with cur-
To perform maintenance operations safely, rent-limiting fuses to protect the equip-
vidual switchboards and feeders, basically
one of two basic precautions must be ment connected. Vacuum contactors can 7
the following types of primary switching
taken before grounding and short-circuiting be installed in the metal-enclosed, metal-
devices are used in the switchgear cubi-
the feeder: clad switchgear types 8BK20, 8BK30 and
cles in this section:
■ 1. Opening of an isolator switch with (Note: Not all types of switching devices can be used in
NXAIR for 7.2 kV/31.5 kA.
clear indication of the OPEN condition. all types of cubicle.)
■ 2. Withdrawal of the interrupter carrier To 3: Vacuum switches or …
■ 1. Vacuum circuit-breakers 8
from the operating into the isolation ■ 2. Vacuum contactors in conjunction Vacuum switches, switch disconnectors
position. with HRC fuses and gas-insulated three-position switch
In both cases, the isolation gap must be ■ 3. Vacuum switches, switch disconnec-
disconnectors in primary distribution switch-
larger than the sparkover distance from tors or gas-insulated three-position boards are used mostly for small trans-
live parts to ground to avoid sparkover switch disconnectors in conjunction with former feeders such as auxiliary transform-
of incoming overvoltages across the gap. HRC fuses. ers or load center substations. Because of 9
The first method is commonly found in their inability to interrupt fault currents
fixed-mounted interrupter switchgear, To 1: Vacuum circuit-breakers they must always be used with current-
whereas the second method is applied limiting fuses. Vacuum switches and switch
In the continuing efforts for safer and more
in withdrawable switchgear. disconnectors can be installed in the air-
reliable medium-voltage circuit-breakers,
insulated switchboard types 8BK20 and
Withdrawable switchgear has primarily the vacuum interrupter is clearly the first
NXAIR. Gas-insulated three-position switch 10
been designed to provide a safe environ- choice of buyers of new circuit-breakers
disconnectors can be installed in the
ment for maintenance work on circuit inter- worldwide.
switchboard type 8DC11.
rupters and instrument transformers. It is maintenancefree up to 10,000 oper-
Therefore, if interrupters and instrument ating cycles without any limitation in terms
transformers are available that do not re- of time and it is recommended for all gen-
quire maintenance during their lifetime, the eralpurpose applications. If high numbers
withdrawable feature becomes obsolete. of switching operations are anticipated
With the introduction of maintenance-free (especially autoreclosing in overhead line
For further information please contact:
vacuum circuit-breaker bottles, and instru- systems and switching of high-voltage mo-
ment transformers which are not subject tors), their use is indicated. They are avail- ++ 49 - 91 31-73 46 39
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 3/5
Primary Distribution
Selection Matrix
2
Metal-enclosed, Draw-out section
metal-clad Vac
Vac
3
Single busbar Metal-enclosed, Draw-out section Vac
metal-clad
Disconnector, Vac
10 Triple-pole
metal-enclosed, fixed-mounted Sw
metal-clad
Double busbar
3/6 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Primary Distribution
Selection Matrix
3
Vacuum contactor
8BK30 50 50 – – 4000 4000 – – 400 400 – – 3/13
Vacuumcircuit-breaker
4
8BK40 63 63 63* – 5000 5000 5000* – 5000 5000 5000* – 3/16
Vacuum circuit-breaker
Vacuum switch
NXAIR 31.5 31.5 25 – 2500 2500 2500 – 2500 2500 2500 – 3/20 5
Switch disconnector
Vacuum contactor
Vacuum circuit-breaker
8BK20 50 50 25 – 4000 4000 2500 – 4000 4000 2000 – 3/8
Vacuum switch 6
Vacuum circuit-breaker
Vacuum switch NXAIR 31.5 31.5 25 – 2500 2500 2500 – 2500 2500 2500 – 3/20
Switch disconnector 7
Vacuum circuit-breaker
NX PLUS 31.5 31.5 31.5 31.5 2500 2500 2500 2500 2500 2500 2500 2500 3/38
8
Vacuum circuit-breaker
Switch disconnector 8DC11 25 25 25 – 1250 1250 1250 – 1250 1250 1250 – 3/24
Vacuum circuit-breaker
9
8DA10 40 40 40 40 3150 3150 3150 2500 2500 2500 2500 2500 3/30
Vacuum circuit-breaker
Switch disconnector 8DC11 25 25 25 – 1250 1250 1250 – 1250 1250 1250 – 3/24
10
Vacuumcircuit-breaker
8DB10 40 40 40 40 3150 3150 3150 2500 2500 2500 2500 2500 3/30
* up to 17.5 kV
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 3/7
Air-Insulated Switchgear
Type 8BK20
■ From 7.2 to 24 kV
■ Single and double-busbar
(back-to-back or face-to-face)
2 ■ Air-insulated
■ Type-tested
■ Metal-enclosed
■ Metal-clad
■ Withdrawable vacuum breaker
3 ■ Vacuum switch optional
■ For indoor installation
Specific features
4 ■ General-purpose switchgear
■ Circuit-breaker mounted on horizontal
slide behind front door
■ Cable connections from front or rear
3/8 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Air-Insulated Switchgear
Type 8BK20
Interlocking system
4
A series of sturdy mechanical interlocks
forces the operator into the only safe oper-
ating sequence of the switchgear, prevent-
ing positively the following:
■ Moving the carriage with the breaker
closed. 5
■ Switching the breaker in any but the
locked ”Connected“ or ”Disconnected/
Fig. 7: Cross-section through 8BK20 cubicle
Test“ position
■ Engaging the grounding switch with the
Low-voltage compartment Busbars and primary disconnectors carriage in the ”Connected“ position, 6
and moving the carriage into this posi-
All protective relays, monitoring and con- Rectangular busbars drawn from pure cop- tion with the grounding switch engaged.
trol devices of a feeder can be accommo- per are used exclusively. They are mount-
dated in a metal-enclosed LV compartment ed on ribbed, cast-resin post insulators
on top of the HV enclosure. Device-mount- which are sized to take up the dynamic Degrees of protection
ing plates, cabling troughs, and the central forces resulting from short circuits. Solid- Standard degree of protection IP 3XD 7
LV terminal strip(s) are located behind a dielectric busbar insulation is available. according to IEC 60529.
separate lockable door. Full or partial plex- The movable parts of the line and load-
iglass windows, or mimic diagrams are side primary disconnectors have flat, Optionally, the cubicles can be protected
available for these doors. spring-loaded and silver-plated hemispheri- against harmful internal deposits of dust
cal pressure contacts for low contact re- and against dripping water (IP 51), available
sistance and good ventilation. The parallel only for cubicles without ventilation slots. 8
Main enclosure connecting arms are designed to increase
The totally enclosed and sealed cubicle contact pressure during short circuits. The
permits installation in most equipment fixed contacts are silver-plated stubs within
rooms. With the optional dust protection, the circuit-breaker bushings or the busbar
the switchgear is safeguarded against mountings. 9
internal contamination, small animals and
rodents, and naturally against contact with
Instrument transformers
live parts. This eliminates the usual rea-
sons for arc faults. Up to three multicore block-type current
Should arcing occur, nevertheless, the transformers plus three single-phase
arc can be guided towards the end of the potential transformers can be installed in 10
lineup, where damage is repaired most the lower compartment, PTs optionally on
easily. For the latter reason, parititions be- withdrawable modules.
tween individual cubicles of the same bus The CTs carry the cable-connecting bars
sections are normally not used. and lugs, and the fixed contacts of the (op-
tional) grounding switch. All common bur-
den and accuracy ratings of instrument
transformers are available. Busbar meter-
ing PTs with their current-limiting fuses are
installed on withdrawable carriages, identi-
cally to breaker carriages.
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 3/9
Air-Insulated Switchgear
Type 8BK20
Installation
The switchboards are shipped in sections
1 of up to three cubicles on stable wooden
pallets which are suitable for rolling and
forklift handling. These sections are bolted
or spot-welded to channel iron sections
embedded in a flat and level concrete floor.
2 Front-connected types can be installed
against the wall or free-standing; rear-con-
nected cubicles require service aisles.
Double-busbar installations in back-to-back
configuration are installed free-standing.
Cable feed-in is through corresponding
3 cut-outs in the floor, plans for which are
part of the switchgear supply. Three-phase
(armored) cables for voltages above 12 kV
require sufficient clearance below the
switchgear to split up the phases (cable-
floor, etc.). Circuit-breakers are shipped Fig. 8: Cross-section through switchgear type 8BK20
4 mounted on their carriages inside the in back-to-back double-busbar arrangement for rated voltages up to 24 kV
switchgear cubicles. For dimensions and
weights, see Fig. 9.
10
3/10 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Air-Insulated Switchgear
Type 8BK20
Technical data 1
Rated Rated Rated short- Rated short- Rated Rated normal feeder current* Rated normal busbar current
voltage lightning time power circuit-breaking short-
impulse frequency current/short- circuit
voltage voltage time current making 2
(1 or 3 s current
available)
630 1250 2000 2500 3150 4000 1) 1250 2000 2500 3150 4000
[kV] [kV] [kV] [kA] (rms) [kA] [A] [A] [A] [A] [A] [A] [A] [A] [A] [A] [A]
3
7.2 60 20 31.5 80 – ■ ■ ■ – – ■ ■ ■ ■ ■
40* 110 – ■ ■ ■ ■ ■ ■ ■ ■ ■ ■
50* 125 – ■ – ■ ■ ■ ■ ■ ■ ■ ■
4
12 75 28 31.5 80 – ■ ■ ■ – – ■ ■ ■ ■ ■
40* 110 – ■ ■ ■ ■ ■ ■ ■ ■ ■ ■
50* 125 – ■ – ■ ■ ■ ■ ■ ■ ■ ■
15 95 36 31.5 80 – ■ ■ ■ – – ■ ■ ■ ■ ■ 5
40* 110 – ■ ■ ■ ■ ■ ■ ■ ■ ■ ■
50* 125 – ■ – ■ ■ ■ ■ ■ ■ ■ ■
17.5 95 38 16 40 ■ ■ – – – – ■ ■ ■ – –
20 50 ■ ■ – – – – ■ ■ ■ – –
6
25 63 ■ ■ ■ – – – ■ ■ ■ – –
24 125 50 16 40 ■ ■ – – – – ■ ■ ■ – –
20 50 ■ ■ ■ – – – ■ ■ ■ – – 7
25 63 – ■ ■ – – – ■ ■ ■ – –
*1s
1) Ventilation unit with or without fan and ventilation slots in the front of the cubicle required.
Fig. 10
8
10
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 3/11
Air-Insulated Switchgear
Type 8BK20
1 8BK20 switchgear up to 24 kV
Panel
Fixed parts Withdraw- Busbar Sectionalizer Bus riser panel Metering Busbar connec-
ableparts modules panel tion panel
2
6
Fig. 11: Available circuit options
10
3/12 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Air-Insulated Switchgear
Type 8BK30
Vacuum contactor
motor starters 8BK30, 1
air-insulated
■ From 3.6–12 kV
■ Single-busbar 2
■ Type-tested
■ Metal-enclosed
■ Metal-clad
■ Withdrawable vacuum contactors
and HRC current-limiting fuses 3
■ For direct lineup with 8BK20 switchgear
■ For indoor installation
Specific features
■ Designed as extension to 8BK20 switch- 4
gear with identical cross section
■ Contactor mounted on horizontally mov-
ing truck – 400 mm panel spacing
■ Cable connection from front or rear
■ Central or individual control power trans- 5
former
■ Integrally-mounted electronic multifunc-
tion motor-protection relays available.
Fig. 12: Metal-clad switchgear type 8BK30 with vacuum contactor (inter-cubicle partition removed)
Tolerance to environment
■ Metal enclosure with optional gaskets
■ Complete corrosion protection and tropi- 9
calization of all parts Technical data
■ Vacuum-potted ribbed expoy insulators
with high tracking resistance Rated BIL PFWV Maximum Feeder Rated busbar current
voltage rating of rating
motor 10
1250 2000 2500 3150 4000
[kV] [kV] [kV] [kW] [A] [A] [A] [A] [A] [A]
Fig. 13
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 3/13
Air-Insulated Switchgear
Type 8BK30
Main enclosure
Practically identical to the associated
8BK20 switchgear.
3/14 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Air-Insulated Switchgear
Type 8BK30
Interlocking system
Contactor, truck and low-voltage plugs are
integrated into the interlocking system to 1
assure the following safeguards:
■ The truck cannot be moved into the
”Connected“ position before the LV plug
is inserted.
■ The LV plug cannot be disconnected 2
with the truck in the ”Connected“ posi-
tion.
■ The truck cannot be moved with the
contactor in the ON position.
■ The contactor cannot be operated with 3
the truck in any other but the locked
”Connected“ or ”Disconnected/Test“
position.
■ The truck cannot be brought into the
”Connected“ position with the ground-
ing switch engaged. 4
■ The grounding switch cannot be en-
gaged with the truck in the ”Connect-
ed“ position.
Degrees of protection 5
Standard degree of protection IP 3XD
according to IEC 60529.
Optionally, the starters can be protected
against harmful internal deposits of dust
and against dripping water in the 6
”Operating“ position (IP 51).
Fig. 15: Cross-section through switchgear type 8BK30
Installation
Identical to the procedures outlined for 7
8BK20 switchgear. Only the HRC fuses are Weights and dimensions
shipped outside the enclosure, separately
packed.
Rated voltage [kV] 3.6 7.2 12
Fig. 16
10
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 3/15
Air-Insulated Switchgear
Type 8BK40
Specific features
■ General-purpose switchgear for rated
4 feeder/busbar current up to 5000 A and
short-circuit breaking current up to
63 kA
■ Circuit-breaker mounted on horizontally
moving truck
■ Cable connections from front
5
Safety of operating and maintenance
personnel
■ All switching operations behind closed
Fig. 17: Metal-clad switchgear type 8BK40 with vacuum circuit-breaker 3AH
doors
6 (inter-cubicle partition removed)
■ Positive and robust mechanical
interlocks
■ Complete protection against contact
with live parts
■ Line test with breaker inserted (option)
7 ■ Maintenance-free vacuum circuit-
breaker
Tolerance to environment
8 ■ Sealed metal enclosure with optional
gaskets
■ Complete corrosion protection and tropi-
calization of all parts
■ Vacuum-potted ribbed epoxy-insulators
with high tracking resistance
9
Generator vacuum circuit-breaker panel
■ Suitable for use in steam, gas-turbine,
hydro and pumped-storage power plants
10 ■ Suitable for use in horizontal, L-shaped
or vertical generator lead routing
3/16 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Air-Insulated Switchgear
Type 8BK40
General description
8BK40 switchboards consist of metal-clad
cubicles of air-insulated switchgear with 1
withdrawable vacuum circuit-breakers. The
breaker truck is fully interlocked with the
interrupter and the stationary cubicle.
It is manually moved in a horizontal direc-
tion from the ”Connected“ position behind 2
the closed front door and without the use
of auxiliary equipment. A fully isolated low-
voltage compartment is integrated.
All commonly used feeder circuits and aux-
iliary devices are available.
The switchgear cubicles and interrupters 3
are factory-assembled and type-tested as
per applicable standards.
Stationary part
4
The cubicle is built as a self-supporting
structure, bolted together from rolled gal-
vanized steel sheets and profile sections.
Cubicles for rated voltages up to 17.5 kV
are of identical construction. Each cubicle
is divided into three sealed and isolated 5
compartments by partitions, i.e. the bus-
bar, cable connection and circuit-breaker
compartment.
The fixed contacts of the primary discon- Fig. 19: Cross-section through panel type 8BK40
nectors are located within insulating breaker 6
bushings, effectively maintaining the com-
partmentalization in all operating states of
the switchgear. The bushings are covered tion indicators are visible through the towards the end of the lineup, where dam-
by automatic steel safety shutters upon closed door. Local mechanical ON/OFF age is repaired most easily. For the latter
removal of the circuit-breaker element pushbuttons are actived through the door reason, partitions between individual cubi-
from the ”Connected“ position. as well. cles of the same bus sections are normally 7
Each compartment in every model has its For complete remote control, the circuit- not used.
own pressure-relief device. To reduce inter- breaker carriage can be equipped for motor
nal arcing times and thus consequential operation. Busbars and primary disconnectors
damage, pressure-switches can be installed
Rectangular busbars drawn from pure
that trip the incoming-feeder circuit-breaker(s)
Low-voltage compartment copper are used exclusively. They are 8
in less than 100 msec. This is an economic
alternative to busbar differential protection. All protective relays, monitoring and con- mounted on ribbed, cast-resin post insula-
trol devices of a feeder can be accommo- tors which are sized to take up the dyna-
dated in a metal-enclosed LV compartment mic forces resulting from short circuits.
Interrupter truck
on top of the HV enclosure. Device-mount- The movable parts of the line and load-
The truck normally supports a vacuum ing plates, cabling troughs, and the central side primary disconnectors have flat, 9
circuit-breaker with the associated operat- LV terminal strip(s) are located behind a spring-loaded and silver-plated hemispheri-
ing mechanism and auxiliary devices. separate lockable door. Full or partial plex- cal pressure contacts for low contact re-
By manually moving the truck with the iglass windows, or mimic diagrams sistance and good ventilation. The parallel
spindle drive it can be brought into a dis- are available for these doors. connecting arms are designed to increase
tinct ”Connected“ and ”Disconnected/ contact pressure during short circuits. The
Test“ position. To this effect, the front fixed contacts are silver-plated stubs within 10
Main enclosure the circuit-breaker bushings.
door remains closed.
Inspection can easily and safely be carried The totally enclosed and sealed cubicle
out with the circuit-breaker in the ”Discon- permits installation in most equipment
Instrument transformers
nected/Test“ position. All electrical and rooms. With the optional dust protection,
mechanical parts are easily accessible in the switchgear is safeguarded against Up to three multicore block-type current
this position. internal contamination, small animals and transformers plus three single-phase
rodents, and naturally against contact with potential transformers can be installed in
Mechanical spring-charge and contact-posi- live parts. This eliminates the usual rea- the lower compartment, PTs optionally
sons for arc faults. Should arcing occur, on withdrawable modules.
nevertheless, the arc can be guided
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 3/17
Air-Insulated Switchgear
Type 8BK40
Degrees of protection
Fig. 21
Degree of protection IP 4X:
In the ”Connected“ and the ”Disconnect-
9 ed/Test“ position of the truck, the switch-
gear is totally protected against contact
with live parts by objects larger than 2 mm Front-connected types can be installed
in diameter. against the wall or free-standing. Double-
Optionally, the cubicles can be protected busbar installations in back-to-back configu-
against harmful internal deposits of dust ration are installed free-standing.
10 and against drip water (IP 51). Cable feed-in is through corresponding cut-
outs in the floor; plans for which are part
of the switchgear scope of supply. Three-
Installation phase (armored) cables for voltages above
The switchboards are shipped in sections 12 kV require sufficient clearance below
of one cubicle on stable wooden pallets the switchgear to split up the phases (cable
which are suitable for rolling and forklift floor, etc.). Circuit-breakers are shipped
handling. These sections are bolted or mounted on their trucks inside the switch-
spot-welded to channel iron sections em- gear cubicles. For preliminary dimensions
bedded in a flat and level concrete floor. and weights, see Fig. 20.
3/18 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Air-Insulated Switchgear
Type 8BK40
1
8BK40 switchgear up to 17.5 kV
Panel
Fixed parts Withdraw- Metering Busbar Sectionalizer Bus riser panel 2
ableparts panel modules
7
Variants Additional parts Optional parts
10
Fig. 22: Available circuit options for switchgear/generator panel type 8BK40
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 3/19
Air-Insulated Switchgear
Type NXAIR
3/20 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Air-Insulated Switchgear
Type NXAIR
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 3/21
Air-Insulated Switchgear
Type NXAIR
Technical data
1
Rated voltage [kV] 12 15 17.5 24
Rated short-time
power-frequency
2 voltage [kV] 28 1) 36 38 50
Rated lightning
impulse voltage [kV] 75 95 95 125
Rated short-circuit
3 breaking current max. [kA] 31.5 31.5 25 25
Rated short-time
withstand current max. [kA] 31.5 31.5 25 25
Rated short-circuit
making current max. [kA] 80 80 63 63
4
Rated normal
current of busbar max. [A] 2500 2500 2500 2500
Rated normal
current of feeder max. [A] 2500 2500 2500 2500
5 Rated normal
current of trans-
former feeder Depends on rated current of fuse used
panels with
HV HRC fuses 2)
6 1) 42 kV on request
2) At 7.2 kV: max. rated current 250 A
at 12 kV: max rated current 150 A
at 15/17.5/24 kV: max. rated current 100 A
Fig. 26
7
10 Fig. 27
3/22 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Air-Insulated Switchgear
Type NXAIR
4
Switch Sectionalizer Bus riser panel Spur panel with
disconnector panel of the bus of the bus circuit-breaker
panel sectionalizer sectionalizer module
Feeder panel with Feeder panel with Feeder panel Feeder panel with
busbar current busbar earthing with busbar busbar voltage
metering switch connection metering 8
(optional)* (optional)* (optional)* (optional)*
10
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 3/23
SF6-Insulated Switchgear
Type 8DC11
Gas-insulated switchgear
1 type 8DC11
■ From 3.6 up to 24 kV
■ Triple-pole primary enclosure
■ SF6-insulated
2 ■ Vacuum circuit-breakers, fixed-mounted
■ Hermetically-sealed, welded, stainless-
steel switchgear enclosure
■ Three-position disconnector as busbar
disconnector and feeder earthing switch
3 ■ Make-proof grounding with
vacuum circuit breaker
■ Width 600 mm for all versions
up to 24 kV
■ Plug-in, single-pole, solid-insulated bus-
4 bars with outer conductive coating
■ Cable termination with external cone
connection system to EN 50181
Operator safety
5 ■ Safe-to-touch and hermetically-sealed
primary enclosure
■ All high-voltage parts, including the cable
sealing ends, busbars and voltage trans-
formers are surrounded by grounded
6 layers or metal enclosures
■ Capacitive voltage indication for check-
ing for ”dead“ state
■ Operating mechanisms and auxiliary
switches safely accessible outside the
primary enclosure (switchgear enclo-
7 sure)
■ Type-tested enclosure and interrogation
interlocking provide high degree of inter-
nal arcing protection
■ Arc-fault-tested acc. to IEC 60 298
8 ■ No need to interfere with the SF6-insu-
lation Fig. 29: Gas-insulated swichgear with vacuum circuit-breakers
Operational reliability
■ Hermetically-sealed primary enclosure ■ Complete switchgear interlocking with The 8DC11 is the result of the economical
9 for protection against environmental mechanical interrogation interlocks combination of SF6-insulation and vacuum
effects (dirt, moisture, insects and ro- ■ Welded switchgear enclosure, perma- technology. The insulating gas SF6 is used
dents). Degree of protection IP65 nently sealed for internal insulation only; circuit interrup-
■ Operating mechanism components ■ Minimum fire contribution tion takes place in standard vacuum break-
maintenance-free in indoor environment er bottles. The safety for the personnel
■ Installation independent of attitude for
10 (DIN VDE 0670 Part 1000) and the environment is maximized. The
feeders without HRC fuses
■ Breaker-operating mechanisms accessi- 8DC11 is completely maintenance-free.
■ Corrosion protection for all climates The welded gas-tight enclosure of the pri-
ble outside the enclosure (primary enclo-
sure) mary part assures an endurance of 30 years
General description without any work on the gas system.
■ Inductive voltage transformer metal-
enclosed for plug-in mounting outside Due to the excellent experience with vacu-
the main circuit um circuit breaker gas-insulated switch-
■ Toroidal-core current transformers gear, there is a worldwide rapidly increas-
located outside the primary enclosure, ing demand of this kind of switchgear even
i.e. free of dielectric stress in the so-called low-range field.
3/24 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
SF6-Insulated Switchgear
Type 8DC11
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 3/25
SF6-Insulated Switchgear
Type 8DC11
3. Current and potential transformers 4. No gas work at site and simplified HV tests can be omitted. Factory-tested
as per user’s application installation quality is ensured thanks to simplified
1 A step forward in switchgear design with- The demand for reliable, economical and
installation without any final adjustments
or difficult assembly work.
out any restriction to the existing system! maintenance-free switchgear is increasing
New switchgear developments are some- more and more in all power supply sys-
times overdesigned with the need for high- tems. Industrial companies and power sup- 5. Minimum space and maintenance-
ly sophisticated secondary monitoring and ply utilities are aware of the high invest- free, cost-saving factors
2 protection equipment, because current- ment and service costs needed to keep a
Panel dimensions reduced, cable-connec-
and potential-measuring devices are used reliable network running. Preventive main-
tenance must be carried out by trained and tion compartment enlarged!
with limited rated outputs.
costly personnel. The panel width of 600 mm and the depth
The result: of 1225 mm are just half of the truth. More
A modern switchgear design should not
Limited application in distribution systems only reduce the investment costs, but also important is the maximized size of the 8DC
3 due to interface problems with existing the service costs in the long run! switchgear cable-connection compartment.
devices; difficult operation and resetting of The access is from the switchgear front
parameters. The Siemens 8DC switchgear has been and the gap from the cable terminal to the
developed to fulfill those requirements. switchgear floor amounts to 740 mm.
The Siemens 8DC switchgear has no re- The modular concept with the mainte-
strictions. Current and potential transform- There is no need for any aisle behind the
nance-free units does not call for installa- switchgear lineup and a cable cellar is su-
4 ers with conventional characteristics are tion specialists and expensive testing and
available for all kinds of protection require- perfluous. A cable trench saves civil engi-
commissioning procedures. The switching neering costs and is fully sufficient with
ments. They are always fitted outside the module with the circuit-breaker and the
SF6-gas-filled container in areas of single- compact dimensions, such as width 500
three-position disconnector is sealed for mm and depth 600 mm.
pole accessibility, the safe-to-touch design life by gas-tight welding without any gas-
of both makes any kind of setting and test- kets. All other high-voltage components Consequently, the costs for the plot of land
5 ing under all service conditions easy. are connected by means of plugs, a tech- and civil work are reduced. Even more,
Current transformers can be installed in nology well-known from cable plugs with a substation can be located closer to the
the cable connection compartment at the long- lasting service and proven experience. consumer which can also solve cable
bushings and, if required additionally, at routing problems.
All cables will be connected by cable plugs
the cables (inside the cable connection with external cone connection system.
6 compartment). Busbar CTs for measuring In the case of XLPE cables, several manu- Busbar
and protection can be placed around the facturers even offer cable plugs with an
silicone-rubber-insulated busbars in any outer conductive coating (also standard for Features
panel. the busbars). Paper-insulated mass-impreg- ■ Single-pole, plug-in version
Potential transformers are of the metal- nated cables can be connected as well by ■ Made of round-bar copper, silicon-
clad pluggable design. Busbar PTs are Raychem heat-shrinkable sealing ends and
7 designed for repeated tests with 80% of adapters.
insulated
the rated power-frequency withstand volt- ■ Busbar connection with cross pieces
The pluggable busbars and PTs do not and end pieces, silicon-insulated
age, cable PTs can be isolated from the require work on the SF6 system at site. In-
live parts by means of a disconnection ■ Field control with the aid of electro-
stallation costs are considerably reduced conductive layers on the silicon-rubber
device which is part of the SF6-gas-filled (all components are pluggable) because,
switching module. This allows high-voltage insulation (both inside and outside)
8 testing of the switchboard with AC and the
contrary to standard GIS, even the site
■ External layers earthed with the switch-
cable with DC without having to remove gear enclosure to permit access
the PTs. ■ Insensitive to dirt and condensation
■ Shock-hazard protected in form of metal
covering
9 ■ Switchgear can be extended or panels
replaced without affecting the SF6 gas
enclosures.
10
Fig. 32: Plug-in busbar (front view with removed low-voltage panel)
3/26 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
SF6-Insulated Switchgear
Type 8DC11
4
4 5 6 7 8 2 9 3 1 Primary part SF6-insulated,
with vacuum interrupter
2 Part of switchgear enclosure
3 Operating-mechanism box
(open) 5
4 Fixed contact element
5 Pole support
6 Vacuum interrupter
7 Movable contact element
6
8 Metal bellows
1 9 Operating mechanism
1)
9
10
Basic versions
Vacuum circuit-breaker Disconnector panel Switch-disconnector Busbar section with Switch-disconnector
panel and three-position with three-position panel with three-position 2 three-position panel with three-position
disconnector disconnector switch disconnector disconnectors and switch disconnector
and HV HCR fuses vacuum circuit-breaker and HV HCR fuses
in one panel
Optional equipment indicated by means of broken lines 1) Current transformer: electrically, this is assigned to the switchpanel,
can be installed/omitted in part or whole. its actual physical location, however, is on the adjacent panel.
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 3/27
SF6-Insulated Switchgear
Type 8DC11
3/28 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
SF6-Insulated Switchgear
Type 8DC11
1 Low-voltage compartment 1
5 2 Operating mechanism
1 3 Cable connection
4 Current transformer 2
6 5 Panel link
6 Busbar
7
7 Gas compartment
2 8 8 Three-position switch
3
9 Voltage transformer
4
3
4
5
9
10
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 3/29
SF6-Insulated Switchgear
Type 8DA/8DB10
3/30 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
SF6-Insulated Switchgear
Type 8DA/8DB10
8DA10 1
1
1 Low-voltage cubicle
2 2 Secondary equipment (SIPROTEC 4)
3 3 Busbar
4 Cast aluminum 2
4 5 Disconnector
6 Operating mechanism and
interlocking device
for three-position switch 3
6 7 Three-position switch
7 8 CB pole with upper and lower
bushings
8
9 CB operating mechanism
9 10 Vacuum interrupter
4
10 11 Connection
12 Current transformer
11
13 Rack
12 5
13
8DB10
7
1
2
3 8
4
5
9
6
7
8
9 10
10
11
12
13
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 3/31
SF6-Insulated Switchgear
Type 8DA/8DB10
6. Low-voltage cabinet
All feeder-related electronic protection
1 devices, auxiliary relays, and measuring
and indicating devices are installed in met-
al-enclosed low-voltage cabinets on top of
each breaker bay. A central terminal strip
of the lineup type is also located there for
2 all LV customer wiring. PCB-type protec-
tion relays and individual-type protection
devices are normally used, depending on
the number of protective functions re-
quired.
2250
3 7. Interlocking system
The circuit-breaker is fully interlocked with
the isolator/grounding switch by means of
solid mechanical linkages. It is impossible
to operate the isolator with the breaker
4 closed, or to remove the switch from the
GROUND SELECTED position with the
breaker closed. Actual grounding is done
via the circuit-breaker itself.
Busbar grounding is possible with the 600
5 available make-proof grounding switch.
If a bus sectionalizer or bus coupler is in-
stalled, busbar grounding can be done via 1525
the three-way switch and the correspond-
ing circuit-breaker of these panels.
The actual isolator position is positively dis-
6 played by rigid mechanical indicators. Fig. 42: Dimensions of switchgear type 8DA10, double-busbar
10
2660
3/32 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
SF6-Insulated Switchgear
Type 8DA/8DB10
Degrees of protection
Cable cross-sections for plug-in terminations 1)
In accordance with IEC 60529:
1
■ Degree of protection IP 3XD:
Interface Rated voltage
The operating mechanism and the low- type
voltage cubicle have degree of protection 7.2/12/15 kV 17.5/24 kV 36 kV
IP 3XD against contact with live parts with Cable cross-section
objects larger than 1 mm in diameter. Pro-
tection against dripping water is optionally [mm2] [mm2] [mm2] 2
available. Space heaters inside the operat-
ing mechanism and the LV cabinet are 2 up to 300 up to 300 up to 185
available for tropical climates.
■ Degree of protection IP 65: 3 400 to 630 400 to 630 240 to 500
By the nature of the enclosure, all high- 3
voltage-carrying parts are totally protected 4 up to 1200 up to 1200 up to 1200
against contact with live parts, dust and
water jets. 1) The plug-in terminations are of the inside cone type acc. to EN 50181: 1997
Fig. 44
Installation 4
The switchgear bays are shipped in prefab-
ricated assemblies up to 5 bays wide on Weights and dimensions
solid wooden pallets, suitable for rolling,
skidding and fork-lift handling. Double-bus-
bar sections are shipped as single or dou- 5
ble bays. The switchgear is designed for Width [mm] 600
indoor operation; outdoor prefabricated en-
closures are available. Each bay is set onto
Height single-busbar (8DA) [mm] 2250
embedded steel profile sections in a flat
concrete floor, with suitable cutouts for the
double-busbar (8DB) [mm] 2350
cables or busbars. All conventional cables 6
can be connected, either with fully insulat- Depth single-busbar (8DA) [mm] 1525
ed plug-in terminations (preferred), or with double-busbar (8DB) [mm] 2660
conventional air-insulated stress cones.
Fully insulated busbars are also connected
directly, without any HV-carrying parts ex- Weight per bay single-busbar (8DA) [kg] approx. 600 7
posed. Operating aisles are required in double-busbar (8DB) [kg] approx. 1150
front of and (in case of double-busbar sys-
tems) behind the switchgear lineup. Fig. 45
8
Ambient temperature and current-carrying capacity:
Minimum temperature –5 °C
45 °C = 90%
50 °C = 80%
Fig. 46
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 3/33
SF6-Insulated Switchgear
Type 8DA/8DB10
Busbar accessories
2
Mounted on
breaker housing
Mounted on current
3 transformer housing
Panel connection
options per phase Mounted
on panel
Voltage connections
transformer,
4 nondisconnectable 1 x plug-in cable
or disconnectable termination
Interface type 2 and 3 Mounted
on panel
or Make-proof or connections
earthing
switch
5 Totally gas or Mounted
solid-insulated bar on panel
Cable or bar connections
or or
connection,
nondisconnectable 3 x plug-in cable termination
or disconnectable Interface type 2
6
or Sectionalizer or 3 x plug-in cable Mounted
without additional
space required termination on panel
Interface type 3 connections
2 x plug-in cable
8 or termination
Interface type 2 and 3 Mounted
with plug-in voltage on panel
transformer connections
or
9 Totally solid-insulated
bar with plug-in
voltage transformer
or
Surge
10 Air-insulated cable
arrester
termination
or
Air-insulated bar
Fig. 47
3/34 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
SF6-Insulated Switchgear
Type 8DA/8DB10
BB1
BB2
Busbar accessories
2
Mounted on
breaker housing
Mounted on current 3
transformer housing
Panel connection Mounted
options per phase on panel
Voltage connections
BB1 BB2
transformer,
nondisconnectable 4
1 x plug-in cable
termination Mounted
Interface type 2 and 3 on panel
BB1 or BB2 Voltage or connections
transformer,
disconnectable
Totally gas or
5
Mounted
solid-insulated bar on panel
or Make-proof or connections
BB1 BB2
earthing
switch 3 x plug-in cable termination
Interface type 2 6
BB1 BB2 or BB1 Cable or bar or
and BB2 connection,
nondisconnectable 3 x plug-in cable termination
Interface type 3
7
Cable or bar or 5 x plug-in cable termination Current
BB1 BB2 or BB1 connection,
and BB2 Interface type 2 transformer
disconnectable
Busbar current or
2 x plug-in cable termination 8
Interface type 2 and 3
BB1 or BB2 transformer with plug-in voltage Mounted on
transformer panel connections
or BB1 Sectionalizer
BB2 without additional
or 9
space required Totally solid insulated
bar with plug-in
voltage transformer
or
Air-insulated cable Surge
10
termination arrester
or Air-insulated bar
Fig. 48
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 3/35
SF6-Insulated Switchgear
Type 8DA/8DB10
Technical data
1
Rated voltage [kV] 7.2 12 15 17.5 24 36 40.5
Rated short-circuit max. [kA] 110 110 110 110 110 110 110
4 making current
Rated current busbar max. [A] 3150 3150 3150 3150 3150 2500 2500
with twin busbar max. [A] 4500 4500 4500 4500 4500 4500 4500
5 Rated current feeder max. [A] 2500 2500 2500 2500 2500 2500 2500
Fig. 49
3/36 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
SF6-Insulated Switchgear
Type 8DA/8DB10
1-pole 2-pole
2
10
Fig. 50 a/b
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 3/37
SF6-Insulated Switchgear
Type NX PLUS
1. Reliablility
■ Hermetically sealed primary enclosure
4 for protection against environmental ef-
fects (dirt, moisture and small animals)
■ Operating mechanism components
maintenance-free in indoor environment
(DIN VDE 0670 Part 1000)
■ Breaker operating mechanisms acces-
5 sible outside the switchgear container
(primary enclosure)
■ Inductive voltage transformers metal-
enclosed for plug-in mounting outside
the main circuit
6 ■ Ring-core current transformers located
outside the primary enclosure
■ Complete interrogative interlocking
system
■ Welded switchgear container, sealed Panel with separate inside cone
7 for life
■ Minimum fire load. Features
2. Insulation medium ■ Rated voltage up to 36 kV
■ Rated short-circuit breaking current
Due to the excellent experience with vacu-
up to 31.5 kA
um circuit-breaker gas-insulated switch-
8 gear, there is a worldwide rapidly increas- ■ Rated normal currents of busbars and
ing demand of this kind of switchgear even feeders up to 2500 A.
in the so-called low-range field.
The insulating gas SF6 is used for internal
insulation only; circuit interruption takes
9 place in standard vacuum breaker bottles.
The safety for the personnel and the envi-
ronment is maximized. Panel with outside cone
The NX PLUS is completely maintenance-
free. The welded gas-tight enclosure of the
primary part assures a full service life with- Features
10 out any work on the gas system. ■ Rated voltage up to 24 kV
■ Rated short-circuit breaking current up
to 25 kA
Fig. 51: SF6-insulated switchgear
Type NX PLUS with SIPROTEC ■ Rated normal currents of busbars up
to 2500 A and feeders up to 1250 A.
Fig. 52
3/38 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
SF6-Insulated Switchgear
Type NX PLUS
1
1 Door of low-voltage compartment
2 SIPROTEC 4 bay controller, type
7SJ63, for control and protection
3 EMERGENCY OFF pushbutton 2
4 Door to mechanical control board
6 15 5 Cover of connection compartment
7
29 6 Busbar cover
8 7 Busbar module, welded, 3
16 SF6-insulated
1 9
8 Three-pole busbar system
17 9 Three-position switch, SF6-insulated,
10 with the three positions:
2 18 ON – OFF – EARTH 4
11 10 Module coupling between busbar
module and circuit-breaker module
12 19
3 11 Circuit-breaker module, welded,
29 SF6-insulated, with integrated cable
4 20 connection 5
13 12 Vacuum interrupter of circuit-breaker
5 21
13 Pressure-relief duct
14 22 14 Integrated cable connection as inside
cone
15 Optional low-voltage compartment
6
1100 mm high
16 Standard low-voltage compartment
730 mm high
17 Ring-core current transformer 7
18 Manual and motor operating
29 mechanism of three-position switch
19 Mechanical control board
23
20 Manual and motor operating
17 mechanism of circuit-breaker 8
24 21 Voltage transformer connection
29 21
socket as inside cone
25 22 22 Cable connection compartment
23 Module coupling between 9
circuit-breaker and cable connection
module
24 Cable connection module, welded,
SF6-insulated, with separate cable
29 connection
11 25 Separate cable connection as inside
10
17 cone
26 Voltage transformer connection
26 socket as outside cone
27 22 27 Cable connection as outside cone
28 28 Connection cables
29 Rupture diaphragm
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 3/39
SF6-Insulated Switchgear
Type NX PLUS
Tolerance to environment
■ Hermetically-sealed enclosure protects Technical data
1 all high-voltage parts from the environ-
ment Rated voltage up to [kV] 24 36 (40.5*)
■ Installation independent of altitude
Rated frequency [Hz] 50/60 50/60
■ Corrosion protection for all climates.
Rated short-time power-frequency voltage [kV] 50 70 (85*)
2 Operator safety Rated lightning impulse voltage [kV] 125 170 (185*)
■ Safe-to-touch and hermetically sealed Rated short-circuit max. [kA] 31.5 31.5
primary enclosure breaking current
■ All HV parts, including the cable sealing and rated short-time
ends, busbars and voltage transformers, withstand current, 3 s
3 are surrounded by earthed layers or met- Rated short-circuit making current max. [kA] 80 80
al enclosures
■ Capacitive voltage detection system for Rated normal current of busbar max. [A] 2500 2500
verification of safe isolation from supply Rated normal current of feeder max. [A] 2500 2500
■ Operating mechanisms and auxiliary
4 switches safely accessible outside the *) On request
primary enclosure (switchgear container)
■ Protective system interlock to prevent Fig. 53
operation when enclosure is open
■ Type-tested enclosure and interrogative
5 interlocks provide high degree of internal Weights and dimensions
arcing protection.
Fig. 54
10
3/40 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
SF6-Insulated Switchgear
Type NX PLUS
Control board Solid-state HMI with panel door SIPROTEC 4 bay controller,
closed type 7SJ63 1
(The basic unit for this is in the
Bay controller
low-voltage compartment)
Solid-state HMI
(human-machine interface)
SIPROTEC 4 bay controller, type 7SJ63,
PROFIBUS-capable, control and protection 2
for stand-alone or master operation. 5 1
2
3
3
6
4
4
1 LCD for process and equipment information, graphically as feeder mimic control
diagram and as text
2 Keys for navigating in menus, in feeder mimic control diagram and for entering values
3 Keys for controlling the process
4 Four programmable function keys for frequently performed actions 5
5 Fourteen programmable LEDs with possible application-related inscriptions for
indicating any desired process and equipment data
6 Two key-operated switches for “changeover between local and remote control“ and
“changeover between interlocked and non-interlocked position“.
Fig. 55 6
Mechanical control board
Mechanical control board 1 ON/OFF position indication for three-
Features with panel door open position switch
■ Arranged behind panel door 2 ON/OFF operating shaft for three-position 7
■ Opening of door switches of the switch
SIPROTEC 4 bay controller, type 7SJ63, 1 2 3 4 3 OFF/EARTHING PREPARED operating
automatically shaft for three-position switch
■ Three-position switch interlocked
4 OFF/EARTHING PREPARED position
with circuit-breaker
indication for three-position switch 8
■ Cancelling of feeder earthing can be 5
blocked mechanically. 6 5 Mimic diagram
6 Ready indication for busbar module
7 (gas compartment monitoring)
8 7 Ready indication for circuit-breaker
module (gas compartment monitoring)
9
9
10 8 Interlocking for preselection
11 9 ON/OFF position indication for circuit-
12 breaker
13
10 Manual spring charging for circuit-breaker 10
14 11 ON pushbutton for circuit-breaker with
15
sealable cap
12 OFF pushbutton for circuit-breaker
13 Locking device for ”feeder earthed”
14 ”Spring charged” indication for circuit-
breaker
15 Operating cycle counter for circuit-breaker
Fig. 56
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 3/41
SF6-Insulated Switchgear
Type NX PLUS
3
Panel connection
versions
5
or 2) 1 x plug-in or 2 x plug-in
cable, cable, sizes
size 2 2 or 3
6
or 2) Voltage or 3 x plug-in
trans- cable, sizes
former, 2 or 3
plug-in
7 type
or 2) Surge or 4 x plug-in
arrester, cable, size 2
plug-in
8 type
10 Surge arrester,
plug-in type
Fig. 57
3/42 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
SF6-Insulated Switchgear
Type NX PLUS
3
Panel connection
versions
6
or Voltage or 3 x plug-in
trans- cable
former,
plug-in
type 7
or Surge
arrester,
plug-in
type 8
and 2) Busbar
current
trans-
9
former
Surge arrester 10
or limiter,
plug-in type
Fig. 58
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 3/43
SF6-Insulated Switchgear
Type NX PLUS
Capacitive Current
4 1)
voltage transformer
detection
system
5 Busbar
and current
transformer
6
1) Not possible with rated normal current of busbar of 2500 A.
Fig. 59
7
10
3/44 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
SF6-Insulated Switchgear
Type NX PLUS
10
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 3/45
Secondary Distribution
Switchgear and Transformer Substations
3/46 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Secondary Distribution
Switchgear and Transformer Substations
1
Primary
distribution
G 2
Secondary
distribution
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 3/47
Secondary Distribution
Selection Matrix
1 Switchgear
3
RMU
subst
conve
conne
Stand
4
RMU
Metal-enclosed subst
Nonextensible SF6-gas-insulated Load-break switch cable
fixed-mounted
Stand
5
Medium-voltage
indoor switchgear,
type-tested RMU
low s
according to: housi
IEC 60 298
6 DIN VDE 0670, Part 6
9
Transformer substations Execution of
the transformer substation
10
Fig. 62
3/48 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Secondary Distribution
Selection Matrix
9
Package Type of housing HV section Transformer Page
substation type Medium-voltage rating
(Example) switchgear type
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 3/49
Secondary Distribution
Switchgear Type 8DJ10
Ring-main unit
1 type 8DJ10, 7.2–24 kV
nonextensible, SF6-insulated
Standard Range 1
2 Typical use
SF6-insulated, metal-enclosed fixed-mount-
ed ring-main units (RMU) type 8DJ10 are
used for outdoor transformer substations
and indoor substation rooms with a varia-
3 bility of 25 different schemes as a standard
delivery program.
More than 60,000 RMUs of type 8DJ10
are in worldwide operation.
4 Specific features
■ Maintenance-free, all-climate
■ SF6 housings have no seals
■ Remote-controlled motor operating
mechanism for all auxiliary voltages from
5 24 V DC to 230 V AC
■ Easily extensible by virtue of trouble-free
replacement of units with identical cable
connection geometry
■ Standardized unit variants for operator-
compatible concepts
6 ■ Variable transformer cable connection
facilities
■ Excellent economy by virtue of ambient
condition-resistant, maintenance-free
components
7 ■ Versatile cable connection facilities,
optional connection of mass-impregnat-
ed or plastic-insulated cables or plug
connectors Fig. 63: Example: Scheme 10
■ Cables easily tested without having to
8 be dismantled
10
3/50 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Secondary Distribution
Switchgear Type 8DJ10
8
1 1 HRC fuse boxes
2 Hermetically-scaled welded
stainless steel enclosure
2
3 SF6 insulation/quenching gas
9
3 4 Three-position load-break switch
5 Feeder cable with insulated
4 connection alternative with
T-plug system
Fig. 65: Cross section of SF6-insulated ring-main unit 8DJ10 Fig. 66: “Three-position load-break switch”
ON–OFF–EARTH
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 3/51
Secondary Distribution
Switchgear Type 8DJ10
3
Scheme 10 Scheme 71 Scheme 81
Dimensions [mm]
10 Dimensions [mm]
3/52 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Secondary Distribution
Switchgear Type 8DJ20
Ring-main unit
type 8DJ20, 7.2–24 kV 1
non extensible, SF6-insulated
Standard Range 2
Typical use 2
Same system as type 8DJ10 (page 3/50)
but other geometrical dimensions and
design, also single panel for transformer
feeder.
■ Substations with control aisles 3
■ Compact substations, substations by
pavements
■ Tower base substations
■ 7.2 kV to 24 kV
■ Up to 25 kA 4
Specific features
■ Minimal dimensions
■ Ease of operation
■ Proven components from the
5
8DJ10 range
■ Metal-enclosed
■ All-climate
■ Maintenance-free
■ Capacitive voltage taps for
6
– incoming feeder cable
– outgoing transformer feeder
■ Optional double cable connection Fig. 68: Example: Scheme 10 (width 1060 mm)
■ Optional surge arrester connection
■ Transformer cable connected via straight
7
or elbow plug
■ Motor operating mechanism for auxiliary
voltages of 24 V DC – 230 V AC
8DJ20 switchgear
8
■ Overall heights 1200 mm, 1400 mm
or 1650 mm
■ High cable termination
■ For cable T-plugs 9
■ Detachable lever mechanism
■ Option: rotary operating mechanism
10
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 3/53
Secondary Distribution
Switchgear Type 8DJ20
Technical data
1
Rated voltage Ur [kV] 7.2 12 15 17.5 24
for transformer feeders depending on the HV HRC fuse [A] 200 200 200 200 200
Rated filling pressure (at 20 °C) [hpa] 500 500 500 500 500
for insulation pre and for operation prm
7 Fig. 69
10
3/54 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Secondary Distribution
Switchgear Type 8DJ20
Transformer feeder 1
Section A-A
A
5
4
6
A
Standard
Cable termination for elbow plugs
(Option:cable-T-plugs), cable bushing
directed downlwards 7
10
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 3/55
Secondary Distribution
Switchgear Type 8DJ20
4
Scheme 01 Scheme 21 Scheme 11/32/70/84 Scheme 20 Scheme 10
3/56 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Secondary Distribution
Switchgear Type 8DJ20
4
e 10 Scheme 71 Scheme 72 Scheme 81 Scheme 82
3 4 2 3 6
1 1 2 2
10
1410 1760 1410 1760
780 780 780 780
1200 1200 1200 1200
1400 1400 1400 1400
1760 1760 1760 1760
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 3/57
Secondary Distribution
Switchgear Type 8DJ40
Ring-main unit
1 type 8DJ40, 7.2–24 kV
nonextensible, SF6-insulated
Typical use
2 SF6-insulated, metal-enclosed, fixed-
mounted. Ring-main units type 8DJ40 are
mainly used for transformer compact sub-
stations. The main advantage of this switch-
gear is the extremely high cable termina-
tion for easy cable connection and cable
3 testing work.
Specific features
8DJ40 units are type-tested, factory-
4 finished, metal-enclosed SF6-insulated
switchgear installations and meet the
following operational specifications:
■ High level of personnel safety and Fig. 72: Nonextensible RMU, type 8DJ40
reliability
■ High availability
5
■ High-level cable connection Technical data (rated values)1)
■ Minimum space requirement
■ Uncomplicated design
Rated voltage [kV] 12 24
■ Separate operating mechanism
actuation for switch disconnector
6 and make-proof grounding switch, Rated frequency [Hz] 50 50
same switching direction in line
with VDEW recommendation Rated current of [A]
cable feeders 400/630* 400/630*
■ Ease of installation
■ Motor operating mechanism Rated current of [A] ≤ 200 ≤ 200
7 retrofittable transformer feeders
■ Optional stored-energy release for
ring cable feeders Rated power-frequency [kV] 28 50
withstand voltage
■ Maintenance-free
■ All-climate Rated lightning-impulse [kV] 75 125
8 withstand voltage
Rated short-circuit [kA]
making current of 50 (31.5)* 40 (31.5)*
cable feeder switches
Fig. 73
3/58 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Secondary Distribution
Switchgear Type 8DJ40
5
Dimensions [mm]
10
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 3/59
Secondary Distribution
Switchgear Type 8DH10
Consumer substation
1 modular switchgear type 8DH10
extensible, SF6-insulated
Typical use
2 SF6-insulated, metal-enclosed fixed-mount-
ed switchgear units type 8DH10 are indoor
installations and are mainly used for power
distribution in customer substations or
main substations.
3 The units are particularly well suited for
installation in industrial environments,
damp river valleys, exposed dusty or sandy
areas and in built-up urban areas.
They can also be installed at high altitude
or where the ambient temperature is very
4 high.
Specific features
8DH10 fixed-mounted switchgear units are
5 type-tested, factory-assembled, SF6-insulat-
ed, metal-enclosed switchgear units com-
prising circuit-breaker panels, disconnector
panels and metering panels.
They meet the demands made on medi-
um-voltage switchgear, such as
6 ■ High degree of operator safety, reliability
and availability Fig. 75: Extensible, modular switchgear type 8DH10
■ No local SF6 work
■ Simple to install and extend
■ The units have a grounded outer enclo-
■ Operation not affected by environmental
7 factors
sure and are thus shockproof. This also
applies to the fuse assembly and the
■ Minimum space requirements cable terminations. Plug-in cable sealing
■ Freedom from maintenance is met sub- ends are housed in a shock-proof metal-
stantially better by these units than by enclosed support frame
earlier designs. ■ Fuses and cable connections are only
8 ■ Busbars from panel blocks are located accessible when earthed
within the SF6 gas compartment. Con- ■ All bushings for electrical and mechani-
nections with individual panels and other cal connections are welded gas-tight
blocks are provided by solid-insulated without gaskets
plug-in busbars ■ Three-position switches are fitted for
9 ■ Single-phase cast-resin enclosed insulat- load switching, disconnection and
ed fuse mounting outside the switch- grounding, with the following switch
gear housing ensures security against positions: closed, open and grounded.
phase-to-phase faults Make-proof earthing is effected by the
■ All live components are protected three-position switch (shown on page
against humidity, contamination, corro- 3/51)
10 sive gases and vapours, dust and small ■ Each switchgear unit can be composed
animals as required from single panels and
■ All normal types of T-plugs for thermo- (preferably) panel blocks, which may
plastic-insulated cables up to 300 m2 comprise up to three combined single
cross-section can be accommodated panels
■ The 8DH10 switchgear is maintenance-
free
■ Integrated current transformer suitable
for digital protection relays and protec-
tion systems for CT operation release
3/60 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Secondary Distribution
Switchgear Type 8DH10
1
1
1
2
2
3
2 4
5
3
3 6
7
4
8
5 9 4
10
7
LV cabinet
1
2
3
4
9
extensible extensible
Fig. 78: Combination of single panels with plug-in type, silicon-insulated busbar. Fig. 79: Cross-section of silicon-plugged
No local SF6 gas work required during assembly or extension busbar section.
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 3/61
Secondary Distribution
Switchgear Type 8DH10
Fig. 80
8
10
3/62 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Secondary Distribution
Switchgear Type 8DH10
Individual panels
1
Ring-main panel Transformer panel Circuit-breaker panel Billing metering Busbar metering
panel and grounding panel
4
Dimensions [mm] 5
Width 500 500 350 600*/850 500
Blocks 7
9
2 Ring-main feeders
3 Ring-main feeders 2 Transformer feeders 3 Transformer feeders
10
Dimensions [mm]
Width 700 1050 1000 1500
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 3/63
Secondary Distribution
Switchgear Type 8AA20
Consumer substation
1 modular switchgear
type 8AA20, 7.2–24 kV
extensible, air-insulated
2 Typical use
This air-insulated modular indoor switch-
gear is used as a flexible system with a lot
of panel variations. Panels with fused and
unfused load-break switches, with truck-
3 type vacuum circuit-breakers and metering
panels can be combined with air-insulated
busbars.
The 8AA20 ring-main units are type-tested,
factory-assembled metal-enclosed indoor
switchgear installations. They meet opera-
4 tional requirements by virtue of the follow-
ing features:
3/64 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Secondary Distribution
Switchgear Type 8AA20
Standards
■ The switchgear complies with the
following standards: 1
Specific features
8
■ Switch disconnector fixed-mounted
■ Switch disconnector with integrated
central operating mechanism
■ Standard program includes numerous Load-break panels
circuit variants
■ Operations enabled by protective inter-
Scheme 21/22 Scheme 23/24 Scheme 25/26 9
locks; the insulating barrier is included in
the interlocking
■ Extensible by virtue of panel design
■ Cubicles compartmentalized (option)
■ Minimal cubicle dimensions without 10
extensive use of plastics Metering and cable panels
■ Lines up with earlier type 8AA10 Scheme 33/34
■ Withdrawable circuit-breaker section can
be moved into the service and discon-
nected position with the door closed
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 3/65
Secondary Distribution
Transformer Substations
Factory-assembled
1 packaged substations
type 8FB1 (example)
Factory-assembled transformer substations
are available in different designs and di-
2 mensions. As an example of a typical sub-
station program, type 8FB1 is shown here.
Other types are available on request.
The transformer substations type 8FB1
with up to 1000 kVA transformer ratings
3 and 7.2–24 kV are prefabricated and facto-
ry-assembled, ready for connection of net-
work cables on site.
Special foundation not necessary.
■ Distribution substations for
4 public power supply
■ Nonwalk-in type
■ Switchgear operated with open substa-
tion doors
5 General features/Applications
■ Power supply for LV systems, especially
in load centers for public supply Fig. 88: Steel-clad outdoor substation 8FB1 for rated voltages up to 24 kV and transformers up to 1000 kVA
■ Power supply for small and medium
industrial plants with existing HV side
HV section (as an example): LV section:
6 cable terminations
■ Particularly suitable for installation at 8DJ SF6-insulated ring-main unit The LV section can take various forms to
sites subject to high atmospheric humid- (for details please refer to RMUs pages suit the differing base configurations. The
ity, hostile environment, and stringent 2/48–2/61) connection to the transformer is made by
demands regarding blending of the sta- parallel cables instead of bare conductors.
tion with the surroundings Technical data:
7 Incoming circuit: Circuit breaker, fused load
■ Extra reliability ensured by SF6-insulated ■ Rated voltages and insulation levels disconnector, fuses or isolating links.
ring-main units type 8DJ, which require 7.2 kV 12 kV 15 kV 17.5 kV 24 kV Outgoing circuits: Tandem-type fuses,
no maintenance and are not affected by 60 75 95 95 125 kV (BIL) load-break switches, MCCB, or any other
the climate ■ Rating of cable circuits: 400 / 630 A requested systems.
■ Rating of transformer circuits: 200 A Basic measuring and metering equipment
8 Brief description ■ Degree of protection for HV parts: IP 65 to suit the individual requirements.
The substation housing consists of a tor- ■ Ambient temperature range:
sion-resistant bottom unit, with a concrete –30°C/+55°C (other on request)
trough for the transformer, embedded in
the ground, and a hot-dip galvanized steel Transformer section:
9 structure mounted on it. It is subdivided
into three sections: HV section, transform- Oil-cooled transformer with ratings up to
er section and LV section. The lateral sec- max. 1000 kVA. The transformer is con-
tion of the concrete trough serves as nected with the 8DJ10 ring-main unit by
mounting surface for the HV and LV cubi- three single-core screened 35 mm2 plastic
cles and also closes off the cable entry insulated cables. The connection is made
10 compartments at the sides. These com- by means of right-angle plugs or standard
partments are closed off at the bottom and air-insulated sealing ends possible at the
front by hot-dip galvanized bolted steel transformer side.
covers.
Four threaded bushes for lifting the com-
plete substation are located in the floor of
the concrete trough. The substations are
arc-fault-tested in order to ensure safety
for personnel during operation and for the
pedestrians passing by the installed sub-
station.
3/66 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Secondary Distribution
Transformer Substations
Transformer rating 630 kVA 630 kVA 630 kVA 1000 kVA 1000 kVA 1000 kVA
Overall dimensions,
4
weights:
Length [mm] 3290 2570 2100 3860 3120 2350
Width [mm] 1300 2100 2100 1550 2300 2300
Height above [mm] 1650 1650 1650 1700 1700 1700
ground 5
Height overall [mm] 2100 2100 2100 2350 2350 2350
Floor area [mm2] 4.28 5.40 4.41 5.98 7.18 5.41
Volume [mm3] 7.06 8.91 7.28 10.17 12.20 9.19
Weight without [kg] approx. 2280 approx. 2530 approx. 2400 approx. 3400 approx. 3800 approx. 3600
transformer 6
Fig. 89: Technical data, dimensions and weights
Fig. 90: HV section: Fig. 91: Transformer section: Fig. 92: LV section:
Compact substation 8FB with SF6-insulated RMU Cable terminations to the transformer, as a example Example of LV distribution board
(two loop switches, one transformer feeder switch 10
with HRC fuses)
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 3/67
Industrial Load Center Substation
Introduction
1
Industrial power supply systems call for a
maximum level of operator safety, opera-
tional reliability, economic efficiency and
flexibility. And they likewise necessitate an
integral concept which includes “before”
2 and “after” customer service, which can
cope with the specific load requirements
and, above all, which is tailored to each
individually occurring situation.
With SITRABLOC® such a concept can be
easily turned into reality.
3
General
Fig. 93
5
SITRABLOC is an acronym for
SIemens TRAnsformer BLOC-type.
SITRABLOC is supplied with power from
a medium-voltage substation via a fuse/
Substation
8DC11/8DH10
switch-disconnector combination and a ra-
6 dial cable. In the load center, where SITRA-
BLOC is installed, several SITRABLOCs are
connected together by means of cables or
bars.
7 Load-centre
Features substation
■ Due to the fuse/switch-disconnector Supply company's
combination, the short-circuit current substation
is limited, which means that the radial
8 cable can be dimensioned according to
the size of the transformer.
■ In the event of cable faults, only one
SITRABLOC fails.
■ The short-circuit strength is increased
9 due to connection of several stations in
the load center. The effect of this is that, LV busways
in the event of a fault, large loads are
selectively disconnected in a very short
time.
10 ■ The transmission losses are optimized
since only short connections to the
loads are necessary. Fig. 94: Example of a schematic diagram
■ SITRABLOC has, in principle, two trans-
former outputs:
– 1250 kVA during AN operation
(ambient temperature up to 40 °C)
– 1750 kVA during AF operation
(140% with forced cooling).
These features ensure that, if one station
fails for whatever reason, supply of the
loads is maintained without interruption.
3/68 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Industrial Load Center Substation
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 3/69
Industrial Load Center Substation
4
Circuit-breakers and switch disconnectors
Substation with HV HRC fuses
5 t < 10 ms
M M M Production M M M
Operator safety
7 Reduced costs
Low system losses
3/70 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Industrial Load Center Substation
PROFIBUS
ET 200B ET 200C Field devices
6
Communications interface
SITRABLOC 7
ET 200M 12/24 kV
P P
GEAFOL transformer 8
with built-on
make-proof earthing switch
9
LV installation with circuit-
breakers and automatic reactive-
power compensation
10
0.4 kV
Option
LV busbar system
with sliding link
(e.g. SENTRON busways)
Fig. 100
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 3/71
Medium-Voltage Devices
Product Range
Devices for
Device Type Rated Short- Short-time
1 medium-voltage switchgear voltage circuit current
current (3s)
With the equipment program for switch-
[kV] [kA] [kA]
gear Siemens can deliver nearly every
device which is required in the medium-
2 voltage range between 7.2 and 36 kV.
Indoor vacuum 3AH 7.2 … 36 13.1 … 80 13.1 … 80
Fig. 101 gives an overview of the available
circuit-breaker
devices and their main characteristics.
All components and devices conform to NX ACT 12 25 25
international and national standards,
Outdoor vacuum 3AF 36 25 25
as there are:
3 circuit-breaker
Vacuum circuit-breakers
■ IEC 60 056 Components for 3AY2 12 … 36 16 … 40 16 … 40
■ IEC 60 694 3AH VCB
4 ■ BS5311
Switch disconnectors
■ IEC 60 129
Indoor switch 3CJ 12 … 24 – 18 … 26 (1s)
disconnector
■ IEC 60 265-1
7
HV HRC fuses Indoor disconnecting 3D 12 … 36 – 16 ... 63 (1s)
■ IEC 60 282 and grounding switch
3/72 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Medium-Voltage Devices
Product Range
800 … 12,000 10,000 … 10,000 … 25 … 100 All applications, e.g. overhead lines, cables, transformers, 3/74 2
120,000 30,000 motors, generators, capacitors, filter circuits, arc furnaces
1250 … 2500 10,000 10,000 25 … 50 3/78
1600 10,000 10,000 50 All applications, e.g. overhead lines, cables, transformers, 3/80
motors, generators, capacitors, filter circuits 3
4
800 10,000 10,000 – All applications, e.g. overhead lines, cables, transformers, 3/82
motors, capacitors; high number of operations; fuses
necessary for short-circuit protection
400 … 800 1x106 ... 3x106 0.25x105 ... 2x106 – All applications, especially motors with very high number 3/84 5
of operating cycles
630 … 4000 10,000 … 10,000 … 25 … 100 For circuit breakers, switches and gas-insulated switchgear 3/85
30,000 30,000 6
7
630 … 3000 – – – Protection of personnel working on equipment 3/87
8
6.3 … 250 – – – Short-circuit protection; short-circuit current limitation 3/88
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 3/73
Medium-Voltage Devices
Type 3AH
3/74 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Medium-Voltage Devices
Type 3AH
4
Fig. 103: Vacuum circuit-breakers type 3AH
Advantages of the 5
vacuum switching principle
The most important advantages of the
principle of arc extinction in a vacuum have
made the circuit-breakers a technically su-
perior product and the principle on which 6
they work the most economical extinction
method available:
■ Constant dielectric:
In a vacuum there are no decomposition
products and because the vacuum inter-
rupter is hermetically sealed there are 7
no environmental influences on it.
■ Constant contact resistance:
The absence of oxidization in a vacuum
keeps the metal contact surface clean.
For this reason, contact resistance can 8
be guaranteed to remain low over the
whole life of the equipment.
■ High total current:
Because there is little erosion of con-
tacts, the rated normal current can be Fig. 104: Front view of vacuum circuit-breaker 3AH1
interrupted up to 30,000 times, the 9
short-circuit breaking current an average
of 50 times
■ Low chopping current:
The chopping current in the Siemens
vacuum interrupter is only 4 to 5 A due 10
to the use of a special contact material.
■ High reliability:
The vacuum interrupters need no seal-
ings as conventional circuit-breakers.
This and the small number of moving
parts inside makes them extremely relia-
ble.
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 3/75
Medium-Voltage Devices
Type 3AH
3AH1,
1 12 kV 604 520
20 kA, up to 1250 A 522 190
210 210
25 kA, up to 1250 A
2 105
437 473
3
60
Dimensions in mm
4
604
3AH1, 3AH2, 550
12 kV 549
190
5 210 210
25 kA, 2500 A,
31.5 kA, 2500 A,
40 kA, 3150 A 105
6
437
587
7
109
Dimensions in mm 565
8
3AH1, 708
24 kV 565
662 190
9 16 kA, up to 1250 A, 275 275
20 kA, up to 1250 A,
25 kA, up to 1250 A 105
10 535
437
60
Dimensions in mm
3/76 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Medium-Voltage Devices
Type 3AH
708 595
3AH1, 3AH2,
24 kV 670 190 1
275 275
20kA, 2500 A
25 kA, 2500 A
105
437 648
109
Dimensions in mm
610
4
6
564 733
Dimensions in mm 776
8
820 211 526
3AH3, 3AH4,
36 kV 350 350
Dimensions in mm 853
612
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 3/77
Medium-Voltage Devices
Type NXACT
General
NXACT combines the advantages of vacu-
um circuit-breakers with additional integrat-
2 ed functions.
More functions
Disconnector, earthing switch, operator
3 panel and interlock are integrated in a sin-
gle breaker module. The module is sup-
plied pretested and ready for installation.
Ease of integration …
4 For the system builder, this means mini-
mum project planning, ease of installation
even with subsequent retrofitting, no more
testing, simplified logistics – these fea-
tures mean that NXACT is unbeatable,
even with the overall cost of the substa-
5 tion.
Its compact design minimizes installation
and commissioning time.
In operation, NXACT is notable for the
clear layout of its control panel, which is
6 always accessible at the front of the Fig. 106: NXACT vacuum circuit-breaker module, 12 kV
switchgear.
Fig. 107
3/78 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Medium-Voltage Devices
Type NXACT
Features
■ Integrated, mechanical interlocks be-
tween operating mechanisms. 1
■ Integrated, mechanical switch position
indications for circuit-breaker, withdrawa-
ble part and earthing switch function
(optional).
■ Easy to withdraw, since only withdrawa- 2
ble part is moved.
■ Fixed interlocking of circuit-breaker mod-
ule with a switchpanel is possible.
■ Manual or motor operating mechanism
(optional for the operating mechanisms). 3
■ Enforced connection of low-voltage plug
with the switchpanel, as soon as the
module is installed in a panel.
■ Maintenance-free operating mechanisms
within scope of switching cycles.
4
Fig. 108 6
275
730 140* 767
9
375
100
10
586
646 156
584
Operating mechanism
for earthing switch
Dimensions in mm * Travel
Fig. 109
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 3/79
Medium-Voltage Devices
Type 3AF
3045
9 2410
1810
10
1730 450
1930 650
Dimensions in mm
Fig. 110: Outdoor vacuum circuit-breaker Fig. 112: Dimensions of outdoor circuit-breaker type 3AF for 36 kV
type 3AF for 36 kV
3/80 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Medium-Voltage Devices
Components, Type 3AY2
Components for 12 kV
Up to 2500 A /to 40 kA /1 sec. 945 6
For 800 mm switchgear panel width:
With 3AH1 – 7.2/12 kV breaker
210 mm pole centre distance
With 3AH5 – 12 kV breaker
210 mm pole centre distance 7
Components for 24 kV
Dimensions in mm
To 2500 A /to 25 kA /1 sec.
For 1000 mm switchgear panel width: Fig. 115: 12 kV switchgear module
With 3AH1 – 24 kV breaker 8
275 mm pole centre distance
With 3AH5 – 24 kV breaker Front view Side view
275 mm pole centre distance
On request: components for 15 kV 1000 295 1224
9
To 2500 A /to 40 kA /1 sec.
For 800 mm switchgear panel width:
With 3AH1 – 15 kV breaker
210 mm pole centre distance
With 3AH5 – 17.5 kV breaker 10
210 mm pole centre distance 1030
Components for 36 kV
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 3/81
Medium-Voltage Devices
Type 3CG
10
3/82 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Medium-Voltage Devices
Type 3CG
3CG,
7.2 and 12 kV 1
530 492
210 210
3
264
435 482
568 5
43
592 170
Dimensions in mm
3 CG,
24 kV
630 7
537
275 275
379 597 9
435
10
684
43
708 170
Dimensions in mm
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 3/83
Medium-Voltage Devices
Type 3TL
10
3/84 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Medium-Voltage Devices
Type VS
Vacuum interrupters
1
Vacuum interrupters for the medium-volt-
age range are available from Siemens for
all applications on the international market
from 1 kV up to 40.5 kV.
2
Applications
■ Vacuum circuit-breakers
■ Vacuum switches
■ Vacuum contactors
■ Transformer tap changers 3
■ Circuit breakers for railway applications
■ Autoreclosers
■ Special applications, e.g. in nuclear
fusion
4
Compact designs
Siemens vacuum interrupters provide very
high switching capacity in very compact
dimensions: for example vacuum interrupt-
ers for 15 kV/40 kA with housing dimen- 5
sions of 125 mm diameter by 161 mm
length, or for 12 kV/13.1 kA with 68 mm
diameter by 115 mm length.
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 3/85
Medium-Voltage Devices
Type 3CJ1
Switch disconnectors
1 type 3CJ1
Indoor switch disconnectors type 3CJ1 are
multipurpose types and meet all the rele-
vant standards both as the basic version
2 and in combination with (make-proof)
grounding switches.
The 3CJ1 indoor switch-disconnectors
have the following features:
■ A modular system with all important
3 modules such as fuses, (make-proof)
grounding switches, motor operating
mechanism, shunt releases and auxiliary
switches
■ Good dielectric properties even under
difficult climatic conditions because of
4 the exclusive use of standard post insu-
lators for insulation against ground
■ No insulating partitions even with small
phase spacings
■ Simple maintenance and inspection
5
Fig. 125: Switch disconnector type 3CJ1
6 Technical data
10
3/86 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Medium-Voltage Devices
Type 3D
5
Fig. 127: Disconnecting switch type 3DC
6
Technical data
9
Technical data
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 3/87
Medium-Voltage Devices
Type 3GD/3GH
HV HRC fuses
1 type 3GD
HV HRC (high-voltage high-rupturing-capac-
ity) fuses are used for short-circuit protec-
tion in high-voltage switchgear. They pro-
2 tect switchgear and components, such as
transformers, motors, capacitors, voltage
transformers and cable feeders, from the
dynamic and thermal effects of high short-
circuit currents by breaking them as they
occur.
3 The HV HRC fuse links can only be used Fig. 130: HV HRC fuse type 3GD
to a limited degree as overload protection
because they only operate with certainty
when their minimum breaking current has Technical data
already been exceeded. Up to this current
4 the integrated thermal striker prevents a
thermal overload on the fuse when used in Rated voltage [kV] 7.2 12 24 36
circuit breaker/fuse combinations.
Siemens HV HRC fuse links have the fol- Rated short-circuit [kA] 63 to 80 40 to 63 31.5 to 40 31.5
lowing features: breaking current
5 ■ Use in indoor and outdoor installations
■ Nonaging because the fuse element Rated normal current [A] 6.3 to 250 6.3 to 160 6.3 to 100 6.3 to 40
is made of pure silver
■ Thermal tripping Fig. 131: Ratings for HV HRC fuse links type 3GD
■ Absolutely watertight
6 ■ Low power loss
With our 30 years of experience in the
manufacture of HV HRC fuse links and
with production and quality assurance
that complies with DIN/ISO 9001,
Siemens HV HRC fuse links meet the
7 toughest demands for safety and reliability.
3/88 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Medium-Voltage Devices
Insulators and Bushings
Insulators:
Post insulators type 3FA 1
and bushings type 3FH/3FM
Insulators (post insulators and bushings)
are used to insulate live parts from one an-
other and also fulfill mechanical carrying 2
and supporting functions.
The materials for insulators are various
cast resins and porcelains. The use of
these materials, which have proved them-
selves over many years of exposure to the 3
roughest operating and ambient conditions,
and the high quality standard to DIN/ISO
9001 assure the high degree of reliability
of the insulators.
Special ribbed forms ensure high electrical
strength even when materials are deposit-
4
ed on the surface and occasional conden-
sation is formed.
Post insulators and bushings are manufac-
tured in various designs for indoor and out-
door use depending on the application. 5
Fig. 135: Post insulators type 3FA1/2
Innovative solutions, such as the 3FA4
divider post insulator with an integrated
expulsion-type arrester, provide optimum
utility for the customer. Technical data
Special designs are possible if requested 6
by the customer.
Rated voltage [kV] 3.6 12 24 36
9
L
L Conductor
U Operating voltage
U1 U1 Partial voltage
C1 M across C1
U U2 Partial voltage across 10
C2 and indicator
V C2 A C1 Coupling capacitance
U2
C2 Undercapacitance
V Arrester
A Indicator
M Measuring socket
Fig. 134: Draw-lead bushing type 3FH5/6 Fig. 137: The principle of capacitive voltage indication with the 3FA4 divider post insulator
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 3/89
Medium-Voltage Devices
Type 4M and Type 3E
Fig. 142
3/90 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Low-Voltage
Switchboards
SIVACON
Contents Page
Introduction .................................... 4/2
Advantages .................................... 4/2
Technical data ............................... 4/3
Cubicle design ............................... 4/4
Busbar system ............................... 4/5
Installation designs ...................... 4/6
Circuit-breaker design ................. 4/6
Withdrawable-unit design .......... 4/7
In-line plug-in design ................. 4/13
In-line-type plug-in
design 3NJ6 ................................. 4/14
Fixed-mounted design ................ 4/15
Communication with
PROFIBUS®-DP ........................... 4/16
Frame and enclosure ................. 4/17
Forms of internal separation .... 4/18
Installation details ...................... 4/19
4
Low-Voltage Switchboards
4/2 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Low-Voltage Switchboards
1 2 3 4
9
1 Circuit-breaker-design cubicle
with withdrawable circuit-breaker
3WN, 1600 A
2 Withdrawable-unit-design cubicle
with miniature and normal
10
withdrawable units up to 250 kW
3 Plug-in design cubicle with in-line
modules and plug-in fuse strips
3NJ6
4 Fixed-mounted-design cubicle
with modular function units
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 4/3
Low-Voltage Switchboards
Cubicle design
1
The cubicle is structured in modular grid 400 600
based on one modular spacing (1 M)
corresponding to 175 mm. The effective
device installation space with a height of
1750 mm therefore represents a height
2 of 10 M. The top and bottom space each
has a height of 225 mm (Fig. 5).
A cubicle is subdivided into four function
compartments:
■ Busbar compartment
3 ■ Device compartment
■ Cable connection compartment
■ Cross-wiring compartment
In 400 mm deep cubicles, the busbar com-
partment is at the top; in 600 mm deep
4 cubicles it is at the rear. In double-front
systems (1000 mm depth) and in a power
control center (1200 mm depth), the bus-
bar compartment is located centrally.
The switching device compartment
5 accommodates switchgear and auxiliary
equipment.
The cable connection compartment is lo-
cated on the right-hand side of the cubicle.
With circuit-breaker design, however, it is
below the switching device compartment 600 400 400 400 400
6 (Fig. 4).
The cross-wiring compartment is located
at the top front and is provided for leading
control and loop lines from cubicle to
cubicle.
7
10
Dimensions in mm
4/4 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Low-Voltage Switchboards
Busbar system
1
Together with the PEN or PE busbars,
and if applicable the N busbars, the phase
conductor busbars L1, L2 and L3 form
the busbar system of a switchboard. Top space Switching device compartment
One or more distribution buses 2
and/or incoming and outgoing feeders
can be connected to a horizontal main
busbar. Depending on requirements, 225 225
this main busbar passes through several
cubicles and can be linked with another
main busbar via a coupling. 3
A vertical distribution busbar is connected
with the main busbar and supplies
outgoing feeders within a cubicle. 2200 10 x 10 x
175 175
In a 400 mm deep cubicle (Fig. 5a) the
phase conductors of the main busbar are 4
always at the top; the PEN or PE and N
conductors are always at the bottom.
The maximum rated current at 35 °C is
1965 A (non-ventilated), and 2250 A (venti-
225 225
lated); the maximum short-circuit strength
is Ipk = 110 kA or Icw = 50 kA, respectively. 400 200 400
5
In single-front systems with 600 mm
cubicle depth (Fig. 5b), the main busbars Bottom space
are behind the switching device compart- a) b)
ment. In double-front systems of 1000 mm
depth (Fig. 5c), they are between the two 6
switching device compartments (central).
The phase conductors can be arranged at
the top or bottom; PEN, PE and N conduc-
tors are always at the bottom. The maxi-
mum rated current is at 35 °C 3250 A
(non-ventilated) or 3500 A (ventilated); 7
Ipk = 250 kA or Icw = 100 kA, respectively. 225 225
In 1200 mm deep systems (power control
center) (Fig. 5d) the conductors are
arranged as for double-front systems, but
in duplicate; the phase conductors are 8
always at the top. The maximum rated
current at 35 °C is 4850 A (non-ventilated) 2200 10 x 2200 10 x
or 6300 A (ventilated); Ipk = 220 kA, 175 175
Icw = 100 kA.
225 225
c) d)
Dimensions in mm
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 4/5
Low-Voltage Switchboards
Installation designs
1
The following designs are available
for the duties specified:
■ Circuit-breaker design
■ Withdrawable-unit design
2 ■ Plug-in design
■ Fixed-mounted design
Circuit-breaker design
3
Distribution boards for substantial energy
requirements are generally followed by
a number of subdistribution boards and
loads. Particular demands are therefore
4 made in terms of long-term reliability and
safety. That is to say, ”supply“, ”coupling“
and ”feeder“ functions must be reliably
available over long periods of time. Mainte-
nance and testing must not involve long
standstill times. The circuit-breaker design
5 components meet these requirements.
The circuit-breaker cubicles have separate
function spaces for a switching device
compartment, auxiliary equipment com-
partment and cable/busbar connection
6 compartment (Fig. 7).
The auxiliary equipment compartment is
above the switching device compartment.
The cable or busbar connection compart-
ment is located below. With supply from
7 above, the arrangement is a like a mirror
image. The cubicle width is determined by
the breaker rated current.
IN to 1600 400/500
Fig. 7: Circuit-breaker cubicle with withdrawable circuit-breaker 3WN, 1600 A rated current
IN to 2500 600
IN to 3200 800
9 IN to 6300 1000
The high short-time current-carrying capaci- In the test position the auxiliary contacts
ty for time-graded short-circuit protection are closed. In the disconnected position
(up to 500 ms) assures reliable operation both main and auxiliary contacts are open.
Fig. 6 of sections of the switchboard not affected Mechanical interlocks ensure that, in the
by a short circuit. process of moving from one position to
Circuit-breaker design 3WN
With the aid of short-time grading control another, the circuit-breaker always reaches
10 The 3WN circuit-breakers in withdrawable- for very brief delay times (50 ms), the the OPEN state or that closing is not
unit or fixed-mounted design are used stresses and damage suffered by a switch- possible when the breaker is between
for incoming supply, outgoing feeders and board in the event of a short-circuit can be two positions.
couplings (longitudinal and transverse). substantially minimized, regardless of the The circuit-breaker is always moved with
The operational current can be shown on preset delay time of the switching device the door closed. The actual position in
an LCD display in the control panel; there concerned. which it is can be telecommunicated via
is consequently no need for an ammeter The withdrawable circuit-breaker has a signaling switch.
or current transformer. three positions between which it can be A kit, switch or withdrawable unit can
moved with the aid of a crank or spindle be used for grounding and short-circuiting.
mechanism. In the connected position the
main and auxiliary contacts are closed.
4/6 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Low-Voltage Switchboards
10
Fig. 8: High packing density with up to 40 feeders per Fig. 9: SIVACON withdrawable units size 1, size 1/4 and 1/2
cubicle
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 4/7
Low-Voltage Switchboards
10
Fig. 11: Operating error protection prevents travel of the isolating contacts when the master switch is “ON”
4/8 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Low-Voltage Switchboards
4
X19 = Auxiliary isolating contact
S20 = Alarm switch in withdrawable unit*
S21 = Alarm switch in compartment*
5
WU = Withdrawable unit
Compt. = Compartment
7
Main isolating Aux. isolating In with- In compartment
contact contact drawable unit
- S 20 - S 21
1 NO 1 NC
8
Connected
9
*
Disconnected
10
Test
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 4/9
Low-Voltage Switchboards
Type [A]
7 D306 35 1/4 / 1/2
3KL50 63 1
3KL52 125 1
3KL53 160 2
8 3KL55 250 2
3KL57 400 2
3KL61 630 3
Rated currents – non-fused and with-
drawable unit sizes of cable feeders Device Rated With-
current drawable
9 unit
size
Type [A]
3RV101 12 1/4 / 1/2
10
I
3RV102 25 1/4 / 1/2 / 1
3RV103 50 1/2 / 1
3RV104 160 1
3VF3 160 1
3VF4 250 2
3VF5 400 2
3VF6 630 4
Fig. 14
4/10 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Low-Voltage Switchboards
400 V 500 V 690 V 400 V 500 V 690 V 400 V 500 V 690 V 400 V 500 V 690 V
11 11 11 7.5 7.5 11 5.5 5.5 5.5 – – – 1/4
18.5 22 22 15 15 22 18.5 22 22 – – – 1/2 7
22 22 37 22 30 37 22 22 22 30 37 55 1
75 90 90 45 55 90 45 55 55 55 75 90 2
160 200 160 90 132 132 110 132 160 132 160 160 3
250 355 500 160 200 375 250 315 375 – – – 4 8
– – – 250 315 400 3+3
– – – 355 355 500 4+4
Fig. 15
9
10
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 4/11
Low-Voltage Switchboards
3 I I I
5
Coordination type 1
400 V 500 V 690 V 400 V 500 V 690 V 400 V 500 V 690 V 400 V 500 V 690 V
7 11 11 – 4 3 – 5.5 5.5 – – – – 1/4
18.5 18.5 – 11 15 – 11 11 – – – – 1/2
22 30 – 11 15 – 22 30 – 22 30 – 1
75 90 – 37 45 – 75 90 – 55 75 – 2
8 160 200 – 132 160 – 160 200 – 110 132 – 3
250 250 – 160 200 – 250 315 – 200 250 – 4
Coordination type 2
9 Full-voltage Full-voltage Full-voltage Star-delta starters Withdrawable
non-reversing (FVNR) non-reversing (FVNR) reversing (FVR) [kW] unit size
motor starters motor starters motor starters
Normal-duty start [kW] Heavy-duty start [kW] Reversing circuit [kW]
10 400 V 500 V 690 V 400 V 500 V 690 V 400 V 500 V 690 V 400 V 500 V 690 V
4/12 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Low-Voltage Switchboards
Coordination type 1
Full-voltage non-reversing (FVNR) Full-voltage reversing (FVR) Modulheight 8
motor starters motor starters [mm]
Normal-duty start [kW] Reversing circuit [kW]
400 V 400 V
11 – 50 9
45 11 100
– 45 200
Coordination type 2
10
Full-voltage non-reversing (FVNR) Full-voltage reversing (FVR) Modulheight
motor starters motor starters [mm]
Normal-duty start [kW] Reversing circuit [kW]
400 V 400 V
7.5 – 50
45 7.5 100
– 45 200
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 4/13
Low-Voltage Switchboards
3NJ6110 160 50
Fig. 21: Rated currents and installation data of in-line-type switching devices
4/14 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Low-Voltage Switchboards
Fixed-mounted design
1
In certain applications, e.g. in building
installation systems, either there is no
need to replace components under
operating conditions or short standstill
times do not result in exceptional costs.
In such cases the fixed-mounted design
2
(Fig. 22) offers excellent economy, high
reliability and flexibility by virtue of:
■ Any combination of modular function
units
■ Easy replacement of function units after 3
deenergizing the switchboard
■ Brief modification or standstill times
by virtue of lateral vertical cubicle
busbars
■ Add-on components for subdivision and 4
even compartmentalization in accord-
ance with requirements.
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 4/15
Low-Voltage Switchboards
Communication with
1 PROFIBUS® -DP
With SIMOCODE®-DP for motor and
cable feeders and the interface DP/3WN
for circuit-breakers type 3WN, SIVACON
2 offers an economical possibility of ex-
changing data with automation systems.
The widespread standardized, cross-manu-
facturer-PROFIBUS®-DP serves as the bus
system, offering links to a very diverse
range of programmable controllers.
3 ■ Easy installation planning
■ Saving in wiring
Communication-capable circuit-breaker
3WN (Fig. 25)
4
■ Remote-control for opening and closing
■ Remote diagnostics for preventive main-
tenance
■ Signalling of operating states Fig. 24 Fig. 25: 3WN circuit-breaker
5 ■ Transmission of current values e.g. for
power management
Communication-capable motor
protection and control device
6 SIMOCODE-DP (Fig. 26)
■ Integrated full motor protection
■ Extensive control functions
■ Convenient diagnostics possibilities
■ Autonomous operation of each feeder
7 via an operator control block
Fig. 26: SIMOCODE-DP in size 1/4 withdrawable unit Fig. 27: AS-interface modules 41
10
4/16 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Low-Voltage Switchboards
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 4/17
Low-Voltage Switchboards
Fig. 31 1 1
7 2 2 2 2
4 4
4 4 4 4 4 4
3 3
4 4
8 4 4
4 4
9
Form 4a Form 4b
1 1
2 2 2 2
10 4 4
4 4 4 4 4 4
3 3
4 4
4 4
4 4
4/18 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Low-Voltage Switchboards
Mounting 75
38.5
Cubicle depths 400 mm and 600 mm: Cubicle width - 100
■ Wall- or 7
■ Floor-mounting Cubicle width
Cubicle depths 1000 mm and 1200 mm:
■ Floor-mounting Cubicle depth 1000 mm, 1200 mm
The following minimum clearances
25 Diameter 14.1 8
between the switchboard and any
obstacles must be observed:
75
Clearances 250
9
1000
Cubicle or
100 mm 75 mm 100 mm depth - 77 1200
Switchboard 250 10
38.5 75
Cubicle width - 100
Fig. 34
Cubicle width
There must be a minimum clearance of
400 mm between the top and sides of the Free space for cables and
cubicle and any obstacles. bar penetrations
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 4/19
Low-Voltage Switchboards
600 600
4
700 700 700 700
Dimensions of lifting truck [mm]
1) Minimum gangway height under covers or enclosures Height 2000
Width 680
5
Depth 920
Approx. 1500
6
Fig. 37
7
Min. gangway width Free min. width
Escape route 600 or 700 mm 500 mm1)
2)
8
Dimensions in mm
For further information please contact:
Fax: ++ 49 - 3 41- 4 47 04 00
Fig. 36: Reduced gangways in area of open doors www.ad.siemens.de
4/20 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Transformers
Contents Page
Introduction ....................................... 5/2
Product Range .................................. 5/3
Electrical Design .............................. 5/4
Transformer Loss Evaluation ......... 5/6
Mechanical Design ......................... 5/8
Connection Systems ....................... 5/9
Accessories and
Protective Devices ........................ 5/11
Technical Data
Distribution Transformers ............ 5/13
Technical Data
Power Transformers ...................... 5/18
On-load Tap Changers .................. 5/26
Cast-resin Dry-type
Transformers, GEAFOL .................. 5/27
Technical Data
GEAFOL Cast-resin
Dry-type Transformers .................. 5/31
Special Transformers .................... 5/35
5
Ohne Namen-1 1 22.09.1999, 16:22 Uhr
Introduction
Transformers are one of the primary In addition, there are various special- Standards and specifications, general
components for the transmission and purpose transformers such as converter
The transformers comply with the relevant
1 distribution of electrical energy. transformers, which can be both in the
VDE specifications, i.e. DIN VDE 0532
Their design results mainly from the range range of power transformers and in the
”Transformers and reactors“ and the
of application, the construction, the rated range of distribution transformers as far
”Technical conditions of supply for three-
power and the voltage level. as rated power and rated voltage are con-
phase transformers“ issued by VDEW
The scope of transformer types starts with cerned.
and ZVEI.
2 generator transformers and ends with dis- As special elements for network stabili-
Therefore they also satisfy the require-
tribution transformers. zation, arc-suppression coils and com-
ments of IEC Publication 76, Parts 1 to 5
Transformers which are directly connected pensating reactors are available. Arc-sup-
together with the standards and specifi-
to the generator of the power station are pression coils compensate the capacitive
cations (HD and EN) of the European
called generator transformers. Their power current flowing through a ground fault and
Union (EU).
range goes up to far above 1000 MVA. thus guarantee uninterrupted energy sup-
3 Their voltage range extends to approx. ply. Compensating reactors compensate Enquiries should be directed to the manu-
1500 kV. the capacitive power of the cable networks facturer where other standards and spe-
and reduce overvoltages in case of load cifications are concerned. Only the US
The connection between the different high-
rejection; the economic efficiency and (ANSI/NEMA) and Canadian (CSA) stand-
voltage system levels is made via network
stablility of the power transmission are im- ards differ from IEC by any substantial de-
transformers (network interconnecting
proved. gree. A design according to these stand-
4 transformers). Their power range exceeds
ards is also possible.
1000 MVA. The voltage range exceeds The general overview of our manufactur-
1500 kV. ing/delivery program is shown in the
Distribution transformers are within the table ”Product Range“. Important additional standards
range from 50 to 2500 kVA and max. ■ DIN 42 500, HD 428: oil-immersed
36 kV. In the last step, they distribute three-phase distribution transformers
5 the electrical energy to the consumers Rated Max. Figs. 50–2500 kVA
by feeding from the high-voltage into the power operating on ■ DIN 42 504: oil-immersed three-phase
low-voltage distribution network. These voltage page transformers 2–10 MVA
are designed either as liquid-filled or as
[MVA] [kV] ■ DIN 42 508: oil-immersed three-phase
dry-type transformers.
transformers 12.5–80 MVA
6 Transformers with a rated power up to ■ DIN 42 523, HD 538: three-phase
2.5 MVA and a voltage up to 36 kV are Oil 0.05–2.5 ≤ 36 5/13– dry-type transformers 100–2500 kVA
referred to as distribution transformers; distribution 5/17 ■ DIN 45 635 T30: noise level
all transformers of higher ratings are transformers
classified as power transformers. ■ IEC 289: reactance coils and neutral
grounding transformers
Power 2.5–3000 36–1500 5/18–
7 transformers 5/25 ■ IEC 551: measurement of noise level
■ IEC 726: dry-type transformers
GEAFOL- 0.10–20 ≤ 36 5/27– ■ RAL: coating/varnish
cast-resin 5/34
transformers
8
Fig. 1: Transformer types
10
5/2 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
2
Generator and power Above 2.5 MVA up to more than 1000 MVA, above 30 kV up to 1500 kV
transformers (system and system interconnecting transformers, with separate windings or
auto-connected), with on-load tap changers or off-circuit tap changers,
of three- or single-phase design
3
Cast-resin distribution 100 kVA to more than 20 MVA, highest voltage for equipment up to 36 kV,
and power transformers of three- or single-phase design
GEAFOL GEAFOL®-SL substations
4
5
Special transformers Furnace and converter transformers
for industry, traction Traction transformers mounted on rolling stock and appropriate on-load tap-changers
and HVDC transmission Substation transformers for traction systems
systems Transformers for train heating and point heating
Transformers for HVDC transmission systems 6
Transformers for audio frequencies in power supply systems
Three-phase neutral electromagnetic couplers and grounding transformers
Ignition transformers
7
Reactors Liquid-immersed shunt and current-limiting reactors up to
the highest rated powers
Reactors for HVDC transmission systems
8
10
Service Advisory services for transformer specifications
Organization, coordination and supervision of transportation
Supervision of assembly and commissioning
Service/inspection troubleshooting services
Training of customer personnel
Investigation and assessment of oil problems
Fig. 2
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 5/3
5/4 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 5/5
Fig. 5
5/6 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
2
Example: 1600 kVA distribution transformer
9
Total cost of owning and operating this Total cost of owning and operating this
transformer is thus: transformer is thus:
DM 44 984.–/year DM 37 844.–/year
10
The energy saving of the optimized distribution transformer of DM 7140 per year
pays for the increased purchase price in less than one year.
Fig. 6
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 5/7
5/8 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Distribution transformers
1
All Siemens transformers have top-mount-
ed HV and LV bushings according to DIN in
their standard version. Besides the open
bushing arrangement for direct connection
of bare or insulated wires, three basic insu-
lated termination systems are available: 2
Fully enclosed terminal box for cables
(Fig. 11)
Available for either HV or LV side, or for
both. Horizontally split design in degree 3
of protection IP 44 or IP 54. (Totally en-
closed and fully protected against contact
with live parts, plus protection against drip,
splash, or spray water.)
Cable installation through split cable glands 4
and removable plates facing diagonally
downwards. Optional conduit hubs. Suit- Fig. 11: Fully enclosed cable connection box
able for single-core or three-phase cables
with solid dielectric insulation, with or
without stress cones. Multiple cables per
phase are terminated on auxiliary bus 5
structures attached to the bushings. Re-
moval of transformer by simply bending
back the cables.
HV LV 10
Cable box Cable box
Cable box Flange/throat
Flange Cable box
Flange Flange/throat
Elbow connector Cable box
Elbow connector Flange/throat
Fig. 10: Combination of connection systems Fig 13: Flange connection for switchgear and bus ducts
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 5/9
Power transformers
1
The most frequently used type of connec-
tion for transformers is the outdoor bush-
ing.
Depending on voltage, current, system
2 conditions and transport requirements, the
transformers will be supplied with bush-
ings arranged vertically, horizontally or in-
clined. Up to about 110 kV it is usual to
use oil-filled bushings according to DIN;
condenser bushings are normally used for
3 higher voltages.
Limited space or other design considera-
tions often make it necessary to connect
cables directly to the transformer. For volt-
ages up to 30 kV air-filled cable boxes are
4 used. For higher voltages the boxes are
oil-filled. They may be attached to the tank
cover or to its walls (Fig. 14).
The space-saving design of SF6-insulated
switchgear is one of its major advantages.
The substation transformer is connected
5 directly to the SF6 switchgear. This elimi-
nates the need for an intermediate link
(cable, overhead line) between transform-
er and system (Fig. 15).
6
Fig. 14: Transformers with oil-filled HV cable boxes
10
5/10 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 5/11
8 Additional accessories
Besides the standard accessories and pro-
tective devices there are additional items
available, especially for large power trans-
formers. They will be offered and installed
9 on request.
Examples are:
■ Fiber-optic temperature measurements
■ Permanent gas-in-oil analysis
■ Permanent water-content measurement
10
■ Sudden pressure rise relay,
etc.
Fig. 21: Dehydrating breather A DIN 42 567 Fig. 22: Dehydrating breather L DIN 42 562
up to 5 MVA over 5 MVA
5/12 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Oil-immersed TUMETIC 12
and TUNORMA three-phase 11 1
10 3 8
distribution transformers
2N 2U 2V 2W
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 5/13
Rated Max. Impe- Type Combi- No-load Load Sound Sound Total Dimensions Dist.
power rated dance nation of losses losses press. power weight between
1 volt. voltage losses level level Length Width Height wheel
HV acc. 1m A1 B1 H1 centers
side CENELEC toler-
TUNORMA
TUNORMA
TUNORMA
TUNORMA
TUNORMA
TUMETIC
TUMETIC
TUMETIC
TUMETIC
TUMETIC
ance
+ 3 dB
2 Sn Um U2 P0 Pk 75* LPA LWA E
[kVA] [kV] [%] 4JB… 4HB… [W] [W] [dB] [dB] [kg] [mm] [mm] [mm] [mm]
50 12 4 ..4744-3LB B-A' 190 1350 42 55 340 350 860 980 660 660 1210 1085 520
3 4 ..4744-3RB A-C' 125 1100 34 47 400 430 825 1045 660 660 1210 1085 520
4 ..4744-3TB C-C' 125 875 34 47 420 440 835 985 660 660 1220 1095 520
24 4 ..4767-3LB B-A' 190 1350 42 55 370 380 760 860 660 660 1315 1235 520
4 ..4767-3RB A-C' 125 1100 34 47 430 460 860 860 660 660 1300 1220 520
4
4 ..4767-3TB C-C' 125 875 33 47 480 510 880 1100 685 660 1385 1265 520
36 6 ..4780-3CB E-D´ 230 1450 x 52 500 x 1000 x 710 x 1530 x 520
100 12 4 ..5044-3LB B-A' 320 2150 45 59 500 500 1090 1020 660 660 1275 1110 520
5
4 ..5044-3RB A-C' 210 1750 35 49 570 570 980 980 660 660 1315 1145 520
4 ..5044-3TB C-C' 210 1475 35 49 600 620 1030 930 660 660 1320 1150 520
24 4 ..5067-3LB B-A' 320 2150 45 59 520 530 1020 1140 685 660 1360 1245 520
6 4 ..5067-3RB A-C' 210 1750 35 49 600 610 1030 1030 690 660 1400 1280 520
4 ..5067-3TB C-C' 210 1475 35 49 640 680 960 1060 695 660 1425 1305 520
36 6 ..5080-3CB E-D´ 380 2350 x 56 660 x 1050 x 780 x 1600 x 520
7 160 12 4 ..5244 -3LA B-A' 460 3100 47 62 620 610 1140 1140 710 710 1350 1185 520
4 ..5244-3RA A-C' 300 2350 37 52 700 690 1130 1010 660 660 1390 1220 520
4 ..5244-3TA C-C' 300 2000 38 52 760 780 985 1085 660 660 1380 1215 520
8 24 4 ..5267-3LA B-A' 460 3100 47 62 660 640 1150 1150 695 660 1440 1320 520
4 ..5267-3RA A-C' 300 2350 37 52 730 730 1030 930 695 660 1540 1420 520
4 ..5267-3TA C-C' 300 2000 37 52 800 820 1120 1120 710 660 1475 1355 520
36 6 ..5280-3CA E-D´ 520 3350 x 59 900 x 1120 x 800 x 1700 x 520
9
(200) 12 4 ..5344-3LA B-A' 550 3600 48 63 720 710 1190 1190 680 680 1450 1285 520
4 ..5344-3RA A-C' 360 2760 38 53 840 830 1070 1120 660 660 1470 1300 520
4 ..5344-3TA C-C' 360 2350 38 53 900 920 1130 1130 660 680 1450 1285 520
10
24 4 ..5367-3LA B-A' 550 3600 48 63 800 780 1290 1290 820 800 1595 1425 520
4 ..5367-3RA A-C' 360 2760 38 53 890 910 1110 1230 755 680 1630 1460 520
4 ..5367-3TA C-C' 360 2350 38 53 950 980 1080 1180 705 690 1595 1430 520
36 6 ..5380-3CA E-D´ 600 3800 x 61 1000 x 1250 x 800 x 1700 x 520
Dimensions and weights are approximate values. Rated power figures in parentheses are not standardized. x: on request
* In case of short-circuits at 75 °C
5/14 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Rated Max. Impe- Type Combi- No-load Load Sound Sound Total Dimensions Dist.
power rated dance nation of losses losses press. power weight between 1
volt. voltage losses level level Length Width Height wheel
HV acc. 1m A1 B1 H1 centers
side CENELEC toler-
TUNORMA
TUNORMA
TUNORMA
TUNORMA
TUNORMA
TUMETIC
TUMETIC
TUMETIC
TUMETIC
TUMETIC
ance
+ 3 dB
250 12 4 ..5444-3LA B-A' 650 4200 50 65 830 820 1300 1300 810 810 1450 1285 520
4 ..5444-3RA A-C' 425 3250 40 55 940 920 1260 1260 670 820 1480 1415 520 3
4 ..5444-3TA C-C' 425 2750 40 55 1050 1070 1220 1220 690 700 1530 1310 520
24 4 ..5467-3LA B-A' 650 4200 49 65 920 900 1340 1340 800 760 1620 1450 520
4 ..5467-3RA A-C' 425 3250 39 55 1010 1010 1140 1190 760 680 1675 1510 520
4
4 ..5467-3TA C-C' 425 2750 40 55 1120 1140 1220 1340 715 710 1640 1475 520
36 6 ..5480-3CA E-E´ 650 4250 x 62 1100 x 1350 x 800 x 1680 x 520
(315) 12 4 ..5544-3LA B-A' 780 5000 50 66 980 960 1440 1330 820 820 1655 1385 670
5
4 ..5544-3RA A-C' 510 3850 40 56 1120 1100 1400 1250 820 820 1690 1415 670
4 ..5544-3TA C-C' 510 3250 40 56 1240 1260 1380 1260 820 820 1665 1390 670
24 4 ..5567-3LA B-A' 780 5000 50 66 1050 1030 1450 1350 840 840 1655 1510 670
4 ..5567-3RA A-C' 510 3850 40 56 1170 1150 1410 1270 820 820 1755 1610 670
6
4 ..5567-3TA C-C' 510 3250 40 56 1250 1280 1395 1290 820 820 1675 1540 670
36 6 ..5580-3CA E-E´ 760 5400 x 64 1220 x 1420 x 960 x 1700 x 670
400 12 4 ..5644-3LA B-A' 930 6000 52 68 1180 1160 1470 1390 930 930 1700 1425 670 7
4 ..5644-3RA A-C' 610 4600 42 58 1320 1310 1400 1360 820 820 1700 1430 670
4 ..5644-3TA C-C' 610 3850 42 58 1470 1470 1410 1390 820 820 1695 1420 670
24 4 ..5667-3LA B-A' 930 6000 52 68 1240 1220 1570 1570 940 940 1655 1510 670 8
4 ..5667-3RA A-C' 610 4600 42 58 1370 1350 1475 1400 820 820 1760 1615 670
4 ..5667-3TA C-C' 610 3850 42 58 1490 1520 1440 1400 820 820 1765 1540 670
36 6 ..5580-3CA E-E´ 930 6200 x 65 1480 x 1470 x 990 x 1830 x 670
9
(500) 12 4 ..5744-3LA B-A' 1100 7100 53 69 1410 1380 1500 1430 840 840 1710 1440 670
4 ..5744-3RA A-C' 720 5450 42 59 1650 1620 1560 1550 890 890 1745 1470 670
4 ..5744-3TA C-C' 720 4550 43 59 1700 1710 1500 1470 820 820 1745 1470 670
10
24 4 ..5767-3LA B-A' 1100 7100 53 69 1460 1440 1470 1530 835 850 1755 1610 670
4 ..5767-3RA A-C' 720 5450 42 59 1650 1620 1495 1420 835 820 1815 1665 670
4 ..5767-3TA C-C' 720 4550 43 59 1860 1910 1535 1500 820 820 1860 1645 670
36 6 ..5780-3CA E-E´ 1050 7800 x 66 1680 x 1510 x 1030 x 1900 x 670
Dimensions and weights are approximate values. Rated power figures in parentheses are not standardized. x: on request
* In case of short-circuits at 75 °C
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 5/15
Rated Max. Impe- Type Combi- No-load Load Sound Sound Total Dimensions Dist.
power rated dance nation of losses losses press. power weight between
1 volt. voltage losses level level Length Width Height wheel
HV acc. 1m A1 B1 H1 centers
side CENELEC toler-
TUNORMA
TUNORMA
TUNORMA
TUNORMA
TUNORMA
TUMETIC
TUMETIC
TUMETIC
TUMETIC
TUMETIC
ance
+ 3 dB
630 12 4 ..5844-3LA B-A' 1300 8400 53 70 1660 1660 1680 1480 880 880 1755 1585 670
4 ..5844-3RA A-C' 860 6500 43 60 1850 1810 1495 1420 835 820 1785 1510 670
3
4 ..5844-3TA C-C' 860 5400 43 60 2000 1990 1535 1380 820 820 1860 1520 670
6 ..5844-3PA B-A' 1200 8700 53 70 1750 1760 1720 1560 890 890 1920 1685 670
6 ..5844-3SA A-C' 800 6750 43 60 1950 1920 1665 1600 870 870 1740 1400 670
4
6 ..5844-3UA C-C' 800 5600 43 60 2160 2130 1670 1560 830 830 1840 1500 670
24 4 ..5867-3LA B-A' 1300 8400 53 70 1690 1650 1665 1640 860 860 1810 1595 670
4 ..5867-3RA A-C' 860 6500 43 60 1940 1920 1685 1680 870 870 1910 1695 670
5
4 ..5867-3TA C-C' 860 5400 43 60 2100 2130 1600 1490 820 820 1940 1725 670
6 ..5867-3PA B-A' 1200 8700 53 70 1730 1720 1780 1580 880 880 1760 1610 670
6 ..5867-3SA A-C' 800 6750 43 60 1970 1960 1645 1640 830 830 1810 1595 670
6 6 ..5867-3UA C-C' 800 5600 43 60 2240 2210 1740 1670 880 880 1840 1625 670
36 6 ..5880-3CA E-E´ 1300 8800 x 67 1950 x 1740 x 1080 x 1940 x 670
(800) 12 6 ..5944-3PA B-A' 1450 10700 55 72 1990 1960 1780 1540 1000 1000 1905 1660 670
7 6 ..5944-3SA A-C' 950 8500 45 62 2210 2290 1720 1830 900 960 1935 1630 670
6 ..5944-3UA C-C' 950 7400 44 62 2520 2490 1760 1710 920 920 1975 1730 670
24 6 ..5967-3PA B-A' 1450 10700 55 72 2000 1950 1720 1710 1000 1000 1885 1670 670
8 6 ..5967-3SA A-C' 950 8500 45 62 2390 2340 1760 1710 960 960 1945 1730 670
6 ..5967-3UA C-C' 950 7400 44 62 2590 2550 1770 1700 930 930 1985 1780 670
36 6 ..5980-3CA E-E´ 1520 11000 x 68 2400 x 1800 x 1100 x 2030 x 670
1000 12 6 ..6044-3PA B-A' 1700 13000 55 73 2450 2640 1790 1630 1000 1000 2095 2070 820
9
6 ..6044-3SA A-C' 1100 10500 45 63 2660 2610 1830 1830 1040 1040 2025 1770 820
6 ..6044-3UA C-C' 1100 9500 45 63 2800 2750 1830 1830 1040 1040 2105 1840 820
24 6 ..6067-3PA B-A' 1700 13000 55 73 2530 2720 1830 1670 1090 1010 2095 2120 820
10
6 ..6067-3SA A-C' 1100 10500 45 63 2750 2690 1790 1740 1050 1050 2055 1840 820
6 ..6067-3UA C-C' 1100 9500 45 63 2830 2810 1725 1770 990 990 2065 1850 820
36 6 ..6080 -3CA E-E´ 1700 13000 x 68 2850 x 2120 x 1160 x 2220 x 820
Dimensions and weights are approximate values. Rated power figures in parentheses are not standardized. x: on request
* In case of short-circuits at 75 °C
5/16 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Rated Max. Impe- Type Combi- No-load Load Sound Sound Total Dimensions Dist.
power rated dance nation of losses losses press. power weight between
volt. voltage losses level level Length Width Height wheel 1
HV acc. 1m A1 B1 H1 centers
side CENELEC toler-
TUNORMA
TUNORMA
TUNORMA
TUNORMA
TUNORMA
TUMETIC
TUMETIC
TUMETIC
TUMETIC
TUMETIC
ance
+ 3 dB
(1250) 12 6 ..6144-3PA B-A' 2100 16000 56 74 2900 3080 1930 1850 1260 1100 2110 2070 820
6 ..6144-3SA A-C' 1300 13200 46 64 3100 3040 1810 1780 990 990 2145 1880 820
3
6 ..6144-3UA C-C' 1300 11400 46 64 3340 3040 1755 1720 1015 1000 2235 1970 820
24 6 ..6167-3PA B-A' 2100 16000 56 74 2950 3200 2020 1780 1260 1100 2110 2220 820
6 ..6167-3SA A-C' 1300 13200 46 64 3190 3120 1840 1810 1060 1060 2115 1900 820
4
6 ..6167-3UA C-C' 1300 11400 46 64 3390 3330 1810 1780 1015 990 2245 2030 820
36 6 ..6180-3CA E-E´ 2150 16400 x 70 3360 x 2150 x 1250 x 2350 x 820
1600 12 6 ..6244-3PA B-A' 2600 20000 57 76 3450 3590 1970 1870 1220 1140 2315 2095 820
6 ..6244-3SA A-C' 1700 17000 47 66 3640 3590 2030 1760 1080 1090 2315 2010 820
5
6 ..6244-3UA C-C' 1700 14000 47 66 3930 3880 2020 1900 1110 1100 2395 2070 820
24 6 ..6267-3PA B-A' 2600 20000 57 76 3470 3690 2070 1830 1280 1120 2335 2320 820
6 ..6267-3SA A-C' 1700 17000 47 66 3670 3850 2030 2000 1230 1070 2265 2120 820 6
6 ..6267-3UA C-C' 1700 14000 47 66 4010 3950 2000 1850 1030 1030 2305 2010 820
6 ..6444-3UA C-C' 2500 22000 51 71 5790 5660 2190 2190 1330 1330 2565 2240 1070
10
24 6 ..6467-3PA B-A' 3500 29000 61 81 5420 5220 2115 2030 1335 1330 2785 2675 1070
6 ..6467-3SA A-C' 2500 26500 51 71 5260 5220 2195 2030 1335 1335 2585 2580 1070
6 ..6467-3UA C-C' 2500 22000 51 71 5640 5470 2160 2080 1330 1330 2605 2305 1070
36 6 ..6480-3CA E-E´ 3800 29400 x 76 5900 x 2320 x 1390 x 2790 x 1070
Dimensions and weights are approximate values. Rated power figures in parentheses are not standardized. x: on request
* In case of short-circuits at 75 °C
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 5/17
Oil-immersed three-phase
1 power transformers with off- Rated power HV range Type of Figure/
and on-load tap changers tap changer page
[MVA] [kV]
Cooling methods
2 Transformers up to 10 MVA are designed 3.15 to 10 25 to 123 off-load Fig. 31, page 5/19
for ONAN cooling.
By adding fans to these transformers, the 3.15 to 10 25 to 123 on-load Fig. 33, page 5/20
rating can be increased by 25%.
However, in general it is more economical 10/16 to 20/31.5 up to 36 off-load Fig. 35, page 5/21
to select higher ONAN ratings rather than
3 to add fans. 10/16 to 20/31.5 up to 36 on-load Fig. 38, page 5/22
Transformers larger than 10 MVA are de-
signed with ONAN/ONAF cooling. 10/16 to 63/100 72.5 to 145 on-load Fig. 41, page 5/23
Explanation of cooling methods:
Note: Off-load tap changers are designed to be operated de-energized only.
■ ONAN: Oil-natural, air-natural cooling
4 Fig. 30: Types of power transformers
■ ONAF: Oil-natural, air-forced cooling (in
one or two steps)
The arrangement with the attached radia-
tors, as shown in the illustrations, is the
preferred design. However, other arrange-
5 ments of the cooling equipment are also
possible.
Depending on transportation possibilities
the bushings, radiators and expansion tank
have be removed. If necessary, the oil has
6 to be drained and shipped separately.
10
5/18 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Oil-immersed three-phase
power transformers with 1
off-load tap changer
3 150–10 000 kVA,
HV rating: up to 123 kV
2
■ Taps on
HV side: ± 2 x 2.5 % H
■ Rated frequency: 50 Hz
■ Impedance 6-10 %
voltage: 3
■ Connection: HV winding: star-
delta connection
alternatively available E E L
up to 24 kV
LV winding: W
star or delta
4
Fig. 31
5
Rated power HV rating LV rating No-load Load loss Total Oil Dimensions E
loss at 75 °C weight weight L/W/H
[kVA] [kV] [kV] [kW] [kW] [kg] [kg] [mm] [mm]
ONAN
6
3150 6.1–36 3–24 4.6 28 7200 1600 2800/1850/2870 1070
Fig. 32
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 5/19
Oil-immersed three-phase
1 power transformers
with on-load tap changer
3 150–10 000 kVA,
HV rating: up to 123 kV
2 H
■ Taps on ± 16 % in ± 8 steps
HV side: of 2 %
■ Rated frequency: 50 Hz
■ Impedance 6–10 %
3 voltage:
■ Connection: HV winding: star E E L
LV winding: W
star or delta
4 Fig. 33
Rated power HV rating LV rating No-load Load loss Total Oil Dimensions E
loss at 75 °C weight weight L/W/H
5
[kVA] [kV] [kV] kW [kW] [kg] [kg] [mm] [mm]
ONAN
Fig. 34
5/20 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Oil-immersed three-phase
power transformers 1
with off-load tap changer
10/16 to 20/31.5 MVA
HV rating: up to 36 kV H
Hs 2
■ Rated frequency: 50 Hz, tapping range
± 2 x 2.5 %
■ Connection of star
HV winding:
■ Connection of star or delta E E L 3
LV winding: W Ls
■ Cooling method: ONAN/ONAF
Ws
■ LV range: 6 kV to 36 kV
Fig. 35
4
10 16 12 31 80 6.3 10
12.5 20 14 37 95 6.3 10 6
16 25 16 45 110 6.4 10
Fig. 36
7
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 5/21
Oil-immersed three-phase
1 power transformer
with on-load tap changer
10/16 to 20/31.5 MVA,
HV rating: up to 36 kV
H
2
Hs
■ Rated frequency: 50 Hz, tapping range
± 16 % in ± 9 steps
■ Connection of star
HV winding:
3 ■ Connection of star or delta Ls Ws
LV winding: W
L
■ Cooling method: ONAN/ONAF
■ LV range: 6 kV to 36 kV
Fig. 38
4
10 16 12 31 80 6.3 10
6 12.5 20 14 37 95 6.3 10
16 25 16 45 111 6.4 10
20 31.5 5300 2550 4600 41 000 9000 5000 1700 3000 37000
10
Fig. 40
5/22 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Oil-immersed three-phase
Rated power at No-load Load loss at Impedance voltage of
power transformers with ONAN ONAF loss ONAN ONAF ONAN ONAF 1
on-load tap changer
10/16 to 63/100 MVA, [MVA] [MVA] [kW] [kW] [kW] [%] [%]
HV rating: from 72.5 to 145 kV
10 16 13 42 108 9.6 15.4 2
■ Rated frequency: 50 Hz, tapping range
12.5 20 15 45 115 9.4 15.0
± 16 % in ± 9 steps
■ Connection of star 16 25 17 51 125 9.6 15.0
HV winding:
■ Connection star or delta 20 31.5 20 56 140 9.6 15.1 3
of LV winding:
■ Cooling method: ONAN/ONAF 25 40 24 63 160 9.5 15.2
20 31.5 6800 2800 5400 54000 14000 5500 2000 3100 49000 8
25 40 6900 2900 5400 61000 14500 5700 2100 3150 56000
31.5 50 7050 2950 5500 70000 17000 5850 2150 3350 65000
63 100 7800 3250 6100 118000 25500 6800 2450 4000 109000
Fig. 42
10
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 5/23
6
Fig. 43: Coal-fired power station in Germany with two 850-MVA generator transformers:
Low-noise design, extended setting range and continuous overload capacity up to 1100 MVA
7
7
1 Five-limb core 12
2 LV winding
3 HV winding
8 4 Tapped winding
5 Tap leads
6 LV bushings 6
7 HV bushings
8 Clamping frame
9 9 On-load tap changer 8
10 Motor drive
11 Schnabel-car-tank
12 Conservator
13 Water-cooling system 9 11
10 13
1
10
3 5
2 4
5/24 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Fig. 45: An integrated solution – the complete Monitoring System housed in a cubicle of the transformer itself
10
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 5/25
The on-load tap changers installed in For operation under extremely onerous
Siemens power transformers are manufac- conditions an oil filter unit is available
1 tured by Maschinenfabrik Reinhausen (MR). for filtering or filtering and drying of the
MR is a supplier of technically advanced switching oil. Voltage monitoring is effect-
on-load tap changers for oil-immersed ed by microprocessor-controlled operation
power transformers covering an application control systems or voltage regulators
range from 100 A to 4,500 A and up to which include a great variety of data input
420 kV. About 90,000 MR high-speed re- and output facilities.
2 sistor-type tap changers are succesfully in In combination with a parallel control unit,
service worldwide. several transformers connected in parallel
The great variety of tap changer models is can be automatically controlled and moni-
based on a modular system which is capa- tored.
ble of meeting the individual customer’s Furthermore, Maschinenfabrik Reinhausen
3 specifications for the respective operating offers a worldwide technical service to
conditions of the transformer. Depending maintain their high quality standard.
on the required application range selector, Inspections at regular intervals with only
switches or diverter switches with tap se- small maintenance requirements guarantee
lectors can be used, both available for neu- the reliable operation expected with MR
4 tral, delta or single-pole connection. Up to products.
107 operating positions can be achieved by
the use of a multiple course tap selector.
In addition to the well-known on-load tap-
changer for installation in oil-immersed
transformers, MR offers also a standard-
5 ized gas-insulated tap changer for indoor
installation which will be mounted on dry-
type transformers up to approx. 30 MVA
and 36 kV, or SF6-type transformers up to
40 MVA and 123 kV.
6 The main characteristics of MR
products are:
■ Compact design
■ Optimum adaption and economic
solutions offered by the great number
of variants Type VT
7
■ High reliability
Fig. 46: MR motor drive ED 100 S Fig. 47: Gas-insulated on-load tap changer
■ Long life
■ Reduced maintenance
■ Service friendliness
8 The tap changers are mechanically
driven – via the drive shafts and the bevel
gear – by a motor drive attached to the
transformer tank. It is controlled according
to the step-by-step principle. Electrical and
mechanical safety devices prevent over-
9 running of the end positions. Further safe-
ty measures, such as the automatic restart
function, a safety circuit to prevent false
phase sequence and running through posi-
tions, ensure the reliable operation of mo-
tor drives.
10
Fig. 48: Selection of on-load tap changers from the MR product range
5/26 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Standards and regulations They only make use of flame-retardent location. This reduces civil works, cable
inorganic insulating materials which free costs, transmission losses, and installation
GEAFOL® cast-resin dry-type transformers
comply with IEC recommendation
these transformers from all restrictions costs. 1
that apply to oil-filled electrical equipment, GEAFOL transformers are fully LI-rated.
No. 726, CENELEC HD 464, HD 538
such as oil-collecting pits, fire walls, fire- They have similar noise levels to compara-
and DIN 42 523.
extinguishing equipment, etc. ble oil-filled transformers. Taking the above
GEAFOL transformers are installed wher- indirect cost reductions into account, they
Advantages and applications ever oil-filled units cannot be used: inside are also frequently cost-competitive.
buildings, in tunnels, on ships, cranes and By virtue of their design, GEAFOL trans-
2
GEAFOL distribution and power trans- offshore platforms, in ground-water catch-
formers in ratings from 100 to more than formers are completely maintenance-free
ment areas, in food processing plants, etc. for their lifetime.
20 000 kVA and LI values up to 170 kV Often they are combined with their prima-
are full substitutes for oil-immersed trans- GEAFOL transformers have been in
ry and secondary switchgear and distribu-
formers with comparable electrical and successful service since 1965. A lot of
tion boards into compact substations that 3
mechanical data. licenses have been granted to major
are installed directly at their point of use.
manufactures throughout the world since.
GEAFOL transformers are designed for As thyristor-converter transformers for
indoor installation close to their point of variable speed drives they can be installed
use at the center of the major consumers. together with the converters at the drive
LV winding
Temperature monitoring Made of aluminum strip. 8
By PTC thermistor detec- Turns firmly glued
tors in the LV winding together by means of
insulating sheet wrapper
Paint finish on material
steel parts
Multiple coating, Insulation: 9
RAL 5009. On request:
Two-component varnish Mixture of epoxy resin
or hot-dip galvanizing and quartz powder
(for particularly aggressive Makes the transformer
environments) maintenance-free, moist-
ure-proof, tropicalized,
Ambient class E2 flame-resistant and self- 10
Climatic category C2 extinguishing
(If the transformer is in-
stalled outdoors, degree Clamping frame and truck
of protection IP 23 must
be assured) Rollers can be swung
around for lengthways or
Fire class F1 sideways travel
* on-load tap changers on request.
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 5/27
HV winding
The high-voltage windings are wound
1 from aluminum foil, interleaved with high-
grade polypropylene insulating foil. The
assembled and connected individual coils
are placed in a heated mold, and are pot-
ted in a vaccum furnace with a mixture
2 of pure silica (quartz sand) and specially
blended epoxy resins. The only connec-
tions to the outside are copper bushings,
which are internally bonded to the alumi-
num winding connections.
The external star or delta connections
3 are made of insulated copper connectors
to guarantee an optimal installation design.
The resulting high-voltage windings are
fire-resistant, moistureproof, corrosion-
proof, and show excellent aging properties
under all indoor operating conditions.
4 (For outdoor use, specially designed sheet-
metal enclosures are available.)
The foil windings combine a simple wind-
ing technique with a high degree of elec-
trical safety. The insulation is subjected
5 to less electrical stress than in other
types of windings. In a conven-
tional round-wire winding,
the interturn voltage
can add up to twice the
interlayer voltage, while
6 in a foil winding it never exeeds the volt- 8
Round-wire
winding
age per turn because a layer consists of
only one winding turn. Result: a high AC 8
voltage and impulse-voltage withstand
U
capacity. 7
1
7 Why aluminum? The thermal expansion
7 8
coefficients of aluminum and cast resin are 2
so similar that thermal stresses resulting
from load changes are kept to a minimum 6 3 7
(see Fig. 50). 6
6 4
5
8 LV winding 5
4 4 3 3 2 2 1
The standard low-voltage winding with its
considerably reduced dielectric stresses is
wound from single aluminum sheets with Strip
interleaved cast-resin impregnated fiber-
9 glass fabric.
winding
The assembled coils are then oven-cured
to form uniformly bonded solid cylinders
that are impervious to moisture. Through U 2 4 6 8
the single-sheet winding design, excellent
10 dynamic stability under short-circuit con-
ditions is achieved. Connections are sub-
merged-arc-welded to the aluminum
sheets and are extended either as alu-
minum or copper busbars to the secondary 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
terminals.
1 3 5 7
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
Fig. 50: High-voltage encapsulated winding design of GEAFOL cast-resin transformer and voltage stress of a
conventional round-wire winding (above) and the foil winding (below)
5/28 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Fire safety The properties laid down in the standards Insulation class and temperature rise
GEAFOL transformers use only flame- for ratings within the approximate category
The high-voltage winding and the low-
retardent and self-extinguishing materials relating to environment (humidity), climate
voltage winding utilize class F insulating 1
in their construction. No additional sub- and fire behavior have to be demonstrated
materials with a mean temperature rise
stances, such as aluminum oxide trihy- by means of tests.
of 100 K (standard design).
drate, which could negatively influence These tests are described for the environ-
the mechanical stability of the cast-resin mental category (code number E0, E1 and
molding material, are used. Internal arcing E2) and for the climatic category (code Overload capability
from electrical faults and externally applied number C1, C2) in DIN VDE 0532 Part 6
2
GEAFOL transformers can be overloaded
flames do not cause the transformers to (corresponding to HD 464). According to permanently up to 50% (with a corre-
burst or burn. After the source of ignition this standard, they are to be carried out on sponding increase in impedance voltage)
is removed, the transformer is self-extin- complete transformers. if additional radial cooling fans are installed.
guishing. This design has been approved The tests of fire behavior (fire category (Dimensions increase by approximately
by fire officials in many countries for instal- code numbers F0 and F1) are limited to 200 mm in length and width.) Short-time 3
lation in populated buildings and other tests on a duplication of a complete trans- overloads are uncritical as long as the
structures. former. It consists of a core leg, a low-volt- maximum winding temperatures are not
The environmental safety of the combus- age winding and a high-voltage winding. exceeded for extended periods of time.
tion residues has been proven in many The specifications for fire category F2 are
tests. determined by agreement between the 4
Temperature monitoring
manufacturer and the customer.
Categorization of cast-resin Siemens have carried out a lot of tests. Each GEAFOL transformer is fitted with
transformers three temperature sensors installed in
The results for our GEAFOL transformers the LV winding, and a solid-state tripping
Dry-type transformers have to be cate- are something to be proud of: device with relay output. The PTC thermis-
gorized under the sections listed below: ■ Environmental category E2 tors used for sensing are selected for the 5
■ Environmental category ■ Climatic category C2 applicable maximum hot-spot winding tem-
■ Climatic category ■ Fire category F1 perature. Additional sets of sensors with
■ Fire category lower temperature points can be installed
This good behavior is solely due to the
These categories have to be shown on the for them and for fan control purposes. Ad-
GEAFOL cast-resin mix which has been
rating plate of each dry-type transformer. ditional dial-type thermometers and Pt100
used successfully for decades. 6
are available, too. For operating voltages
of the LV winding of 3.6 kV and higher,
special temperature measuring equipment
can be provided.
Auxiliary wiring is run in protective conduit
and terminated in a central LV terminal 7
box (optional). Each wire and terminal is
identified, and a wiring diagram is perma-
nently attached to the inside cover of this
terminal box.
8
Installation and enclosures
Indoor installation in electrical operating
rooms or in various sheet-metal enclosures
is the preferred method of installation.
The transformers need only be protected
against access to the terminals or the
9
winding surfaces, against direct sunlight,
and against water. Sufficient ventilation
must be provided by the installation loca-
tion or the enclosure. Otherwise forced-air
cooling must be specified or provided by 10
others.
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 5/29
10
Fig. 53: Radial cooling fans on GEAFOL transformer for AF cooling Fig. 54: GEAFOL transformer in protective housing to IP 20/40
5/30 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
E E
A1 B1
5
Fig. 56: GEAFOL cast-resin transformer
Rated Rated Impe- Type No-load Load Load Sound Sound Total Dimensions Distance
power voltage dance losses losses losses press. power weight between
voltage level level Length Width Height wheel
1m centers 6
toler-
ance
+ 3 dB
Sn Um U2 P0 Pk 75* Pk 120** LPA LWA GGES A1 B1 H1 E
[kVA] [kV] [%] 4GB… [W] [W] [W] [dB] [dB] [kg] [mm] [mm] [mm] [mm]
7
100 12 4 .5044-3CA 440 1600 1900 45 59 630 1210 705 835 without wheels
4 .5044-3GA 320 1600 1900 37 51 760 1230 710 890 without wheels
6 .5044-3DA 360 2000 2300 45 59 590 1190 705 860 without wheels
6 .5044-3HA 300 2000 2300 37 51 660 1230 710 855 without wheels 8
24 4 .5064-3CA 600 1500 1750 45 59 750 1310 755 935 without wheels
4 .5064-3GA 400 1500 1750 37 51 830 1300 755 940 without wheels
6 .5064-3DA 420 1800 2050 45 59 660 1250 750 915 without wheels
6 .5064-3HA 330 1800 2050 37 51 770 1300 755 930 without wheels 9
160 12 4 .5244-3CA 610 2300 2600 47 62 770 1220 710 1040 520
4 .5244-3GA 440 2300 2600 39 54 920 1290 720 1050 520
6 .5244-3DA 500 2300 2700 47 62 750 1270 720 990 520
6 .5244-3HA 400 2300 2700 39 54 850 1300 725 985 520 10
24 4 .5264-3CA 800 2200 2500 47 62 910 1330 725 1090 520
4 .5264-3GA 580 2200 2500 39 54 940 1310 720 1095 520
6 .5264-3DA 600 2500 2900 47 62 820 1310 725 1075 520
6 .5264-3HA 480 2500 2900 39 54 900 1350 765 1060 520
Dimensions and weights are approximate values and valid for 400 V on the secondary side, vector-group can be Dyn 5 or Dyn 11. Rated power figures in parentheses are not standardized.
* In case of short-circuits at 75 °C
** In case of short-circuits at 120 °C
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 5/31
Rated Rated Impe- Type No-load Load Load Sound Sound Total Dimensions Distance
power voltage dance losses losses losses press. power weight between
1 voltage level level Length Width Height wheel
1m centers
toler-
ance
+ 3 dB
Sn Um U2 P0 Pk 75* Pk 120** LPA LWA GGES A1 B1 H1 E
2 [kVA] [kV] [%] 4GB… [W] [W] [W] [dB] [dB] [kg] [mm] [mm] [mm] [mm]
250 12 4 .5444-3CA 820 3000 3500 50 65 1040 1330 730 1110 520
4 .5444-3GA 600 3000 3400 42 57 1170 1330 730 1135 520
6 .5444-3DA 700 2900 3300 50 65 990 1350 740 1065 520
3 6 .5444-3HA 570 2900 3300 42 57 1120 1390 745 1090 520
24 4 .5464-3CA 1050 2900 3300 50 65 1190 1390 735 1120 520
4 .5464-3GA 800 2900 3300 41 57 1230 1400 735 1150 520
6 .5464-3DA 880 3100 3600 50 65 990 1360 735 1140 520
4 6 .5464-3HA 650 3100 3600 41 57 1180 1430 745 1160 520
36 6 .5475-3DA 1300 3800 4370 50 65 1700 1900 900 1350 520
(315) 12 4 .5544-3CA 980 3300 3800 52 67 1160 1370 820 1125 670
4 .5544-3GA 720 3300 3800 43 59 1320 1380 820 1195 670
5
6 .5544-3DA 850 3400 3900 51 67 1150 1380 830 1140 670
6 .5544-3HA 680 3400 3900 43 59 1290 1410 830 1165 670
24 4 .5564-3CA 1250 3400 3900 51 67 1250 1410 820 1195 670
4 .5564-3GA 930 3400 3900 43 59 1400 1440 825 1205 670
6
6 .5564-3DA 1000 3600 4100 51 67 1190 1410 825 1185 670
6 .5564-3HA 780 3600 4100 43 59 1300 1460 830 1195 670
36 6 .5575-3DA 1450 4500 5170 51 67 1900 1950 920 1400 670
400 12 4 .5644-3CA 1150 4300 4900 52 68 1310 1380 820 1265 670
7
4 .5644-3GA 880 4300 4900 44 60 1430 1380 820 1290 670
6 .5644-3DA 1000 4300 4900 52 68 1250 1410 825 1195 670
6 .5644-3HA 820 4300 4900 44 60 1350 1430 830 1195 670
5/32 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Rated Rated Impe- Type No-load Load Load Sound Sound Total Dimensions Distance
power voltage dance losses losses losses press. power weight between
voltage level level Length Width Height wheel 1
1m centers
toler-
ance
+ 3 dB
Sn Um U2 P0 Pk 75* Pk 120** LPA LWA GGES A1 B1 H1 E
[kVA] [kV] [%] 4GB… [W] [W] [W] [dB] [dB] [kg] [mm] [mm] [mm] [mm] 2
630 12 4 .5844-3CA 1500 6400 7300 54 70 1830 1510 840 1345 670
4 .5844-3GA 1150 6400 7300 45 62 2070 1470 835 1505 670
6 .5844-3DA 1370 6400 7400 54 70 1770 1550 860 1295 670
6 .5844-3HA 1150 6400 7400 45 62 1990 1590 865 1310 670
3
24 4 .5864-3CA 1950 6000 6900 53 70 1860 1550 845 1380 670
4 .5864-3GA 1500 6000 6900 45 62 2100 1600 850 1400 670
6 .5864-3DA 1650 6400 7300 53 70 1810 1580 855 1345 670
6 .5864-3HA 1250 6400 7300 45 62 2050 1620 860 1370 670
4
36 6 .5875-3DA 2200 7000 8000 53 70 2900 2070 940 1650 670
(800) 12 4 .5944-3CA 1850 7800 9000 55 72 2080 1570 850 1560 670
4 .5944-3GA 1450 7800 9000 47 64 2430 1590 855 1640 670
5
6 .5944-3DA 1700 7600 8700 55 72 2060 1560 865 1490 670
6 .5944-3HA 1350 7600 8700 47 64 2330 1600 870 1530 670
24 4 .5964-3CA 2100 7500 8600 55 72 2150 1610 845 1580 670
4 .5964-3GA 1600 7500 8600 47 64 2550 1650 855 1620 670
6
6 .5964-3DA 1900 7900 9100 55 71 2110 1610 860 1590 670
6 .5964-3HA 1450 7900 9100 47 64 2390 1630 865 1595 670
36 6 .5975-3DA 2600 8200 9400 55 72 3300 2140 950 1850 670
1000 12 4 .6044-3CA 2200 8900 10200 55 73 2480 1590 990 1775 820
7
4 .6044-3GA 1650 8900 10200 47 65 2850 1620 990 1795 820
6 .6044-3DA 2000 8500 9700 56 73 2420 1620 990 1560 820
6 .6044-3HA 1500 8500 9700 47 65 2750 1660 990 1560 820
24 4 .6064-3CA 2400 8700 10000 55 73 2570 1660 990 1730 820 8
4 ..6064-3GA 1850 8700 10000 47 65 3060 1680 990 1815 820
6 .6064-3DA 2300 9200 10500 55 73 2510 1680 990 1620 820
6 .6064-3HA 1750 9600 11000 47 65 2910 1730 990 1645 820
36 6 .6075-3DA 3000 9500 10900 55 73 3900 2200 1050 1900 820 9
(1250) 12 6 .6144-3DA 2400 9600 11000 57 75 2900 1780 990 1605 820
6 .6144-3HA 1850 10500 12000 49 67 3370 1790 990 1705 820
24 6 .6164-3DA 2700 10000 11500 57 75 3020 1820 990 1635 820
6 .6164-3HA 2100 10500 12000 49 67 3490 1850 990 1675 820 10
36 6 .6175-3DA 3500 11000 12600 57 75 4500 2300 1060 2000 520
Dimensions and weights are approximate values and valid for 400 V on the secondary side, vector-group can be Dyn 5 or Dyn 11. Rated power figures in parentheses are not standardized.
* In case of short-circuits at 75 °C
** In case of short-circuits at 120 °C
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 5/33
Rated Rated Impe- Type No-load Load Load Sound Sound Total Dimensions Distance
power voltage dance losses losses losses press. power weight between
1 voltage level level Length Width Height wheel
1m centers
toler-
ance
+ 3 dB
1600 12 6 .6244-3DA 2800 11000 12500 58 76 3550 1840 995 2025 1070
6 .6244-3HA 2100 11400 13000 50 68 4170 1880 1005 2065 1070
3 24 6 .6264-3DA 3100 11800 13500 58 76 3640 1880 995 2035 1070
6 .6264-3HA 2400 12300 14000 49 68 4080 1900 1005 2035 1070
36 6 .6275-3DA 4300 12700 14600 58 76 5600 2500 1100 2400 1070
(2000) 12 6 .6344-3DA 3600 14000 16000 59 78 4380 1950 1280 2150 1070
4 6 .6344-3HA 2650 14500 16500 51 70 5140 1990 1280 2205 1070
24 6 .6364-3DA 4000 14500 16500 59 78 4410 2020 1280 2160 1070
6 .6364-3HA 3000 14900 17000 51 70 4920 2040 1280 2180 1070
36 6 .6375-3DA 5100 15400 17700 59 78 6300 2500 1280 2400 1070
5 2500 12 6 .6444-3DA 4300 17600 20000 62 81 5130 2110 1280 2150 1070
6 .6444-3HA 3000 18400 21000 51 71 6230 2170 1280 2205 1070
24 6 .6464-3DA 5000 17600 20000 61 81 5280 2170 1280 2160 1070
6 .6464-3HA 3600 18000 20500 51 71 6220 2220 1280 2180 1070
6 36 6 .6475-3DA 6400 18700 21500 61 81 7900 2700 1280 2400 1070
Dimensions and weights are approximate values and valid for 400 V on the secondary side, vector-group can be Dyn 5 or Dyn 11. Rated power figures in parentheses are not standardized.
* In case of short-circuits at 75 °C
** In case of short-circuits at 120 °C
Rated power >2500 kVA to 20 MVA on request.
7
Fig. 60: GEAFOL cast-resin transformers 50 to 2500 kVA
10
5/34 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
10
Fig. 61: 16/22-MVA GEAFOL cast-resin transformer with oil-free on-load tap changer
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 5/35
5/36 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Contents Page
Local and Remote Control
Introduction ................................. 6/71
SINAUT LSA
Overview ...................................... 6/74
SINAUT LSA
Substation automation
distributed structure .................. 6/78
SINAUT LSA
Substation automation
centralized structure
(Enhanced RTU) .......................... 6/91
SINAUT LSA
Compact remote
terminal units .............................. 6/93
SICAM Overview ........................ 6/96
SICAM RTU Remote terminal
units (RTUs) ................................. 6/97
SICAM SAS
Substation automation ............ 6/108
SICAM PCC
Substation automation ............ 6/118
Contents Page Device dimensions .................. 6/125
General overview ........................ 6/2 Power Quality
Application hints ......................... 6/4 Introduction ............................... 6/131
Power System Protection Measuring and recording ...... 6/132
Introduction ................................... 6/8 Compensation systems
Introduction ............................... 6/146
Relay selection guide ................ 6/22
Passive compensation
Relay portraits ............................ 6/25 systems ...................................... 6/147
Typical protection schemes ..... 6/42 Active compensation
Protection coordination ............ 6/62 systems ...................................... 6/154
6
Protection and Substation Control
General Overview
6/2 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Protection and Substation Control
General Overview
Fig. 4: Siemens Protection and Substation Control comprises these systems and product ranges
8
System Protection The integration of additional protection Thus the on-line measurements and fault
and other functions, such as real-time data registered in the protective relays
Siemens offers a complete spectrum of
multifunctional, numerical relays for all
operational measurements, event and fault can be used for local and remote control 9
recording, all in one unit economizes on or can be transmitted via telephone mo-
applications in the field of network and
space, design and wiring costs. dem connections to the workplace of the
machine protection.
Setting and programming of the devices service engineer.
Uniform design and electromagnetic-inter-
can be performed through the integral, Siemens supplies individual devices as
ference-free construction in metal housings
plaintext, menu-guided operator display or well as complete protection systems in 10
with conventional connection terminals in by using the comfortable PC program DIG- factory finished cubicles. For complex ap-
accordance with public utility requirements SI for Windows*. plications, for example, in the field of extra-
assure simple system design and usage
Open serial interfaces, IEC 870-5-103-com- high-voltage transmission, type and design
just as with conventional relays.
pliant, allow free communication with high- test facilities are available together with an
Numerical measurement techniques en- er level control systems, including those extensive and comprehensive network
sure precise operation and necessitate less from other manufacturers. Connection to a model using the most modern simulation
maintenance thanks to their continuous Profibus substation LAN is optionally possible. and evaluation techniques.
self-monitoring capability.
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 6/3
Protection and Substation Control
General Overview
6/4 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Protection and Substation Control
Application Hints
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 6/5
Protection and Substation Control
Application Hints
EMC tests; emission (type tests) Cores for revenue metering The required c.t. accuracy-limiting factor
KALF can be determined by calculation,
■ Standard: In this case, class 0.2 M is normally
1 EN 50081-2 (generic standard) required.
as shown in Fig. 6.
■ Interference field strength CISPR 11, The overdimensioning factor KOF depends
EN 55011, class A Protection cores: on the type of relay and the primary d.c.
The size of the protection core depends time constant. For the normal case, with
– 30 MHz to 1000 MHz
mainly on the maximum short-circuit cur- short-circuit time constants lower than
■ Conducted interference voltage, 100 ms, the necessary value for K*ALF can
2 aux. voltage CISPR 22, EN 55022, rent and the total burden (internal c.t. bur-
be taken from the table in Fig. 9.
class B den, plus burden of connecting leads, plus
relay burden). The recommended values are based on
– 150 kHz to 30 MHz extensive type tests.
Further, an overdimensioning factor has to
be considered to cover the influence of the C.t. design according to BS 3938
Instrument transformers
3 d.c. component in the short-circuit current.
Instrument transformers must comply In this case the c.t. is defined by the knee-
In general, an accuracy of 1% (class 5 P) is point voltage UKN and the internal second-
with the applicable IEC recommendations specified. The accuracy limiting factor KALF
IEC 60044, formerly IEC 60185 (c.t.) and ary resistance Ri.
should normally be designed so that The design values according to IEC 60 185
186 (p.t.), ANSI/IEEE C57.13 or other com- at least the maximum short-circuit current
parable standards. can be approximately transferred into the
can be transmitted without saturation BS standard definition by the following
4 (d.c. component not considered). formula:
Potential transformers This results, as a rule, in rated accuracy
Potential transformers (p.t.) in single- or limiting factors of 10 or 20 dependent on (RNC + Ri) • I2N • KALF
double-pole design for all primary voltages the rated burden of the c.t. in relation to UKN =
the connected burden. A typical specifica- 1.3
have single or dual secondary windings of
5 100, 110 or 120 V/ 3, with output ratings tion for protection cores for distribution I2N = Nominal secondary current
between 10 and 300 VA, and accuracies feeders is 5P10, 15 VA or 5P20, 10 VA. Example:
of 0.2, 0.5 or 1% to suit the particular The requirements for protective current IEC 185 : 600/1, 15 VA, 5P10, Ri = 4 Ohm
application. Primary BIL values are select- transformers for transient performance are (15 + 4) • 1 • 10
ed to match those of the associated specified in IEC 60044-6. The recom- BS : UKN = = 146 V
1.3
6 switchgear. mended calculation procedure for satura- Ri = 4 Ohm
tion-free design, however, leads to very
high c.t. dimensions. Fig. 7: BS c.t. definition
Current transformers In many practical cases, the c.t.s cannot
Current transformers (c.t.) are usually of be designed to avoid saturation under all C.t. design
the single-ratio type with wound or bar- circumstances because of cost and space according to ANSI/IEEE C 57.13
7 type primaries of adequate thermal rating. reasons, particularly with metal-enclosed Class C of this standard defines the c.t. by
Single, dual or triple secondary windings of switchgear. its secondary terminal voltage at 20 times
1 or 5 A are standard. The Siemens relays are therefore designed nominal current, for which the ratio error
1 A rating however should be preferred, to tolerate c.t. saturation to a large extent. shall not exceed 10%. Standard classes
particularly in HV and EHV stations, to re- The numerical relays proposed in this are C100, C200, C400 and C800 for 5 A
duce the burden of the connecting leads. guide are particularly stable in this case nominal secondary current.
8 Output power (rated burden in VA), accura- due to their integral saturation detection This terminal voltage can be approximately
cy and saturation characteristics (accuracy function. calculated from the IEC data as follows:
limiting factor) of the cores and secondary
windings must meet the particular applica-
tion. RBC + Ri
The c.t. classification code of IEC is used KALF > K*ALF KALF
9 RBN + Ri Vs.t. max = 20 x 5 A x RBN •
in the following: 20
KALF : Rated c.t. accuracy limiting factor
Measuring cores with:
K*ALF : Effective c.t. accuracy
They are normally specified with 0.5% or limiting factor RBN = PBN and INsec = 5 A , we get
1.0% accuracy (class 0.5 M or 1.0 M), and RBN : Rated burden resistance INsec2
10 an accuracy limiting factor of 5 or 10. RBC : Connected burden
The required output power (rated burden) Ri : Internal c.t. burden (resistance
must be higher than the actually connect- Vs.t. max =
PBN • KALF
of the c.t. secondary winding)
ed burden. Typical values are 5, 10, 15 VA. 5
Higher values are normally not necessary with:
Iscc.max.
when only electronic meters and recorders K*ALF > KOF Example:
are connected. IN IEC 185 : 600/5, 25 VA, 5P20,
A typical specification could be: 0.5 M 10, Iscc.max. = Maximum short-circuit current 25 • 20
15 VA. IN = Rated primary c.t. current ANSI C57.13: Vs.t. max = =
5
KOF = Overdimensioning factor = 100, i.e. class C100
Fig. 6: C.t. dimensioning formulae Fig. 8: ANSI c.t. definition
6/6 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Protection and Substation Control
Application Hints
2
Transformer
differential protection >
– 50 for each side
7UT51
Iscc.max.
= 30,000 = 50
Numerical busbar I
protection (low impe- = 1 scc. max. (outflowing current for ext. fault)
dance type) 7SS5 2 IN
IN 600 5
According to Fig. 9:
Iscc. max. (close-in fault) TN < 50 ms:
Distance protection = a
IN a=2
7SA511, 7SA513,
K*ALF >
1
50 = 25 6
7SA522 TN < 100 ms: 2
a = 3 for 7SA511
a = 2 for 7SA513
and 7SA522 15 VA
RBN = = 15 Ohm; 7
1 A2
and 1.5 VA
Iscc. max. (line-end fault) RRelay = = 1.5 Ohm
= 10 1 A2
IN
8
Fig. 9: Required effective accuracy limiting factor K*ALF 2 0.0179 50
Rl = = 0.3 Ohm
Relay burden Burden of the connection leads 6
The c.t. burdens of the numerical relays of The resistance of the current loop from
Siemens are below 0.1 VA and can there- the c.t. to the relay has to be considered:
fore be neglected for a practical estimation. RBC = Rl + RRelay = 9
Exceptions are the busbar protection 7SS50
= 0.3 + 1.5 = 1.8 Ohm
(1.5 VA) and the pilot wire relays 7SD502, 2 ρ l
7SD600 (4 VA) and 7SD503 (3 VA + 9 VA per Rl = Ohm
A
100 Ohm pilot wire resistance).
Intermediate c.t.s are normally no longer
applicable as the ratio adaption for busbar l = single conductor length KALF >
1.8 + 4
25 = 7.6
10
and transformer protection is numerically 15 + 4
performed in the relay. from the c.t. to the relay in m.
Analog static relays in gereral also have
burdens below about 1 VA. Result:
Mechanical relays, however, have a much Specific resistance:
The rated KALF-factor (10) is higher
Ohm mm2
higher burden, up to the order of 10 VA. ρ = 0.0179 m (copper wires) than the calculated value (7.6).
This has to be considered when older re- Therefore, the stability criterium is
lays are connected to the same c.t. circuit. A = conductor cross section
fulfilled.
In any case, the relevant relay manuals in mm2
should always be consulted for the actual
burden values. Fig. 10 Fig. 11
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 6/7
Power System Protection
Introduction
1
Siemens is one of the world’s leading sup-
pliers of protective equipment for power
systems.
Thousands of our relays ensure first-class
performance in transmission and distribu-
2 tion networks on all voltage levels, all over
the world, in countries of tropical heat or
arctic frost.
For many years, Siemens has also signifi-
cantly influenced the development of pro-
3 tection technology.
■ In 1976, the first minicomputer (process
computer)-based protection system was
commissioned: A total of 10 systems
for 110/20 kV substations were supplied
4 and are still operating satisfactorily today.
■ Since 1985, we have been the first to
manufacture a range of fully numerical Fig. 12: Numerical relay ranges of Siemens
relays with standardized communication
interfaces.
Today, Siemens offers a complete pro-
5 gram of protective relays for all applica- State of the art
tions including numerical busbar protec- Mechanical and solid-state (static) relays
tion. have been almost completely phased out
To date (1999), more than 150,000 numer- of our production because numerical relays
ical protection relays from Siemens are are now preferred by the users due to
6 providing successful service, as stand- their decisive advantages:
alone devices in traditional systems or
■ Compact design and lower cost due to
as components of coordinated protec-
tion and substation control. integration of many functions into one
Meanwhile, the innovative SIPROTEC 4 relay
series has been launched, incorporating ■ High availability even with less mainte-
7 the many years of operational experi- nance due to integral self-monitoring
ence with thousands of relays, together ■ No drift (aging) of measuring characteris-
with users’ requirements (power author- tics due to fully numerical processing
ity recommendations). ■ High measuring accuracy due to digital
filtering and optimized measuring algo-
rithms
8 ■ Many integrated add-on functions,
for example, for load-monitoring and
event/fault recording
■ Local operation keypad and display de-
signed to modern ergonomic criteria
9 ■ Easy and secure read-out of information
via serial interfaces with a PC, locally or
remotely
■ Possibility to communicate with higher-
level control systems using standardized
10 protocols (open communication)
6/8 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Power System Protection
Introduction
52
1
21 67N FL 79 25 SM ER FR BM
2
85
3
Serial link to station – or personal computer
to remote line end kA,
kV,
Hz, 01.10.93
21 Distance protection MW,
67N Directional ground-fault protection MVAr, 4
Load monitor MVA,
FL Distance-to-fault locator
79 Autoreclosure Fault report
25 Synchro-check Fault record
85 Carrier interface (teleprotection) 5
SM Self-monitoring Relay monitor
ER Event recording
Breaker monitor
FR Fault recording
BM Breaker monitor Supervisory control
6
Fig. 13: Numerical relays, increased information availability
Modern protection management All relays can stand fully alone. Thus, the Measuring included 7
traditional protection concept of separate
All the functions, for example, of a line pro- For many applications, the protective-current
main and alternate protection as well as
tection scheme can be incorporated in one transformer accuracy is sufficient for oper-
the external connection to the switchyard
unit: ational measuring. The additional mea-
remain unchanged.
■ Distance protection with associated suring c.t. was more for protection of
add-on and monitoring functions measuring instruments under system fault 8
■ Universal teleprotection interface
”One feeder, one relay“ concept conditions. Due to the low thermal with-
stand ability of the measuring instruments,
■ Autoreclose and synchronism check Analog protection schemes have been en-
they could not be connected to the protec-
gineered and assembled from individual
tion c.t.. Consequently, additional measur-
Protection-related information can be relays. Interwiring between these relays
ing c.t.s and measuring instruments are
called up on-line or off-line, such as: and scheme testing has been carried out
now only necessary where high accuracy 9
manually in the workshop.
■ Distance to fault is required, e.g. for revenue metering.
■ Fault currents and voltages
Data sharing now allows for the integration
of several protection and protection related
■ Relay operation data (fault detector pick-
tasks into one single numerical relay. Only
up, operating times etc.)
a few external devices may be required for 10
■ Set values completion of the total scheme. This has
■ Line load data (kV, A, MW, kVAr) significantly lowered the costs of engineer-
To fulfill vital protection redundancy require- ing, assembly, panel wiring, testing and
ments, only those functions which are in- commissioning. Scheme failure probability
terdependent and directly associated with has also been lowered.
each other are integrated in the same unit. Engineering has moved from schematic
For back-up protection, one or more addi- diagrams towards a parameter definition
tional units have to be provided. procedure. The documentation is provided
by the relay itself. Free allocation of LED
operation indicators and output contacts
provides more application design flexibility.
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 6/9
Power System Protection
Introduction
6/10 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Power System Protection
Introduction
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 6/11
Power System Protection
Relay Design and Operation
6/12 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Power System Protection
Relay Design and Operation
Implemented Functions
SIOPROTEC relays are available with a
variety of protective functions. See relay 1
charts (page 6/20 and following).
The high processing power of modern nu-
merical devices allow further integration of
non-protective add-on functions.
2
The question as to whether separate or
combined relays should be used for pro-
tection and control cannot be uniformly an-
swered. In transmission type substations,
separation into independent hardware units
is still preferred, whereas on the distribu- 3
tion level a trend towards higher function
integration can be observed. Here, com-
bined feeder relays for protection, monitor-
ing and control are on the march (Fig. 20).
Most of the relays of this guide are stand- 4
alone protection relays. The exception in
the SIPROTEC 3 series is the distribution
feeder relay 7SJ531 that also integrates
control functions. Per feeder, only one re-
lay package ist needed in this case leading
to a considerable reduction in space und 5
wiring. Fig. 20: Switchgear with numerical relay (7SJ62) Switchgear with combined protection
and traditional control and control relay (7SJ63)
With the new SIPROTEC 4 series (types
7SJ61, 62 and 63), Siemens supports both
stand-alone and combined solutions on the
basis of a single hardware and software The following solutions are available within ■ Combined feeder relays for protection, 6
platform. The user can decide within wide one relay family: monitoring and control
limits on the configuration of the control ■ Separate control and protection relays Mixed use of the different relay types is
and protection functions in the feeder, ■ Protection relays including remote con- readily possible on account of the uniform
without compromising the reliability of the trol of the feeder breaker via the serial operation and communication procedures.
protection functions (Fig. 21). communication link 7
7SJ61/ 7SJ62/63
Busbar 62/63
52
Local/Remote control PLC logic Vf (option) Directional (option)
8
Commands/Feedback indications
Trip circuit Fault locator Rotating field
supervision Lockout 810/U 59 27 monitoring
Motor & 21FL
control 74TC 86 47
(only 7SJ63) 9
HMI Communica- Fault Metering values V, Watts,
tions module recording Vars f.p.f.
RS23/485 I2 limit values
fiber optic
IEC 60 870-5-103 Metered power Calculated
values pulses
PROFIBUS FMS
10
Motor protection (option)
Starting time 67 67N
Inrush
50 51 50N 51N 46 49 restrain 50BF
37 48 66/86
Breaker Directional ground-
failure Start fault detection (option)
Auto reclosing protection 14 Locked inhibit
79M rotor
60N 51N 67 64
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 6/13
Power System Protection
Relay Design and Operation
3 3
Local relay operation
All operator actions can be executed and 4
7 information displayed on an integrated user 4 5
interface.
6 6
Many advantages are already to be found
on the clear and user-friendly front panel: 7
7
■ Positioning and grouping of the keys
8 supports the natural operating process
(ergonomic design) 1 Large illuminated display 4 Control (7SJ61/62 6 Freely programmable
■ Large non-reflective back-lit display 2 Cursor keys uses function keys) function keys
■ Programmable (freely assignable) LEDs 3 LED with reset key 5 Key switches 7 Numerical keypad
for important messages
9 ■ Arrows arrangement of the keys for Fig. 23: Front view of the protection relay 7SJ62 Fig. 24: Front view of the combined protection,
easy navigation in the function tree monitoring and control relay 7SJ63
■ Operator-friendly input of the setting val-
ues via the numeric keys or with a PC
by using the operating program DIGSI 4
■ Command input protected by key lock
10 (6MD63/7SJ63 only) or password
■ Four programmable keys for frequently
used functions >at the press of a but-
ton<
6/14 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Power System Protection
Relay Design and Operation
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 6/15
Power System Protection
Relay Design and Operation
DIGSI 4 matrix
The DIGSI 4 matrix allows the user to see
1 the overall view of the relay configuration
at a glance. For example, you can display
all the LEDs that are linked to binary inputs
or show external signals that are connect-
ed to the relay. And with one click of
2 the button, connections can be switched
(Fig. 28).
Display editor
A display editor is available to design the
3 display on SIPROTEC 4 units. The prede-
fined symbol sets can be expanded to suit
the user. The drawing of a one-line dia-
gram is extremely simple. Load monitoring
values (analog values) can be placed where Fig. 28: DIGSI 4 allocation matrix
required (Fig. 29).
4
Commissioning
Special attention has been paid to commis-
sioning. All binary inputs and outputs can
5 be read and set directly. This can simplify
the wire checking process significantly for
the user.
6/16 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Power System Protection
Relay Design and Operation
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 6/17
Power System Protection
Relay Design and Operation
Fault analysis
The evaluation of faults is simplified by nu-
1 merical protection technology. In the event
of a fault in the network, all events as well
as the analog traces of the measured volt-
ages and currents are recorded.
The following types of memory are avail-
2 able:
■ 1 operational event memory
Alarms that are not directly assigned to
a fault in the network (e.g. monitoring
alarms, alternation of a set value, block-
3 ing of the automatic reclose function).
■ 5 fault-event histories
Alarms that occurred during the last
3 faults on the network (e.g. type of
fault detection, trip commands, fault lo-
cation, autoreclose commands). A re-
4 close cycle with one or more reclosures
is treated as one fault history. Each new
fault in the network overrides the oldest
fault history.
■ A memory for the fault recordings for Fig. 33: Display and evaluation of a fault record using DIGSI
5 voltage and current. Up to 8 fault record-
ings are stored. The fault recording
memory is organized as a ring buffer, i.e. Evaluation of the fault recording Data security, data interfaces
a new fault entry overrides the oldest
fault record. Readout of the fault record from the pro- DIGSI is a closed system as far as protec-
■ 1 earth-fault event memory (optional for tection device by DIGSI is done by fault- tion parameter security is concerned. The
6 isolated or resonant grounded networks) proof scanning procedures in accordance security of the stored data of the operating
Event record of the sensitive earth fault with the standard recommendation for PC is ensured by checksums. This means
detector (e.g. faulted phase, real compo- transmission of fault records. that it is only possible to change data with
nent of residual current). A fault record can also be read out repeat- DIGSI, which subsequently calculates a
edly. In addition to analog values, such as checksum for the changed data and stores
The time tag attached to the fault-record
voltage and current, binary tracks can also it with the data. Changes in the data and
7 events is a relative time from fault detec-
be transferred and presented. thus in safety-related protection data are
tion with a resolution of 1 ms. In the case
DIGSI is supplied together with the reliably detected.
of devices with integrated battery back-up
clock, the operational events as well as the DIGRA (Digsi Graphic) program, which DIGSI is, however, also an open system.
fault detection are assigned the internal provides the customer with full graphical The data export function supports export
clock time and date stamp. operating and evaluation functionality like of parameterization and marshalling data in
8 The memory for operational events and
that of the digital fault recorders (Oscil- standard ASCII format. This permits simple
lostores) from Siemens (see Fig. 33). access to these data by other programs,
fault record events is protected against fail-
Real-time presentation of analog distur- such as test programs, without endanger-
ure of auxiliary supply with battery back-up
bance records, overlaying and zooming of ing the security of data within the DIGSI
supply.
curves and visualization of binary tracks program system.
The integrated operator interface or a PC
(e.g. trip command, reclose command, etc.) With the import and export of fault records
9 supported by the programming tool DIGSI
are also part of the extensive graphical in IEEE standard format COMTRADE (ANSI),
is used to retrieve fault reports as well as
functionality, as are setting of measurement a high-performance data interface is pro-
for the input of settings and marshalling.
cursors, spectrum analysis and fault resist- duced which supports import and export of
ance derivation. fault records into the DIGSI partner program
DIGRA.
10 This enables the export of fault records
from Siemens protection units to custom-
er-specific programs via the COMTRADE
format.
6/18 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Power System Protection
Relay Design and Operation
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 6/19
Power System Protection
Relay Design and Operation
3 Terminations:
Fig. 35c
8
10
Fig. 36: SIPROTEC 3 relays left: Connection method Fig. 36 Right: Connection method for panel surface
for panel flush mounting including fiber-optic inter- mounting
faces;
6/20 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Power System Protection
Relay Design and Operation
Terminations:
Fig. 37 Fig. 42: SIPROTEC 4 combined protection, control and monitoring relay 7SJ63 with separate operator panel
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 6/21
Power System Protection
Relay Selection Guide
Generator protection
Fiber-optic current
Motor protection
2
Overcurrent
comparison
Differential
Distance
7SS50/52
7UM511
7UM512
7UM515
7UM516
Type
7SA511
7SA513
7SA522
7SD600
7SD502
7SD503
7SD511
7SD512
7UT512
7UT513
7SJ551
7SJ511
7SJ512
7SJ531
7VH80
7VH83
7SJ60
7SJ61
7SJ62
7SJ63
Protection functions
ANSI Description
4 No.*
14 Zero speed and underspeed dev. – – – – – – – – – – ■ – – – – ■ – – – – – – – – –
21 Distance protection, phase ■ ■ ■ – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – ■
5 21N Distance protection, ground ■ ■ ■ – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – –
24 Overfluxing – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – ■ –
25 Synchronism check ■ ■ ■ – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – –
27 Undervoltage – – – – – – – – – – ■ – – ■ ■ ■ – – – – – ■ ■ ■ –
6
27/59/ U/f protection – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – ■ –
81
32 Directional power – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – ■ – – ■
* ANSI/IEEE C 37.2: IEEE Standard Electrical Power System Device Function Numbers
Fig. 43a
6/22 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Power System Protection
Relay Selection Guide
Generator protection
Fiber-optic current
Motor protection
2
Overcurrent
comparison
Differential
Distance
7SS50/52
Type
7UM511
7UM512
7UM515
7UM516
7SA511
7SA513
7SA522
7SD600
7SD502
7SD503
7SD511
7SD512
7SJ511
7SJ512
7SJ531
7UT512
7UT513
7SJ551
7VH80
7VH83
7SJ55
7SJ60
7SJ61
7SJ62
7SJ63
Protection functions
ANSI Description
No.*
4
51GN Stator ground-fault overcurrent – – – – – – – – – – – ■ – – – – ■ – – – – – ■ ■ ■ –
51 Overcurrent with time delay – – – – ■ ■ ■ ■ ■ ■ – ■ ■ ■ ■ ■ ■ – ■ ■ – – ■ ■ – ■
51N Ground-fault overcurrent ■ ■ ■ – – – ■ ■ ■ – – ■ ■ ■ ■ ■ ■ – – – – – ■ ■ – – 5
with time delay
59 Overvoltage – ■ ■ – – – – – – – – ■ – – ■ ■ ■ – – – – – ■ ■ ■ –
59N Residual voltage ground-fault – – – – – – – – – ■ – ■ – – ■ ■ – – – – – – ■ – ■ ■
protection
6
64R Rotor ground fault – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – ■ ■ ■ –
67 Directional overcurrent – – – – – – – – – ■ – ■ – – ■ ■ – – – – – – – – – –
67N Directional ground-fault ■ ■ – – – – – – – ■ – ■ – – ■ ■ ■ – – – – – – – – –
overcurrent 7
67G Stator ground-fault, directional – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – ■ – –
overcurrent
68/78 Out-of-step protection ■ ■ ■ – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – ■
79 Autoreclose ■ ■ ■ – – – – ■ – ■ ■ ■ ■ ■ ■ ■ – – – – – – – – – – 8
81 Frequency relay – – – – – – – – – – – – – – ■ ■ – – – – – – ■ ■ ■ –
85 Carrier interface ■ ■ ■ – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – –
86 Lockout relay, start inhibit – – – – – – – – – – – ■ – ■ ■ ■ ■ – – – – – – – – –
9
87G Differential protection, generator – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – ■ ■ – – – – – –
87T Differential protection, transf. – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – ■ ■ – – – – – –
87B Differential protection, bus-bar – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – ■ ■ – – – –
87M Differential protection, motor – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – ■ ■ – ■ – – – – 10
87L Differential protection, line – – – ■ ■ ■ ■ ■ – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – –
87N Restricted earth-fault protection – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – ■ – ■ – – – – – –
92 Voltage and power directional rel. – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – – –
50BF Breaker failure – ■ ■ – – – – – ■ ■ – ■ – ■ ■ ■ – – – – ■ – – – – –
* ANSI/IEEE C 37.2: IEEE Standard Electrical Power System Device Function Numbers
Fig. 43b
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 6/23
Power System Protection
Relay Selection Guide
Voltage, Frequency
Breaker failure
Synchronizing
Autoreclose +
3
7RW600
Type
7SV512
7SV600
7VK512
7VE51
Protection functions
ANSI Description
4
No.*
24 Overfluxing – – – – ■
25 Synchronism check ■ – – – –
5 Synchronizing – ■ – – –
27 Undervoltage – – – – ■
27/59/ U/f protection – – – – ■
81
6 50BF Breaker failure – – ■ ■ –
59 Overvoltage – – – – ■
79 Autoreclose ■ – – – –
7 81 Frequency relay – – – – ■
10
Fig. 43c
6/24 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Power System Protection
Relay Portraits
Relay portraits
1
Siemens manufactures a complete series
of numerical relays for all kinds of protec-
tion application.
The series is briefly portrayed on the fol-
lowing pages.
2
7SJ600
Universal overcurrent
and overload protection
3
■ Phase-segregated measurement and
indication (Input 3 ph, IE calculated)
■ All instantaneous, i.d.m.t. and d.t.
characteristics can be set individually
for phase and ground faults
■ Selectable setting groups
4
■ Integral autoreclose function (option)
■ Thermal overload, unbalanced load * only with 7SJ512
and locked rotor protection
■ Suitable for busbar protection with *
50 50N 49 48 50 50N BF 67N 5
reverse interlocking
■ With load monitoring, event and fault * *
memory 51 51N 46 79 51 51N 67 79
7SJ602*
Fig. 44: 7SJ600/7SJ602 Fig. 45: 7SJ511/512 6
Universal overcurrent
and overload protection
7SJ511
Functions as 7SJ600, however additionally:
■ Fourth current input transformer for con- Universal overcurrent protection
nection to an independent ground cur- ■ Phase-segregated measurement and
7
rent source (e.g. core-balance CT) indication (3 ph and E)
■ Optical data interface as alternative to ■ I.d.m.t and d.t. characteristics can be set
the wired RS485 version (located at the individually for phase and ground faults
relay bottom) ■ Suitable for busbar protection with
■ Serial PC interface at the relay front reverse interlocking 8
■ With integral breaker failure
protection
■ With load monitoring, event and fault
memory
■ Inrush stabilization 9
7SJ512
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 6/25
Power System Protection
Relay Portraits
7SJ61
1 Universal overcurrent
and overload protection with
control functions
■ Phase-segregated measurement and
indication (input 3 ph and E)
2 ■ All instantaneous, i.d.m.t. and d.t. char-
acteristics can be set individually for
phase and ground faults
■ Selectable setting groups
■ Inrush stabilization
3 ■ Integral autoreclose function (option)
■ Thermal overload, unbalanced load and
locked rotor protection
■ Suitable for busbar protection with
reserve interlocking
■ With load monitoring, event and fault
4 memory 7SJ61
■ With integral breaker failure protection
■ With trip circuit supervision 56 50N 50BF 79 86 27 49R 51N
Control functions:
5 51 51N 74TC 37 50 59 48 51
■ Measured-value acquisition (current)
■ Limit values of current
■ Control of 1 C.B. 7SJ62 additionally: 46 50G 86 49 51G
■ Switchgear interlocking isolator/C.B.
67 76N 27 59 81o/u
6 7SJ62
FL 46 49 47
Digital overcurrent and overload protection
with additional functions
Features as 7SJ61, plus: Fig. 46: 7SJ61/7SJ62 Fig. 47: 7SJ551
7 ■ Sensitive directional ground-fault protec-
tion for isolated, resonant or high-
resistance grounded networks 7SJ551
■ Directional overcurrent protection Universal motor protection
■ Selectable setting groups and overcurrent relay
8 ■ Over and undervoltage protection
■ Thermal overload pretection
■ Over and underfrequency protection
– separate thermal replica for stator and
■ Distance to fault locator (option) rotor based on true RMS current
Control functions: measurement
– up to 2 heating time constants for the
9 ■ Measured-value acquisition (voltage) stator thermal replica
■ P, Q, cos ϕ and meter-reading calculation – separate cooling time constants for
■ Measured-value recording stator and rotor thermal replica
■ Limit values of I, V, P, Q, f, cos ϕ – ambient temperature biasing of
thermal replica
10 ■ Connection of up to 8 RTD sensors
ground elements
■ Real-Time Clock: last 3 events are stored
with real-time stamps of alarm and trip
data
6/26 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Power System Protection
Relay Portraits
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 6/27
Power System Protection
Relay Portraits
7SA511
7SA510
Fig. 51: 7SA511 Fig. 52: 7SA510
Line protection with distance-to-fault locator
6 (Reduced version of 7SA511)
Universal distance protection, suitable for
all networks, with additional functions,
including
■ Universal carrier interface (PUTT, POTT,
7 Blocking, Unblocking)
■ Power swing blocking and/or tripping
■ Selectable setting groups
■ Sensitive directional ground-fault deter-
mining for isolated and compensated
8 networks
■ High-resistance ground-fault protection
for grounded networks
■ Thermal overload protection for cables
■ Free marshalling of optocoupler inputs
9 and relay outputs
■ Line load monitoring, event and fault
recording
■ Three-pole autoreclose
10
6/28 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Power System Protection
Relay Portraits
7SA522
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 6/29
Power System Protection
Relay Portraits
7SD511
1 Current-comparison protection
for overhead lines and cables
■ With phase-segregated measurement
■ For serial data transmission
(19.2 kbits/sec)
2 – with integrated optical transmitter/
receiver for direct fiber-optic link up
to approx. 15 km distance
– or with the additional digital signal
transmission device 7VR5012 up to
150 km fiber-optic length
3 – or through a 64 kbit/s channel of avail-
able multipurpose PCM devices, via
fiber-optic or microwave link
■ Integral overload and breaker failure
protection
4 ■ Emergency operation as overcurrent
backup protection on failure of data link
■ Automatic measurement and correction
of signal transmission time, i.e. channel-
swapping is permissible 50 51 50
87L 51 87L
5 ■ Line load monitoring, event and fault
recording
49 BF 49 BF 79
7SD512
6 Current-comparison protection
Fig. 55: 7SD511 Fig. 56: 7SD512
for overhead lines and cables
with functions as 7SD511, but additionally
with autoreclose function for single and
three-pole fast and delayed autoreclosure.
7
7SD502
■ Pilot-wire differential protection for lines
and cables (2 pilot wires)
■ Up to about 25 km telephone-type pilot
8 wire length
■ With integrated overcurrent back-up and
overload protection
■ Also applicable to 3-terminal lines
(2 devices at each end)
9
7SD503
■ Pilot-wire differential protection for lines
and cables (3 pilot wires)
■ Up to about 15 km pilot wire length
10 ■ With integrated overcurrent back-up and
overload protection 87L 50
■ Also applicable to 3-terminal lines
(2 devices at each end)
49 51
6/30 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Power System Protection
Relay Portraits
7SD600
5
87 L
7UT512
Differential protection
for three-winding transformers 10
with the same functions as 7UT512, plus:
■ Sensitive restricted ground-fault * 87 *
87T 49 50/51 87T 50G REF
protection
■ Sensitive d.t. or i.d.m.t. ground-fault-
o/c-protection 49 50/51
* 87REF or 50G
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 6/31
Power System Protection
Relay Portraits
2 Central unit
Optic fibers
1 2 3 48
3
Bay units
4
87 BF
BB
5 7SS50
Numerical busbar and
breaker failure protection
■ With absolutely secure 2-out-of-2 meas-
6 urement and additional check zone, each
processed on separate microprocessor
hardware
■ Mixed current measurement
■ With fast operating time (< 15 ms)
7 ■ Extreme stability against c.t. saturation
■ Completely self-monitoring, including c.t.
circuits, isolator positions and run time
■ With integrated circuit-breaker failure
protection
8 ■ With commissioning-friendly aids (indica- 87
tion of all feeder, operating and stabiliz-
ing currents)
■ With event and fault recording Fig. 64: 7VH80
■ Designed for single and multiple bus- 87
bars, up to 8 busbar sections and 32
9 bays ■ Inrush stabilized through filtering
Fig. 63: 7VH83 ■ Fast operation: 15 ms (l > 5 x setting)
7SS52
■ Optionally, external voltage limiters
Distributed numerical busbar (varistor)
■ With commissioning-friendly aids (indica-
and breaker failure protection
10 tion of all feeder, operating and stabiliz-
7VH83
■ With absolutely secure 2-out-of-2 meas- ing currents)
urement and additional check zone, each ■ With event and fault recording High impedance differential relay
processed on separate microprocessor ■ Designed for single and multiple bus-
hardware ■ Three-phase type
bars, up to 12 busbar sections and 48
■ Phase-segregated measurement bays ■ Robust solid-state design
■ With fast operating time (< 15 ms) ■ Integral buswire supervision
■ Extreme stability against c.t. saturation 7VH80 ■ Integral c.t. shorting relay
■ Completely self-monitoring, including c.t. ■ Inrush stabilized through filtering
High impedance differential relay
circuits, isolator positions and run time ■ Fast operation: 21 ms (l > 5 x setting)
■ With integrated 2-stage circuit-breaker ■ Single-phase type ■ Optionally, external voltage limiters
failure protection ■ Robust solid-state design (varistors)
6/32 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Power System Protection
Relay Portraits
7UM511/12/15/16
Multifunctional devices 1
for machine protection
■ With 10 protection functions on average,
with flexible combination to form com-
plete protection systems, from the
smallest to the largest motor generator 2
units (see Fig. 66)
■ With improved measurement methods
based on Fourier filters and the evalua-
tion of symmetrical components (fully 7SJ511
numeric, frequency compensated)
■ With load monitoring, event and fault
3
recording
7UT513
See also separate reference list for
machine protection.
Order No. E50001-U321-A39-X-7600 7VE51 4
7VE51
7UM512
Paralleling device
for synchronization of generators and 5
networks
■ Absolutely secure against spurious
7UM511
switching due to duplicate measurement
with different procedures G
■ With numerical measurand filtering that 6
ensures exact synchronization even in
networks suffering transients
■ With synchrocheck option
■ Available in two versions: 7VE511 with-
out, 7VE512 with voltage and frequency 7UT512
balancing
7
7VE51 25 Synchronizing
9
7UM512 59N 64R 46
7UM511 81u 59 32 40 49
7UT512 87G
10
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 6/33
Power System Protection
Relay Portraits
Fig. 66
Numerical generator protection
1 Protection functions
7UM511
7UM512
7UM515
7UM516
Relay
ANSI
No.* Function
2 51 Overcurrent I>, t(+U<) ■ ■
IE>, t ■2)
I>>, t ■
51, 37 Overcurrent/Undercurrent I ><, t ■
3
49 Thermal overload I2t ■
46 Load unbalance I2ln>, t ■ ■ ■
(I2lln)2 t ■ ■ ■
6/34 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Power System Protection
Relay Portraits
7VK512 7RW600
7SV600 7
Breaker failure protection relay
■ Phase selective for single and three-pole
autoreclosure
■ Reset time < 10 ms (Sinusoidal current) 8
< 20 ms worst case
■ “No current“ condition control using the
breaker auxiliary contacts
■ Selectable setting groups
■ Event and fault recording 9
■ Lockout of trip command
10
50
BF
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 6/35
Power System Protection
Relay Dimensions
2 ø5
or
M4
244
266 245+1 255±0.3
3
ø6
75 37 172 29.5
4 Fig. 69
Case 7XP2030-2 for relays 7SD511, 7SJ511/12, 7SJ531, 7UT512, 7VE51, 7SV512, 7SK512
5 Front view Side view Panel cutout
145 30 172 29.5 7.3 131.5
13.2 105 5.4
6 10 ø5
or
Optical 244 266 245 M4 255.8
fibre
interface
1.5 ø6
7
10 ø5
or
266 245 M4 255.8
ø6
10 1,5
6/36 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Power System Protection
Relay Dimensions
ø5
2
or
M4
244 266 245 255.8
ø6 3
71
Fig. 72 4
ø5
or M4
111.0 133 112 122.5 6
ø6
71
Fig. 73
7
115
All dimensions in mm.
Fig. 74
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 6/37
Power System Protection
Relay Dimensions
Fig. 75
146/5.74
5 Case for 7SJ61, 62
Rear view 1
150/5.90
Panel cutout
145/5.70
Side 29.5 172/6.77 34
view 1.16 1.33
Mounting plate
ø5 or M4/
0.2 diameter
6
255.8/10.07
245/9.64
266/10.47
FO ø6/0.24
7
244/9.61
2 diameter
0.07 SUB-D
Connector
105/4.13
131.5/5.17
8 RS232-port
Fig. 76a
10 255.8/10.07
245/9.65
266/10.47
FO ø6/0.24
244/9.61
2 diameter
0.07 SUB-D
Connector
180/7.08
206.5/8.12
RS232-port
Fig. 76b All dimensions in mm.
6/38 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Power System Protection
Relay Dimensions
225/8.85
220/8.66 Mounting 2
29.5 27.1 plate
202.5/7.97 29 30 1.16 1.06
1.14 1.18
266/10.47
266/10.47 312/12.28 244/9.61
FO
2
4
0.07
Connection cable
RS232-
68 poles to basic 5
unit length 2.5 m/8 ft.,
port 2.4 in
Mounting plate
Fig. 77: 7SJ63, 1/2 surface mounting case (only with detached panel, see Fig. 42, page 6/21)
6
10
Mounting plate
Fig. 78: 7SJ63, 1/1 surface mounting case (only with detached panel, see Fig. 42, page 6/21) All dimensions in mm.
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 6/39
Power System Protection
Relay Dimensions
120 L
3 102
55 96 104
k l
14.5 x 6.5 K
200 2 120
4
Fig. 79
6
12 80 Diam.
149
7 81
Diam.
6.4
143 54
8 170
Fig. 80
10
6/40 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Power System Protection
Relay Dimensions
G H I K L M Y 2
90 62
3
75
4
64
64 A B C D E F Z
G H I K L M Y
7
Fig. 81
10
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 6/41
Power System Protection
Typical Protection Schemes
Fig. 82
6/42 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Power System Protection
Typical Protection Schemes
Fig. 84
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 6/43
Power System Protection
Typical Protection Schemes
6 Fig. 85
General hints:
Infeed
7 – This circuit is preferably used for the
52 interruption-free supply of important
consumers without significant backfeed.
52 I>, t IE>, t ϑ> I2>, t 52 – The directional o/c protection 67/67N
trips instantaneously for faults on the
51 51N 49 46 7SJ60
8 protected line. This allows the saving
of one time-grading interval for the o/c-
O H line or Protection relays at the infeed.
O H line or
cable 1 cable 2 same as – The o/c relay functions 51/51N have
line or cable 1 each to be time-graded against the
relays located upstream.
9 51 51N 7SJ62
67 67N
52
10 52
52
52 52
Load Load
Fig. 86
6/44 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Power System Protection
Typical Protection Schemes
Fig. 87
Notes:
52
1) Teleprotection logic 85 for transfer trip 52
or blocking schemes. Signal transmis- 7
sion via pilot wire, power-line carrier,
microwave or optical fiber (to be pro- 52 52
vided separately). The teleprotection
supplement is only necessary if fast 21/ 2)
67N
fault clearance on 100% line length is 21N
7SA511
required, i.e. second zone tripping 3) 8
(about 0.3 s delay) cannot be accepted 85 79 4) Same
for far end faults. Line or protection
2) Directional ground-fault protection 67N cable for parallel line,
1) if applicable
with inverse-time delay against high-
resistance faults
3) Single or multishot autoreclosure 79 85 79
3) 9
only with overhead lines 7SA511
2)
4) Reduced version 7SA510 may be used 21/
where no, or only 3-pole autoreclosure 21N 67N 4)
is required.
52 52 10
52
52 52 52 52
Load Backfeed
Fig. 88
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 6/45
Power System Protection
Typical Protection Schemes
7. Subtransmission line
1 Note:
1) Connection to open delta winding if
available. Relays 7SA511 and 7SJ512
can, however, also be set to calculate
the zero-sequence voltage internally.
2 General hints:
– Distance teleprotection is proposed as
main, and time graded directional O/C as
backup protection.
1) – The 67N function of 7SA511 provides
3 additional high-resistance ground fault
protection. It can be used in a directional
comparison scheme in parallel with the
21 67 21/21N-function, but only in POTT mode.
25 79 21N 67N If the distance protection scheme ope-
4 rates in PUTT mode, 67N is only availa-
68 51 ble as time-delayed function.
78 67N 51N – Recommended schemes:
PUTT on medium and long lines with
phase shift carrier or other secure com-
BF 7SJ62 munication channel.
5 POTT on short lines.
BLOCKING with On/Off carrier (all line
S lengths).
85 CH To remote
R line end
6 7SA511
Signal transmission
equipment
Fig. 89
7
10
6/46 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Power System Protection
Typical Protection Schemes
Line con- Normally used with ■ Short lines in particu- All kinds of line EHV lines
figuration: medium and long lines lar when high fault re- (Preferred US
sistance coverage is practice)
required 4
(7SA511/513 relays al- ■ Multi-terminal and
low use also with short tapped lines with in-
lines due to their inde- termediate infeed ef-
pendent X and R setting fects
of all distance zones).
5
Advantages: ■ Simple method ■ No distance zone
■ Tripping of underrea- overreaching pro-
ching zone does not blems, when applied
depend on the chan- with CCVTs on short
nel (release signal lines
from the remote line ■ Applicable to extreme
6
end not necessary). short lines below the same as same as
■ No distance zone or minimum zone setting for POTT for POTT
time coordination be- limit
tween line ends ne- ■ No problems with the
cessary, i.e. this mode impact of parallel line 7
can easily be used coupling.
with different relay
types.
Drawbacks: ■ Parallel, teed and ■ Distance zone and Same as for POTT,
tapped lines may time coordination with same as however, loss of re- 8
cause underreach remote line end relays for POTT mote end signal
problems. Careful necessary does not completely
consideration of zero- ■ Tripping depends on Except that a weak block the protection
sequence coupling receipt of remote end infeed supplement scheme. Tripping is
and intermediate in- signal (additional inde- is not necessary in this case released 9
feed effects is neces- pendent underrea- with a short time
sary. ching zone of 7SA511/ No continuous on- delay of about
■ Not applicable with 513 relays avoids this line supervision of 20 ms (unblocking
weak infeed termi- problem). the channel possi- logic).
nals. ■ Weak infeed supple- ble!
ment necessary 10
Fig. 90
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 6/47
Power System Protection
Typical Protection Schemes
8. Transmission line with reactor – Operating time of the 7SA513 relay is in – Both 7SA513 and 7SA511 can practise
the range of 15 to 25 ms dependent on selective single-pole and/or three-pole
1 Note: the particular fault condition, while the tripping and autoreclosure.
1) 51G only applicable with grounded reac- operating time of the 7SA511 is 25 to The ground current directional compari-
tor neutral. 35 ms respectively. son protection 67N of the 7SA513 relay
These tripping times are valid for faults uses phase selectors based on symmet-
2) If phase CTs at the low-voltage reactor in the underreaching distance zone rical components. Thus, single pole au-
side are not available, the high-voltage (80 to 85% of the line length). Remote toreclosure can also be practised with
2 phase CTs and the CT in the neutral can end faults must be cleared by the super- high-resistance faults.
be connected to a restricted ground fault imposed teleprotection scheme. Its The 67N function of the 7SA511 relay
protection using one 7VH80 high-imped- overall operating time depends on the should be used as time delayed direc-
ance relay. signal transmission time of the channel tional O/C backup in this case.
(typically 15 to 20 ms for frequency shift – The 67N functions are provided as high-
3 General hints: audio-tone PLC or Microwave channels, impendance fault protection. 67N of the
and lower than 10 ms for ON/OFF PLC 7SA513 relay is normally used with an
– Distance relays are proposed as main 1 or digital PCM signalling via optical additional channel as separate carrier
and main 2 protection. Duplicated 7SA513 fibres). scheme. Use of a common channel with
is recommended for long (>100 km) and
Teleprotection schemes based on distance protection is only possible in
heavily loaded lines or series-compensat-
7SA513 and 7SA511 have therefore ope- the POTT mode. The 67N function in the
4 ed lines and in all cases where extreme
rating times in the order of 40 ms and 7SA511 is blocked when function 21/
short operating times are required due
50 ms each. With state-of-the-art two- 21N picks up. It can therefore only be
to system stability problems.
cycle circuit breakers, fault clearing used in parallel with the distance direc-
7SA513 as main 1 and 7SA511 as main times well below 100 ms (4 to 5 cycles) tional comparison scheme POTT using
2 can be used in the normal case. can normally be achived. one common channel. Alternatively, it can
– Dissimilar carrier schemes are recom- be used as time-delayed backup protec-
5 mended for main 1 and main 2 protec- tion.
tion, for example PUTT, and POTT or
Blocking/Unblocking
6
CC
52L
7SJ600
52R
TC1 TC2
7 CVT
50
50N
51
51N BF
79 67N 79 67N
9 51G 7SJ600
68 68 7SA522 or
BF 85 7SA511 BF
79 79 BF, 59
S Direct Trip
Trip
85 7SA513 R Channel
10 52L
S Channel To remote
R 2 line end
S Channel
R 3
Fig. 91
6/48 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Power System Protection
Typical Protection Schemes
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 6/49
Power System Protection
Typical Protection Schemes
– The location of the CTs on both sides of – For the selection of the main 1 and main one breaker and the manual closure of
the circuit-breakers is typical for substa- 2 line protection schemes, the com- the other breaker, may be made selecta-
1 tions with dead-tank breakers. Live-tank ments of application examples 8 and 9 ble by a control switch.
breakers may have CTs only on one side apply. – A coordinated scheme of control circuits
to reduce cost. A Fault between circuit – Autoreclosure (79) and synchrocheck is necessary to ensure selective tripping,
breakers and CT (end fault) may then function (25) are each assigned directly interlocking and reclosing of the two
still be fed from one side even when the to the circuit breakers and controlled by breakers of one line (or transformer
breaker has opened. Consequently, final main 1 and 2 line protection in parallel. feeder).
2 fault clearing by cascaded tripping has to In case of a line fault, both adjacent – The voltages for synchrochecking have
be accepted in this case. breakers have to be tripped by the line to be selected according to the breaker
The 7SV512 relay provides the neces- protection. The sequence of automatic and isolator positions by a voltage repli-
sary end fault protection function and reclosure of both breakers or, alterna- ca circuit.
trips the breakers of the remaining in- tively, the automatic reclosure of only
3 feeding circuits.
4 87 7SS5. or
BB1 7VH83
BB1
7SV512 or
7VK512 7SV600
BF 85
5 UBB1 7SA522 or
1) 1) 2) 7SA511
79 21 50 51
21N 67N 50N 51N 59
52
UBB1
25
6 UL1 or UL2
or UBB2 UL1
Line 1
79
52
UL1 or UBB1
8 25
UL2 or UBB2
BF
7SV512 or
7SV600
Line 2
9 7VK512 UL2
79
Main 1
UL2 or 52 Protection of Line 2
UL1 or UBB1 (or transformer,
10 25
Main 2 if applicable)
UBB2
UBB2
BF
7SV512 or
7SV600
BB2
87 7SS5. or
BB2 7VH83
Fig. 93
6/50 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Power System Protection
Typical Protection Schemes
52
o/c- Fuse
relay
Load Load
5
Fig. 94
51 51N
52 7SJ60
10
Load bus, e.g. 13.8 kV
52 52
Load Load
Fig. 95
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 6/51
Power System Protection
Typical Protection Schemes
4 7SJ60 51G
I>> IE>
7SJ60
51 51N
5 52
Load
bus
52 52 52
Load
6
Fig. 96
same as
63 infeed 1
7SJ62
9 51G IE>, t I>, t IE>, t I> IE>
51 51N 67 67N
7SJ60
10 1)
52 52
Load
bus
52 52 52
Fig. 97
6/52 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Power System Protection
Typical Protection Schemes
7SJ60 7SJ60
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 6/53
Power System Protection
Typical Protection Schemes
17. Autotransformer
7SJ60 or
1 7SJ61 52
Notes:
1) 87N high-impedance protection requires
51N 50 46 50 87N 7VH80 special class X current transformer cores
BF 51 2)
with equal transmission ratio.
2) The 7SJ60 relay can alternatively be
1)
2 connected in series with the 7UT513 re-
lay to save this CT core.
General hint:
7UT513 87T 49
63 – Two different protection schemes are
provided:
3 87T is chosen as low-impedance three-
52 52 winding version (7UT513). 87N is a sin-
1) gle-phase high-impedance relay (7VH80)
50
51 connected as restricted ground fault pro-
51 tection. (In this example, it is assumed
4 46 that the phaseends of the transformer
winding are not accessible on the neu-
50 tral side, i.e. there exists a CT only in the
59N BF 1) 50
BF neutral grounding connection.)
7RW60 7SJ60
51N
5
7SJ60
Fig. 100
6
18. Large autotransformer bank
68
21 21N 78 7SA513 General hints:
7SV600 7SV600
– The transformer bank is connected in a
7 50 50 11/2 breaker arrangement.
BF BF Duplicated differential protection is pro-
EHV 52 52 posed:
Main 1: Low-impedance differential pro-
tection 87TL (7UT513) connected to the
transformer bushing CTs.
8 HV
Main 2: High-impedance overall differen-
tial protection 87TH (7VH83). Separate
87 50 class X cores and equal CT ratios are re-
7VH83 TH BF 7SV600 quired for this type of protection.
52 – Back-up protection is provided by dis-
9 tance relays (7SA513 and 7SA511), each
7SA511 “looking“ with an instantaneous first
7UT513 87 49 zone about 80% into the transformer
TL 21 and with a time-delayed zone beyond
63 the transformer.
– The tertiary winding is assumed to feed
10 21N a small station supply network with iso-
52 lated neutral.
68
78
51
52
50
BF 50
BF 7SV600
59N 51G
6/54 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Power System Protection
Typical Protection Schemes
3
b) With high-resistance grounded infeed
(IE ≤ IN Motor)
Notes: 52 I>> ϑ> Locked I 2> I<
rotor
1) Window-type zero sequence CT. 49 7SJ62 or
2) Sensitive directional ground-fault protec-
50 49
CR 46 37
7SJ551 4
tion 67N only applicable with infeed 3)
from isolated or Peterson-coil-grounded I E> 2)
network. 7XR96
(For dimensioning of the sensitive direc- 1) 51G 67G
tional ground fault protection, see also 60/1A
application circuit No. 24)
5
3) If 67G ist not applicable, relay 7SJ602
can be applied.
M
Fig. 102b 6
20. Large HV motors > about 1 MW
Notes:
7SJ62 or
1) Window-type zero sequence CT. 7SJ551 7
2) Sensitive directional ground-fault protec-
tion 67N only applicable with infeed 52 I>> ϑ> Locked I2> U<
from isolated or Peterson-coil-grounded rotor
network. 50 49 49 46 27
3) This function is only needed for motors CR
where the runup time is longer than the
8
Optional
safe stall time tE. IE> 2) I< 37
According to IEC 79-7, the tE-time is the 7XR96
1) 51G 67G
time needed to heat up AC windings, 60/1A
when carrying the starting current IA,
from the temperature reached in rated Startup 9
service and at maximum ambient tem- super- 49T 87M 7UT512
perature to the limiting temperature. visior 3) 5) 6)
A separate speed switch is used to
supervise actual starting of the motor. 3)
The motor breaker is tripped if the motor Speed RTD's 4)
does not reach speed in the preset time. switch M 10
optional
The speed switch is part of the motor
delivery itself.
4) Pt100, Ni100, Ni120
5) 49T only available with relay type 7SJ5
6) High impedance relay 7VH83 may be
used instead of 7UT12 if separate
class x CTs. are provided at the terminal
and star-point side of the motor winding. Fig. 103
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 6/55
Power System Protection
Typical Protection Schemes
Note:
MV 1) If a window-type zero-sequence CT is
4 provided for sensitive ground fault pro-
tection, relay 7SJ602 with separate
G1 I>, IE>, t I2> ϑ> ground current input can be used
(similar to Fig. 102b of application exam-
Generator 2 51
46 49 7SJ60 ple 19b).
51N
1)
5
VN
RN =
√3 • (0.5 to 1) • Irated
6
Fig. 104b: With resistance grounded neutral
8
Field
9 G 64R
51 32 46 40 7UM511
10
IE>, t
51G
Fig. 105
6/56 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Power System Protection
Typical Protection Schemes
IE>, t 7UM511
5
51G
6
Fig. 106
Fig. 107
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 6/57
Power System Protection
Typical Protection Schemes
6/58 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Power System Protection
Typical Protection Schemes
Notes: 1
1) 100% stator ground-fault protection
based on 20 Hz voltage injection
52 2) Sensitive field ground-fault protection
63 Transf. fault press based on 1 Hz voltage injection
Unit
trans.
3) Only used functions shown, further 2
71 Oil low integrated functions available in each re-
87 lay type (see ”Relay Selection Guide“,
TU
Fig. 43).
51 3
TN
Transf. neut. OC Unit aux.
backup
87U
Unit diff.
51
Oil low
4
Transf.
fault press 71
63
5
Unit
Overvolt. 59 aux.
81N
51 6
Overfreq. TN
78
Trans.
Loss of 24 neut.
sync. OC
Volt/Hz
40 87T
Stator A 7
O.L. Loss of Trans.
field diff.
49S 32
E
Reverse 8
G 87G power Relay
type
Functions 3) Number
of relays
Gen. required
2) diff.
64
R2 64R
7UM511 40 46 59 81N 49 64R 1 9
Field Field 46 21
grd. grd. 59
Neg. Sys. 7UM516 32 21 78 1
seq. backup GN
1) 2)
7UM515 24 51 64
R2
1 10
59 GN
GN
2
Gen. 7UT512 87G 87T and optionally 87 optionally
neut. OV TU 3
51 1)
GN
7UT513 87U 1
7SJ60 51N 51 3
Fig. 109
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 6/59
Power System Protection
Typical Protection Schemes
Reverse interlocking
3 I>, t0 I>, t
50 51 7SJ60
50N 51N
52
4 t0 = 50 ms
52 52 52
I> I>, t I> I>, t I> I>, t
6 50 51 50 51 50 51
50N 51N 50N 51N 50N 51N
8 Fig. 110
10
6/60 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Power System Protection
Typical Protection Schemes
Bus tie 87
protection BB 10
52 52
86
Feeder Feeder
protection protection
BF
Load Back-feed
Fig. 112
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 6/61
Power System Protection
Protection Coordination
4 3.0
Phase-fault relays
2.0
The pick-up values of phase o/c relays are
normally set 30% above the maximum 1.0
load current, provided that sufficient short-
5 circuit current is available. 2 10 100 400
This practice is recommmended in particu- Rated transformer power [MVA]
lar for mechanical relays with reset ratios
of 0.8 to 0.85.
Time constant of inrush current
Numerical relays have high reset ratios
near 0.95 and allow therefore about 10%
6 lower setting. Nominal power 0.5 . . . 1.0 1.0 . . . 10 >10
Feeders with high transformer and/or [MVA]
motor load require special consideration.
Time constant 0.16 . . . 0.2 0.2 . . . 1.2 1.2 . . . 720
Transformer feeders [s]
7 The energizing of transformers causes
inrush currents that may last for seconds,
depending on their size (Fig. 113).
Fig. 113: Transformer inrush currents, typical data
Selection of the pickup current and as-
signed time delay have to be coordinated
so that the rush current decreases below High-resistance grounding requires much An even more sensitive setting is applied
8 the relay o/c reset value before the set more sensitive setting in the order of in isolated or Peterson-coil-grounded net-
operating time has elapsed. some amperes primary. works where very low ground currents occur
The rush current typically contains only The ground-fault current of motors and with single-phase-to-ground faults.
about 50% fundamental frequency compo- generators, for example, should be limited Settings of 20 mA and less may then be
nent. to values below 10 A in order to avoid iron required depending on the minimum
burning. ground-fault current.
9 Numerical relays that filter out harmonics
Sensitive directional ground-fault relays
and the DC component of the rush current Residual-current relays in the star point
can therefore be set more sensitive. The connection of CTs can in this case not be (integrated in the relays 7SJ512, 7SJ55
inrush current peak values of Fig. 113 will used, in particular with rated CT primary and 7SA511) allow settings as low as 5 mA.
be nearly reduced to one half in this case. currents higher than 200 A. The pickup
value of the zero-sequence relay would
10 Ground-fault relays
in this case be in the order of the error
currents of the CTs.
Residual-current relays enable a much A special zero-sequence CT is therefore
more sensitive setting, as load currents do used in this case as ground current sensor.
not have to be considered (except 4-wire The window-type current transformer
circuits with single-phase load). In solidly 7XR96 is designed for a ratio of 60/1 A.
and low-resistance grounded systems a The detection of 6 A primary would then
setting of 10 to 20% rated load current is require a relay pickup setting of 0.1 A
generally applied. secondary.
6/62 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Power System Protection
Protection Coordination
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 6/63
Power System Protection
Protection Coordination
1 Operating time
52 M
51
2 M
52 F 52 F
51 51
3 F F
0.2–0.4
Time grading
4
Fault Fault Interruption of
inception detection fault current
6 Overshoot*
tOS
I> Margin tM
t51M
Example 1
9
Mechanical relays: tOS = 0.15 s
Oil circuit-breaker t52F = 0.10 s tTG = 0.10 + 0.15 + 0.15 = 0.40 s
Safety margin for measuring errors,
etc.: tM = 0.15
10
Example 2
6/64 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Power System Protection
Protection Coordination
Calculation example
The feeder configuration of Fig. 117 and Example: Time grading of inverse-time relays for a radial feeder
the assigned load and short-circuit currents 1
are given. Load
Numerical o/c relays 7SJ60 with normal A F4 B F3 C F2 13.8 kV/ Fuse: D F1
inverse-time characteristic are applied. 0.4 kV 160 A
The relay operating times dependent on Load
13.8 kV
current can be taken from the diagram or
1.0 MVA
L.V. 75. 2
derived from the formula given in Fig. 118.
51 7SJ60 51 7SJ60 51 7SJ60 5.0%
The IP /IN settings shown in Fig. 117 have Load
been chosen to get pickup values safely
above maximum load current. Station Max. Load Iscc. max.* CT ratio Ip/IN ** Iprim*** Iscc. max.
I /Ip =
This current setting shall be lowest for [A] [A] [A] Iprim
the relay farthest downstream. The relays 3
further upstream shall each have equal or A 300 4500 400/5 1.0 400 11.25
higher current setting. 2690 200/5 1.1 220 12.23
B 170
The time multiplier settings can now be
calculated as follows: C 50 1395 100/5 0.7 70 19.93
Station C: D – 523 – – – – 4
*) Iscc.max. = Maximum short-circuit current
■ For coordination with the fuses, we
** Ip/IN = Relay current multiplier setting
consider the fault in location F1. *** Iprim = Primary setting current corresponding to Ip/IN
The short-circuit current related to
13.8 kV is 523 A. Fig. 117
This results in 7.47 for I/IP at the o/c 5
relay in location C.
■ With this value and TP = 0.05 The setting values for the relay at station B
are herewith t [s]
we derive from Fig. 118
an operating time of tA = 0.17 s ■ Current tap: IP /IN = 1.1 100
This setting was selected for the o/c relay ■ Time multiplier TP = 0.11 6
to get a safe grading time over the fuse on Given these settings, we can also check 50
the transformer low-voltage side. the operating time of the relay in B for a 40
The setting values for the relay at station C close-in fault in F3: 30
are therefore: The short-circuit current increases in this Tp [s]
20
■ Current tap: IP /IN = 0.7 case to 2690 A (see Fig. 117). The corre-
sponding I/IP value is 12.23.
7
■ Time multipler: TP = 0.05 10
■ With this value and the set value of 3.2
Station B: TP = 0.11 5
The relay in B has a back-up function for we obtain again from Fig. 118 4
the relay in C. an operating time of 0.3 s. 1.6
3
The maximum through-fault current of 8
1.395 A becomes effective for a fault in Station A: 2 0.8
location F2. ■ We add the time grading interval of
For the relay in C, we obtain an operating 0.3 s and find the desired operating time 1 0.4
time of 0.11 s (I/IP = 19.9). tA = 0.3 + 0.3 = 0.6 s.
We assume that no special requirements
for short operating times exist and can
Following the same procedure as for the 0.50
0.4 0.2 9
relay in station B we obtain the following
therefore choose an average time grading values for the relay in station A: 0.3
interval of 0.3 s. The operating time of the 0.1
■ Current tap: IP /IN = 1.0 0.2
relay in B can then be calculated:
■ Time multiplier: TP = 0.17
■ tB = 0.11 + 0.3 = 0.41 s 0.05
■ Value of IP /IN = 1395 A = 6.34
■ For the close-in fault at location F4 we 0.1 10
obtain an operating time of 0.48 s.
220 A
0.05
see Fig. 117.
■ With the operating time 0.41 s
2 4 6 8 10 20
and IP /IN = 6.34, Normal inverse I/Ip [A]
we can now derive TP = 0.11 0.14
from Fig. 118. t= . Tp [s]
(I/Ip)0.02 – 1
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 6/65
Power System Protection
Protection Coordination
1
= 16.000 kA
Iscc = 1395 A
Iscc = 2690 A
Imax = 4500 A
I – 0.4 kVmax
8
Fig. 119: O/c time grading diagram
6/66 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Power System Protection
Protection Coordination
Secondary I2>, t2 n
a
breaker
0.2 seconds LV bus 7
I>>
b)
Fig. 120: Coordination of an o/c relay with an MV fuse and a low-voltage breaker trip device
9
10
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 6/67
Power System Protection
Protection Coordination
X Fig. 123
D
5
X3A ■ Typical settings of the ratio R/X are:
C
– Short lines and cables (≤ 10 km):
X2A R/X = 2 to 10
B – Medium line lengths < 25 km: R/X = 2
6 – Longer lines 25 to 50 km: R/X = 1
X1A
6/68 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Power System Protection
Protection Coordination
(9~) [15~]
8
Fig. 126
10
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 6/69
Power System Protection
Protection Coordination
protection: Verification of design The differential relay must be a high- This check is made by assuming an exter-
1 impedance relay designed as sensitive nal fault with maximum through-fault
current relay (7VH80/83: 20 mA) with current and full saturation of the CT in the
The following design series resistor. If the series resistor is faulted feeder. The saturated CT ist then
data must be established: integrated in the relay, the setting values only effective with its secondary winding
may be directly calibrated in volts, as with resistance RCT, and the appearing relay volt-
2 CT data the relays 7VH80/83 (6 to 60 V or 24 to age VR corresponds to the voltage drop of
The CTs must all have the same ratio and 240 V). the infeeding currents (through-fault
should be of low leakage flux design ac- current) at RCT and RL. The current at the
Sensitivity
cording to Class TPS of IEC 44-6 (Class X relay must under this condition safely stay
of BS 3938). The excitation characteristic For the relay to operate in case of an inter- below the relay pickup value.
and the secondary winding resistance are nal fault, the primary current must reach a In practice, the wiring resistances RL may
3 to be provided by the manufacturer. minimum value to supply the set relay not be equal. In this case, the worst
The knee-point voltage of the CT is required pickup current (IR-set), the varistor leakage condition with the highest relay voltage
to be designed at least for two times the current (Ivar) and the magnetizing currents (corresponding to the highest relay current)
relay pick-up voltage to assure dependable of all parallel-connected CTs (n·ImR). must be sought by considering all possible
operation with internal faults. Low relay voltage setting and CTs with low external feeder faults.
magnetizing demand therefore increase
4 the protection sensitivity.
Setting
The setting is always a trade-off between
1 2 3 n sensitivity and stability. A higher voltage
Voltage limitation by a varistor setting leads to enhanced through-fault
is required if: stability, but, also to higher CT magnetizing
5 RCT RCT RCT RCT
and varistor leakage currents resulting con-
sequently in a higher primary pickup cur-
VRmax = 2 2VKN (VF –VKN) > 2kV
rent.
RL RL RL RL IFmax Through A higher voltage setting also requires a
with VF = (RCT + 2·RL + RR) higher knee-point voltage of the CTs and
N
therefore greater size of the CTs.
6 Fig. 129 A sensitivity of 10 to 20% IN is normal for
motor and transformer differential protec-
RR tion, or for restricted ground-fault protection.
Varistor
With busbar protection a pickup value
87B Calculation example: ≥ 50 % IN is normally applied.
An increased pickup value can be achie-
7 Given: n = 8 feeders
ved by connecting a resistor in parallel to
Fig. 127 N = 600/1 A the relay.
VKN = 500 V
Varistor
RCT = 4 Ohm
Sensitivity: ImR = 30 mA (at relay setpoint) Voltage limitation by a varistor is needed if
8 peak voltages near or above the insulation
IFmin = N·(IRset + Ivar + n·ImR) RL = 3 Ohm (max.) voltage (2 kV) are to be expected. A limita-
Stability: IRset = 20 mA tion to 1500 V rms is then recommended.
RR RR = 10 kOhm This can be checked for the maximum in-
IFThrough max < N· ·I ternal fault current by applying the formula
RL + RCT Rset IVar = 50 mA (at relay setpoint)
shown for VR-max.
N = CT ratio
9 Sensitivity: A restricted ground-fault protection may
IRset = Set relay pickup current normally not require a varistor, but, a bus-
IVar = Varistor spill current IFmin = N·(IRset + Ivar + n·ImR) bar protection in general does.
ImR = CT magnetizing current at The electrical varistor characteristic can be
IFmin = 600 ·(0.02 + 0.05 + 8·0.03) expressed as V=K·IB. K and B are the varis-
relay pickup voltage 1
tor constants.
10 V IFmin = 186 A (31% IN)
VKN Stability:
VKN =CT knee
point voltage RR Relay K B Varistor
IFmaxThrough < N· ·I
RL + RCT Rset setting type
VR =RR·IRset
VR VKN ≥ 2·VR IFmax Through < 600 · 10,000 ·0.02 V rms
1 3+4
≤125 450 0.25 600A/S1/S256
IFmax Through < 17 kA (28·IN)
ImR Im 125–240 900 0.25 600A/S1/S1088
6/70 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Local and Remote Control
Introduction
State-of-the-art
Modern protection and substation control
uses microprocessor technology and serial Traditional protection and substation control
1
communication to upgrade substation op-
eration, to enhance reliability and to reduce
overall life cycle cost.
The traditional conglomeration of often to-
tally different devices such as relays, me- To network control center 2
ters, switchboards and RTUs is replaced by
a few multifunctional, intelligent devices
of uniform design. And, instead of exten-
sive parallel wiring (centralized solution,
Fig. 132), only a few serial links are used
(decentralized solution, Fig. 133). 3
Control of the substation takes place with
menu-guided procedures at a central VDU
workplace. Alarm annunciation
Remote terminal unit and local control
4
Marshalling rack 6
Approx. 20 to
40 cores per bay
8
F F
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 6/71
Local and Remote Control
Introduction
2
Control center
3
Compact central PC
control unit *
including RTU functions
4
5
Printer
6
Profibus Substation LAN
**
8
9
Control Protection Combined protection
I/O unit relay and control relay
Low-voltage compartment
Shown with
10 open door
of the medium-voltage
switchgear
6/72 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Local and Remote Control
Introduction
Substation control and The SICAM family offers of the following – Central process connection
protection system options: – PLC functions
For numerical substation control and pro- ■ SICAM SAS, the substation automation – Communication with Control Center 1
tection system applications, two different system with the following features: ■ SICAM PCC, the PC-based Substation
systems are available: – Principal function: Control System with the following fea-
■ SINAUT LSA substation automation tures:
■ SICAM – Decentralized and centralized process – Principal function: local substation su-
By virtue of their different functions and connection pervision and control 2
specific advantages, the two systems cov- – Local control and monitoring with ar- – Decentralized process connection
er different applications. This means that it chive function – LAN/WAN communication with
is possible to configure an optimum sys- – Communication with the System IEC 60870-6 TASE.2
tem for every application. Control Center – Flexible communication
SINAUT LSA is typically used primarily for ■ SICAM RTU, the telecontrol system with – Linkage to Office® products. 3
medium-voltage and high-voltage applica- central process connection and the fol-
tions in power supply utilities. lowing features:
The principal use for SICAM products is – Principal function: information commu-
currently in medium-voltage applications nication
for power suppliers and industry. 4
Other features in which they differ are Principal application aspects of SINAUT LSA and SICAM
summarized in Fig. 134.
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 6/73
Local and Remote Control
SINAUT LSA – Overview
Technical proceedings
System Control Center Engineering
The first coordinated protection and sub-
1 station control system SINAUT LSA was
Analysis
commissioned in 1986 and continuously
further developed over subsequent years.
It now features the following main charac-
teristics: Operator’s LSA
desk PROCESS Time signal
2 ■ Coordinated system structure
■ Optical communication network
(star configuration) VDU Modem
■ High processing power
(32-bit µP technology) Station Event Logger
level Modem
3 ■ Standardized serial interfaces and com-
munication protocols
■ Uniform design of all components
■ Complete range of protection and con- ”Master Unit“ (i. e. 6MB55)
trol functions
1… …n
4 ■ Comprehensive user-software support
packages.
Currently (1999) over 1500 systems are in
Bay Control Unit Bay Protection 7S
successful operation on all voltage levels Bay 6 MB 524 including
up to 400 kV. level interlocking
5 System structure
and scope of functions
The SINAUT LSA system performs super-
visory local control, switchgear interlock- Switchyard
ing, bay and station protection, synchro-
Serial Parallel
6 nizing, transformer tap-changer control,
switching sequence programs, event and
Fig. 135: Distributed structure of coordinated protection and control system SINAUT LSA
fault recording, telecontrol, etc.
It consists of the independent subsystems
(Fig. 135): Data sharing between protection and con- ing: local feeder control, overcurrent and
■ Supervisory control 6MB5** trol via the so-called informative interface overload protection, breaker-failure protec-
7 ■ Protection 7S*** according to IEC 60 870-5-103 is restricted tion and metering.
to noncritical measuring or event recording
Normally, switchgear interlocking is inte- functions. The protection units, for exam-
grated as a software program in the super- ple, deliver r.m.s. values of currents, volt- Supervisory control
visory control system. Local bay control is ages, power, instantaneous values for os- The substation is monitored and controlled
implemented in the bay-dedicated I/O con- cillographic fault recording and time-tagged from the operator‘s desk (Fig. 136). The
8 trol units 6MB524. operating events for fault reporting. VDU shows overview diagrams and com-
For complex substations with multiple bus- Besides the high data transmission securi- plete details of the switchgear including
bars, however, the interlocking function ty, the system also provides self-monitor- measurands on a color display. All event
can also be provided as an independent ing of individual components. and alarm annunciations are selectable in
backup system (System 8TK). The distributed structure also makes the the form of lists. The control procedure is
9 Communication and data exchange be- SINAUT LSA system attractive for refur- menu-guided and uses mouse and keyboard.
tween components is performed via serial bishment programs or extensions, where The operation is therefore extremely user-
data links. Optical-fiber connections are conventional secondary equipment has to friendly.
preferred to ensure EMI compatibility. be integrated.
The communication structure of the con- It is general practice to provide protection Automatic functions
trol system is designed as a hierarchical of HV and EHV substations as separate, Apart from the switchgear interlocking pro-
10 star configuration. It operates in the polling self-contained relays that can communi- vided, a series of automatic functions en-
procedure with a fixed assignment of the cate with the control system, but function sure effective and secure system operation.
master function to the central unit. The otherwise completely independently. Automatic switching sequences, such as
data transmission mode is asynchronous, At lower voltage levels, however, higher changing of busbars, can be user-pro-
half-duplex, protected with a hamming integrated solutions are accepted for cost grammed and started locally or remotely.
distance d = 4, and complies with the reasons. Furthermore, the synchronizing function
IEC Standard 60 870-5. For distribution-type substations combined has been integrated into the system soft-
Each subsystem can operate fully in stand- protection and control feeder units (e.g. ware and is available as an option.
alone mode even in the event of loss of 7SJ63) are available which integrate all
communication. necessary functions of one feeder, includ-
6/74 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Local and Remote Control
SINAUT LSA – Overview
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 6/75
Local and Remote Control
SINAUT LSA – Overview
Numerical protection
A complete range of fully digital (numeri-
1 cal) relays is available (see chapter Power
System Protection 6/8 and following System Management
pages). control terminal
They all have a uniform design compatible center
with the control units (Fig. 139). This ap-
2 plies to the hardware as well as to the soft-
ware structure and the operating proce- Modem
dures. Metallic standard cases, IEC 60255-
tested, with EMI-secure terminals, ensure
an uncomplicated application comparable VF Modem
to mechanical relays. The LCD display and
3 setting keypad are integrated. Additionally
a RS232 port is provided on the front panel Remote control Telephone network
for the connection of a PC as an HMI.
The rear terminal block contains an optical-
fiber interface for the data communication VF Modem
with the SINAUT LSA control system.
4 The relays are normally linked directly to Substation
the relevant I/O control unit at the bay level
level. Connection to the central control
system unit is, however, also possible. ERTU
The numerical relays are multifunctional
5 and contain, for example, all the necessary
protection functions for a line feeder or Printer Operator
transformer. At higher voltage levels, addi- Marshalling rack terminal
tional, main or back-up relays are applied.
The new relay generation has extended
memory capacity for fault recording (5 sec- Bay level Interposing relays,
6 onds, 1 ms resolution) and nonvolatile transducers
memory for important fault information.
The serial link between protection and con-
trol uses standard protocols in accordance Existing
with IEC 60870-5-103. Extended switchyard
switchyard
7 In this way, supplier compatibility and
interchangeability of protection devices is
achieved. Fig. 140: Enhanced remote terminal unit 6MB55, application options
6/76 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Local and Remote Control
SINAUT LSA – Overview
Master unit
6
Loading of
parameters 7
Downloading of parameters
during startup 8
PC inputs
Input/output
units
10
Fig. 142: PC-aided parameterization of SINAUT LSA with LSATOOLS and downloading of parameters
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 6/77
Local and Remote Control
SINAUT LSA – Distributed Structure
6/78 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Local and Remote Control
SINAUT LSA – Distributed Structure
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 6/79
Local and Remote Control
SINAUT LSA – Distributed Structure
6MD637 4 + 83) 1 16 1 – –
7SJ636 7 + 83) – 16 1 4 x I, 3 x U 2
10
1) Local (bay) control has to be provided separately if desired. In distribution-
type substations, mechanical local control of the switchgear may be sufficient.
2) Control of switching devices: 11/ -pole; 2-pole control possible
2
3) Second figure is number of heavy duty relays
6/80 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Local and Remote Control
SINAUT LSA – Distributed Structure
The 6MB51 control master unit System monitoring primarily involves eval-
This unit lies at the heart of the 6MB sub- uating the self-monitoring results of the
station control system and, with its 32-bit devices and serial interfaces which are 1
80486 processor, satisfies the most de- coordinated by the control master unit.
manding requirements. In particular, in important EHV substations,
It is a compact unit inside the standard some users require redundancy of the con-
housing used in Siemens substation sec- trol master unit. In these cases, two con-
trol master units are connected to each
ondary equipment.
other via a serial interface. System moni-
2
The 6MB51 control master unit manages
the input/output devices, controls the inter- toring then consists of mutual error recog-
action between the control centers in the nition and, if necessary, automatic transfer
substation and the higher control levels, of control of the process to the redundant
processes information for the entire station control master unit.
and archives data in accordance with the 3
parameterized requirements of the user. The SINAUT LSA station control center
Specifically, the control master unit coordi-
nates communication The standard equipment of the station con-
trol center includes
■ to the higher network control levels
■ The PC with color monitor and LSAVIEW
■ to the substation control center
software package for displaying Fig. 150: Compact control master unit 6MB513 for a
4
■ to an analysis center located either in maximum of 32 serial interfaces to bay control units.
the station or connected remotely via – Station overview
Extended version 6MB514 for 64 serial interfaces to
a telephone line using a modem – Detailed pictures bay control units (double width) additionally available
■ to the input/output devices and/or the – Event and alarm lists
numerical protection units (bay control – Alarm information
units)
5
■ A printer for the output reports
■ to lower-level stations. The operator can access the required infor-
This is for the purpose of controlling and mation or initiate the desired operation
monitoring activities at the substation and quickly and safely with just a few keystrokes.
network control levels as well as providing
data for use by engineers. 6
Other tasks of the control master unit are
■ Event logging with a time resolution of
1 or 10 ms
■ Archiving of events, variations in meas-
ured values and fault records on mass-
7
storage units
■ Time synchronization using radio clock
(GPS, DCF77 or Rugby) or using a signal
from a higher-level control station
■ Automation tasks affecting more than 8
one bay:
– Parallel control of transformers
– Synchronizing
(measured value selection)
– Switching sequences 9
– Busbar voltage simulation
– Switchgear interlocking
■ Parameter management to meet the
relevant requirements specification
■ Self-monitoring and system monitoring. 10
Fig. 151: SINAUT LSA PC station control center with function keyboard
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 6/81
Local and Remote Control
SINAUT LSA – Local Control Functions
6/82 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Local and Remote Control
SINAUT LSA – Local Control Functions
Event list
All events are logged in chronological or-
der. The event list can be displayed on the 1
VDU whenever called or printed out on
a printer or stored on a mass-storage me-
dium. Fig. 153 shows a section of this
event list as it appears on the VDU.
The event list can also be incorporated in 2
the detailed displays. The bay-related
events can therefore also be shown in the
detailed displays.
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 6/83
Local and Remote Control
SINAUT LSA – Local Control Functions
4
Fig. 153: SINAUT LSA substation control, example: overview picture Fig. 154: SINAUT LSA substation control, example: event list
Fig. 155: SINAUT LSA substation control, example: alarm list Fig. 156: 6MB substation control system, example: fault recording
9
Example fault recording (Fig. 156) 12 ms after the general start, the circuit The important point is that this fault re-
breaker was tripped (OFF) and after further cording is possible in all feeders that are
After a fault, the millisecond-precision val- 80 ms, the fault was cleared. equipped with the microprocessor-control-
ues for the phase currents and voltages After approx. 120 ms the protection reset. led protection having a serial interface
10 and the ground current and ground voltage Voltage recovery after disconnection was according to IEC 60870-5-103.
are buffered in the feeder protection. recorded up to 600 ms after the general
These values are called from the numerical start.
feeder protection by the control master
unit and can be output as curves with the This format permits quick and clear analy-
program LSAPROCESS (Fig. 156). sis of a fault. The correct operation of the
The time marking 0 indicates the time of protection and the circuit breaker can be
fault detection, i.e. the relay general start seen in the fault recording (Fig. 156).
(GS). Approx. 5 ms before the general The high-voltage feeder protection present-
start, a three-phase fault to ground oc- ly includes a time range of at least 5 sec-
curred, which can be seen by the rise in onds for the fault recording.
phase currents and the ground current.
6/84 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Local and Remote Control
SINAUT LSA – Application Examples
Application examples
1
The flexible use of the components of the
Coordinated Protection and Substation
Control System SINAUT LSA is demon- Bay 1 2 n Bus coupler
strated in the following for some typical
application examples.
2
Application in high-voltage substations
with relay kiosks
Fig. 157 shows the arrangement of the
local components. Each two bays (line or 3
transformer) are assigned to one kiosk.
Each bay has at least one input/output unit
for control (bay control unit) and one pro-
tection unit. In extra-high voltage, the pro-
tection is normally doubled (main and back-
up protection). 4
Local control is performed at the bay units
(6MB524) using the integrated graphic dis- FPR FPR FPR FPR
play and keypad. BCU BCU BCU BCU
Switchgear interlocking is included in the
Relay
bay control units and in the central control
kiosks 5
unit.
The protection relays are serially connect-
ed to the bay control unit by optical-fiber
links. To the network
Control control center
building
6
CCU with
CCC and MS Modem
To the operations
and maintenance
office
Parallel 7
VDU
Serial
8
Key:
CCU Central control unit VDU Visual display unit
CCC Control center coupling FPR Feeder protection relays
MS Mass storage BCU Bay control unit 9
Fig. 157: Application example of outdoor HV or EHV substations with relay kiosks
10
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 6/85
Local and Remote Control
SINAUT LSA – Application Examples
5 Local
control •••••••••••• ••••••••••••
level
Bay
control level
6
••••••••••
8
Feeder 1 Switchgear Feeder n
9 Parallel Serial
*only principle shown
10
6/86 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Local and Remote Control
SINAUT LSA – Application Examples
Protection and substation control SINAUT LSA with input/output units and numerical
protection installed in low-voltage compartments of the switchgear
7
VDU with keyboard Printer Network control Operation place
center
Fig. 160: Protection and substation control system SINAUT LSA for a distribution-type substation
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 6/87
Local and Remote Control
SINAUT LSA – Application Examples
Switching status
8
close close
CB ON/OFF 2) or 2) or 2)
open trip
9 Protection Short-circuiting
core I facility
10
U
6/88 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Local and Remote Control
SINAUT LSA – Application Examples
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 6/89
Local and Remote Control
SINAUT LSA – Application Examples
1
To load dispatch
center
Central
control
2 unit
To transformer 6MB513
GPS
feeders
OF VDU Printer Mass
(option) storage
OF
3
OF
4 RS485/O F
RS485
5
7 51
M M M M
51 51 51 51
Load currents are taken from the protection relays Measuring values
1 x 7KG60 (3 x V, 3 x I) from protection
Control
Fig. 165: Typical I/O signal requirements for feeders of a distribution-type substation
6/90 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Local and Remote Control
SINAUT LSA – Centralized (RTU) Structure
Enhanced remote
terminal units 6MB551 System Station control center (option) Central evaluation 1
control center station (PC)
The 6MB55 telecontrol system is based on
the same hardware and software modules
Remote control Telephone channel
as the 6MB51 substation control system. channel
The functions of the inupt/output devices 2
have been taken away from the bays and Radio time
relocated to the central unit at station con- (option)
trol level. The result is the 6MB551 en-
hanced remote terminal unit (ERTU). Enhanced terminal unit 6MB551
Special plug-in modules for control and
acquisition of process signals are used 3
instead of the bay dedicated input/output 1 … … n
devices: Marshalling rack
■ Digital input (32 DI) Station protection
Transducers and 7SS5
■ Analog input (32 AI grouped, interposing relays
16 AI isolated) 4
■ Command output (32 CO) and
(option) (option)
■ Command enabling
These modules communicate with the
central modules in the same frame via the
internal standard LSA bus. The bus can be 5
extended to further frames by parallel in- Protection relay Bay Control Unit
terfaces. 7S/7U 6MB52*
The 6MB551 station control unit therefore
has the basic structure of a remote termi-
nal unit but offers all the functions of the
6MB51 substation control system such as:
6
Substation Extension to substation
Communication
■ to the higher network control levels Serial interface Parallel interface
■ to an analysis center located either in
the station or connected remotely via Fig. 166: Protection and substation control system LSA 678 for a distribution-type substation 7
a telephone line using a modem
■ to the bay control unit and/or the numer-
ical protection units (bay control units)
■ to lower-level stations (node function).
This is for the purpose of controlling and 8
monitoring activities at the substation and
network control levels as well as providing
data for system planning and analysis.
10
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 6/91
Local and Remote Control
SINAUT LSA – Centralized (RTU) Structure
Other tasks of the enhanced RTU are These distributed input/output devices
■ Event logging with a time resolution of can then be connected via serial interface
1 1 or 10 ms to the telecontrol equipment. Additional
■ Archiving of events, variations in meas- parameterization takes care of their actual
ured values and fault records on mass integration in the operational hierarchy.
storage units The 6MB551 RTU system is also available
■ Time synchronization using radio clock as standard cubicle version SINAUT LSA
2 (GPS, DCF77 or Rugby) or using a signal COMPACT 6MB5540. The modules and
from a higher-level control station the bus system have been kept; the rack
■ Automation tasks affecting more than design and the connection technology,
one bay: however, have been cost-optimized (fixed
rack only and plug connectors).
– Parallel control of transformers
This version is limited to a baseframe
3 – Synchronizing plus one extension frame with altogether
(measured value selection) 33 I/O modules, and a maximum of 5 seri-
– Switching sequences al interfaces for telecontrol connection
– Busbar voltage simulation without communication to bay control
– Switchgear interlocking units or numerical protection units.
4 ■ Parameter management to meet the
relevant requirements specification
■ Self-monitoring and system monitoring.
■ Up to 96 serial fiber-optic interfaces to
distributed bay control units
■ Up to 5 expansion frames.
5 Configuration including signal I/O modules
can be parameterized as desired.
Up to 121 signal I/O modules can be used
Fig. 167: 6MB551 enhanced remote terminal unit, in-
stalled in an 8MC standard cubicle with baseframe (21 per frame minus one in the baseframe
and expansion frame for each expansion frame, i.e. totally
6 6 x 21 – 5 = 121).
The 6MB551 station control unit can
therefore be expanded from having simple
telecontrol data processing functions to
assuming the complex functionality of a
7 substation control system.
The same applies to the process signal
capacity. In one unit, more than 4 000 data
points can be addressed and, by means of
serial interfacing of subsystems, this figure
can be increased even further.
8 The 6MB551 station control unit simplifies
the incorporation of extensions to the sub-
station by using the decentralized 6MB52*
bay control units for the additional substa-
tion bays.
9
10
6/92 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Local and Remote Control
SINAUT LSA – Remote Terminal Units
Fig. 168: 6MB552 compact RTU for medium process Fig. 169: SINAUT LSA COMPACT 6MB5540 remote Fig. 171: 6MB5530-1 remote terminal unit (RTC) with
signal capacity terminal unit installed in a cubicle cable-shield communication 7
Design Type Single Alarm Analog Serial ports Serial ports
commands inputs inputs to control to bay units
centers
8
Minicompact 6MB5530-0A 8 8 – 1 –
RTU* 6MB5530-0B 8 24 8
6MB5530-0C 8 32 –
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 6/93
Local and Remote Control
SINAUT LSA – Remote Terminal Units
1 Control Control
center center
1… …n
2
Modem Modem
Telecontrol channel
3
Substation
level
Modem
Point to point con. 1)
4 RTU M M
Line connection 1) Optical fiber
M
M M …… M 1)
M
1)
RTU RTU RTU M
5
2) 2) 2)
RTU Marshalling rack
Bay level Protection
M relays and
Interposing relays, transducers I/O units
RTU M Loop configuration
6
M Existing switchgear Extended switchgear
1) Telecontrol channel
RTU 2) Only with compact RTU 6MB552
M = Modem
RTU interfaces
The described RTUs are connected to the
switchgear via interposing relays and meas-
8 uring transducers (± 2.5 to ± 20 mA DC)
(Fig. 173). Serial connection of numerical
protection relays and control I/O units is
possible with the compact RTU type
6MB552.
9 The communication protocols for the serial
connection to system control centers can
be IEC standard 870-5-101 or the Siemens
proprietary protocols 8FW.
For the communication with protection
relays, the IEC standard 870-5-103 is im-
10 plemented.
Besides these standard protocols, more
than 100 legacy protocols including deriva-
tives are implemented for remote control
links up to system control centers and
down to remote substations (see table
overleaf).
6/94 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Local and Remote Control
SINAUT LSA – Remote Terminal Units
5
Higher telecontrol level
Power cable (typically 5 km)
…
6
Modem VF couplers VF couplers VF couplers VF couplers
(optional)
Signal Modem Modem
loop Channel 1 Channel 2 Channel 1 Channel 2
Branch 1
Mini RTU Mini RTU
6MB5530-1 (RTC) 6MB5530-1 (RTC) 7
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
8
Multiplexer Distribution station Distribution station
(optional) … Branch 2 1st station of branch 1 16th station of branch 1
Modem …
Channel 1 Channel 2 Power cable (typically 5 km)
Communication … 9
control unit
6MB5530-1 (CCU) VF couplers VF couplers VF couplers
Signal Modem Modem
loop Channel 1 Channel 2 Channel 1 Channel 2
VF couplers
Mini RTU Mini RTU 10
6MB5530-1 (RTC) 6MB5530-1 (RTC)
Substation Substation
1st station of branch 8 16th station of branch 8
Fig. 175: Remote control network based on remote terminal units with cable-shield communication
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 6/95
Local and Remote Control
SICAM – Overview
3
The SICAM family consists of the follow-
ing individual systems (see Fig. 176): Marshalling rack ... ...
■ SICAM RTU, the telecontrol system with
the following features Interposing relays, transducers SIMEAS IEDs
Q or T Trans- (Relays, etc.)
– Principal function: information transfer ducers
– Central process connection Switchgear
– PLC functions
4 – Communication with control center SICAM SAS
■ SICAM SAS, the decentralized automa-
tion system System Control center
– Principal function: substation automa- SICAM IEC 60 870-5-101
tion WinCC
5 – Decentralized and centralized process
connection
– Local operation and monitoring with
archiving functions
– Communication with the control
6 center
PROFIBUS
9 System
Control center
10 PROFIBUS
IEC 60870-5-103
SIPROTEC 4
Protection and Other IEDs Protection relays
control devices
*) Siemens PLCs and Industrial Automation
Systems (see Catalog ST70) Fig. 176: The SICAM family
6/96 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Local and Remote Control
SICAM RTU – Design
SICAM
2
Database Data Software Communi- Communication
recording cation
DIGSI CPU
4
7
System control center
SICAM RTU 6MD201 ■ CT and VT graded measuring value ac-
quisition via serially connected numerical
Enhanced Remote Terminal Unit transducers SIMEAS Q or T
(see page 6/132) 8
Overview ■ Acquisition of short-time event signals
with 1 ms resolution and real-time
The SICAM RTU Remote Terminal Unit is stamping
based on the SIMATIC S7-400, a powerful ■ Preprocessing of information acquired
PLC version of the Siemens product range
for industrial automation. The SIMATIC S7-
(e.g. double indications, metered values)
Communication
9
■ Fail-safe process control (e.g., 1-out-of-n
400 has been supplemented by the addi-
tion of modules and functions so as to pro- check, switching current check)
vide a flexible, efficient remote terminal ■ Secure long-distance data transmission SICAM
unit. Based on worldwide used SIMATIC using the IEC 60870-5-101 or SINAUT RTU
8-FW protocol
S7-400, it is possible to add project-specif- 10
ic automation functions to the existing tel- ■ Remote diagnostic capability
econtrol functions. The open and uniform system structure is
The SIMATIC S7-400 System has been ex- illustrated in Fig. 177, showing the essen-
panded to include the following properties: tial modules.
■ All-round isolation of all connections with A variety of SICAM equipment family prod-
2.5 kV electric strength ucts are available depending on the differ-
■ Heavy duty output contacts (10 A, ent requirements and applications.
Central process
150 VDC, 240 AC) on external relay mo- The individual system modules are de- connection
dule (type LR with up to 16 command scribed in detail in the sections below.
relays) Fig. 178: SICAM RTU remote terminal unit
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 6/97
Local and Remote Control
SICAM RTU – Design
System architecture
The SICAM RTU is a modular system. It is
1 suitable for substation sizes from approxi-
mately 300 up to 2048 data points.
The SICAM RTU consists of the:
■ SICAM S7-400 basic rack with its exten-
sion facilities and
2 ■ Any S7-400 CPU (412 to 477, with/with-
out PROFIBUS connection). As standard
CPU, the CPU 412 or CPU 413 is used.
To supplement the SIMATIC S7-400 mod-
ules, telecontrol-specific modules have
3 been developed in order to fulfill the re-
quired properties and functions, such as
for example electric insulation strength and
time resolution.
These are the following modules:
4 ■ Power supply
– Voltage range from 19 V–72 V DC
Fig. 179: SICAM mounting rack
– 88 V–288 V AC/DC
■ Process input and output modules
– Digital input DI (32 inputs) for status
5 indications, counting pulses, bit pat-
terns and transformer tap settings
• voltage ranges:
24–60 V DC
110–125 V DC
– Analog input AI (32 analog inputs
6 grouped, 16 AIR (analog inputs iso-
lated) for currents (0.5 mA–24 mA)
and voltages (0.5 V–10 V)
– Command output (32 CO) for
commands and digital setpoints
7 • voltage range: 24 –125 V DC
– Command release (8 DI, 8 DO) for
local inputs and outputs and monitor-
ing of command output circuits
• voltage ranges:
24–60 V DC
8 110–125 V DC
■ Communication module
– Telecontrol processor TP1 for commu-
nication with the system control cen-
ter with protocols IEC 60870-5-101
9 and SINAUT 8-FW and as time signal
receivers for DCF77 or GPS reception.
The Power Supply and the I/O modules
can also be used in SICAM SAS.
10
6/98 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Local and Remote Control
SICAM RTU – Design
Construction
The SICAM RTU is based on the SIMATIC
S7-400. The construction of the SICAM 1
RTU is therefore, as is the case with
SIMATIC, highly compact, straightforward
and simple to operate:
■ All connections are accessible from the
front. Therefore, no swivel frame is nec- 2
essary.
■ The modules are enclosed and therefore
extremely rugged.
■ Plugging and unplugging of modules is
possible while in operation; therefore 3
maintenance work can be carried out in
a minimum of time (reduced MTTR).
■ Direct process connection is effected by
means of self-coding front plug connec-
tors of screw-in or crimp design.
■ During configuration, no module slot 4
rules have to be observed; the SICAM
RTU permits free module fitting.
■ No forms of setting are necessary on
the modules; replacement can be carried
out in a minimum of time. 5
Dependent on configuration level and cus-
tomer requirements, there are two housing Fig. 180a: SICAM RTU wall-mounting cabinet
variants:
■ a floor-mounting cabinet and
■ a wall-mounting cabinet. 6
Both housing variants are optimized for the
SICAM RTU; they are of flexible modular
construction. Thus, for example, provision
is made for installation of accessories to
provide a cost-effective rack system. 7
10
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 6/99
Local and Remote Control
SICAM RTU – Design
SICAM Modules
SICAM RTU modules have been developed
1 to be SIMATIC-compatible and can there-
fore be used in a standard SIMATIC S7-400,
for example for the following applications:
■ Acquisition of status indications with a
resolution of 1 ms and an accuracy of
2 ± 2 ms
■ Time synchronization of the SIMATIC
CPU to within an accuracy of ± 2 ms
■ An analog input module with 32 channels
with current or voltage inputs
3 ■ Use of modules with 2.5 kV electric insu-
lation strength in order to save interpos-
ing relays
The modules are used for example in hydro-
power plants for acquisition of fault events
via digital input with a resolution of 1 ms
4 and relaying them to a power station sys-
tem, for example via an Industrial Ethernet.
The other application is the use of the com-
munication module TP1 in a SIMATIC NET -
IEC 60870-5-101 gateway. Fig. 182 shows
5 an example of a PROFIBUS gateway.
SICAM RTU
8 IEC 60870-5-101
SINAUT 8-FW
PROFIBUS
Industrial Ethernet
9 Gateway
Profibus
10
IEDs
Switchgear
6/100 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Local and Remote Control
SICAM RTU – Functions
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 6/101
Local and Remote Control
SICAM RTU – Functions
Automation functions
The SICAM RTU is based on the SIMATIC
1 S7-400. Therefore, all modules of the
SIMATIC S7-400 System can be used in a
SICAM RTU: For example, a CPU 413-DP
with PROFIBUS connection or the com-
munication processor CP 441, e.g. for con-
2 nection of a Modbus device.
If additional functions are to be introduced
project-specifically by S7 PLC means,
these can be integrated with the aid of the
internal API Interface (Application Program
Interface). Thus, for example, the data re-
3 ceived via the CP 441 can be processed
internally and sent via the TP1 to the sys-
tem control center.
The following functions can for example
be implemented:
4 ■ Initiate functions by commands from
the system control center
■ Derive commands as a function of
measured value changes (e.g. load
shedding when a frequency drop has
Fig. 184a: Operator Panel
5 been measured)
■ Connection of an operator panel to the
serial system interface (Fig. 184a/b)
■ Connection of decentralized peripherals
via the PROFIBUS DP
6
10
6/102 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Local and Remote Control
SICAM MRTU/microRTU
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 6/103
Local and Remote Control
SICAM miniRTU
IEC 60870-5-101
unbalanced mode
10
Fig. 187: SICAM miniRTU with TCM and three S7-214 CPUs
6/104 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Local and Remote Control
SICAM miniRTU
Communication
Communication with the system control To control center
center is carried out by the SICAM miniRTU Point-to-point traffic 1
with the TCM communicaton module.
A gradable V.21 modem is already integrat-
ed in the TCM, so that the SICAM miniRTU
can be used directly.
Other communication characteristics are: 2
■ Transmission speed of 300 – 9600 bit/ SINAUT LSA
sec. adjustable data concentrator
■ Mode control with 15 priorities which
can be freely assigned
■ Different send lists for: 3
– Spontaneous mode
– Polling mode
– Cyclic mode
Linkage of small remote transmission units
generally takes place by means of trans- 4
mission on demand. The lines with the re- 2-wire, polling mode
mote transmission units are compressed
with the aid of a data concentrator and are
relayed to the system control center.
Fig. 188 shows an example of configura-
tion.
5
Rail-mounted modems with RS-232 inter-
face are available for transmission with an
external modem:
Fig. 188: SICAM miniRTU, typical configuration
■ Gradable V.23 modem with 1200 bit/sec
transmission speed 6
■ Dedicated line modem – V.32 modem – Project-specific expansion options
with a transmission speed of 9600 bit/
In the SICAM miniRTU, an API interface
sec.
(Application Program Interface) is availa-
ble. Project-specific programs can thus be
upgraded. Access by the API interface to 7
communication is supported by the sys-
tem. That is to say, the information from
the control center can be processed in the
user program; information derived in the
user program can be remotely controlled. 8
Examples of this are:
■ Formation of group alarms,
■ Transmitting internally formed meas-
ured values or metered values to the
control center, 9
■ Initiating functions by means of com-
mands from the control center,
■ Influencing of alarm processing,
for example filtering, relaying via API,
■ Activating PROFIBUS link on an S7-215.
10
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 6/105
Local and Remote Control
SICAM miniRTU
Engineering
Parameterizing is effected with the plus- Design RTU Type Single point Single Analog Analog Serial ports
1 TOOLS program for miniRTU. The program information 1) commands 1) inputs outputs to CC
can be run on Windows 95, 98 or NT 4.
Parameterizing takes place operator-guided
by means of menus. Extensive help texts SICAM RTU 6MD201 typical up to 2048 2
facilitate operation. Figs. 190 and 191 illus- maximum: 4096
2 trate as examples the mask for hardware
configuration and the mask for assignment SICAM 6MD202 192 2) 192 2) 36 2) 12 2) 1
of message addresses. miniRTU
The parameters are checked for plausibility SICAM 6MD203 24 16 12 4 1
prior to loading. They are loaded in non- microRTU
3 volatile form from the PC into the flash
EPROM of the TCM. All parameters of a 1)
Processing of double point information and double commands is also
SICAM miniRTU can be read locally with possible. The table is intended solely to represent the number
the PC. For this purpose, the parameter of connection points.
set of the station to be read out does not 2)
Maximum values; note combination options!
have to be present on the PC. Modification
4 and reloading is possible.
Fig. 189: Remote terminal units, process signal volumes
8
Fig. 190: plusTOOLS, generation of hardware configuration Fig. 191: plusTOOLS, parameterizing of communication
10
6/106 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Local and Remote Control
SICAM SAS – Overview
Field of application
5
SICAM SAS is used in power transmission
and distribution for automation of medium-
voltage and high-voltage substations.
It is used wherever: 6
■ Distributed processes are to be moni-
tored and controlled.
■ Functions previously available on a high-
er control level are being decentralized Fig.192: SICAM SAS components: SICAM SC Substation Controller,
and implemented locally.
■ High standards of electric insulation
SIPROTEC 4 relays and 6MB525 bay control units 7
strength and electromagnetic compatibil-
ity are demanded. Functions
■ A real-time capability system is required. SAS assumes the following functions in a
■ Reliability is very important. substation:
■ Communication with other control sys-
8
■ Monitoring
tems must be possible. ■ Data exchange with and operation of se-
rially connected protection devices and
other IEDs
■ Local and remote control with interlock
■ Teleindication
9
■ Automation
■ Local processing and display
■ Archiving and logging
10
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 6/107
Local and Remote Control
SICAM SAS – Structure
System architecture
The typical configuration of a SICAM SAS System control center(s) or telecontrol node(s)
1 consists of:
IEC 60 870-5-101
■ SICAM SC Substation Controller GPS SINAUT 8-FW
■ Connection to higher-level system con-
trol centers SICAM plusTOOLS
Configuration
■ Connection to bay level SICAM SC
2 ■ Bay control units, protection relays or Substation
combined control and protection bay Controller
units.
■ Configuration PC with SICAM plusTOOLS
■ Operation and monitoring with SICAM
3 WinCC SIMATIC NET IEC 60870-5-103
The modular construction of the system PROFIBUS FMS
permits a wide range of combination op- wire
RS485 O.F. O.F.
tions within the scope of the system limits.
In the SICAM SC substation controller, the
4 SICAM I/O modules can be used for alter-
native central connection of process inputs
and outputs (see description of the SICAM
RTU).
SICAM WinCC
Operator control, SIPROTEC 4 protection 6MB525 bay SIPROTEC 3
5 monitoring, and control devices control units protection relays
and archiving and 7**6
relays
Fig. 193: Typical configuration of a SICAM SAS
10
6/108 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Local and Remote Control
SICAM SAS – SC Substation Controller
10
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 6/109
Local and Remote Control
SICAM SAS – SC Substation Controller
6/110 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Local and Remote Control
SICAM SAS – SC Substation Controller
Telecontrol interfaces
Via the serial interfaces of the MCP com-
munication processor and the XC2 expan-
Substation bus Telecommunication 1
sion modules, one can connect the SICAM
– Industrial Ethernet – IEC 60 870-5-103
SC to a maximum of three higher-level sys- SINAUT 8FW
tem control centers. – PPROFIBUS FMS
Connection to SICAM Module MCP (XC2, XF6)
The telecontrol interfaces are operated WinCC
with the IEC 60870-5-101 or SINAUT 8FW Module CP443-1 2
transmission protocols and are parameter- or -5
izable as RS232, RS422/RS485 or optical
fiber interfaces.
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 6/111
Local and Remote Control
SICAM SAS – Bay Control Units
7SJ636 7 + 8 2) – 16 1 4 x I, 3 x U 2
6/112 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Local and Remote Control
SICAM SAS – Bay Control Units
SIPROTEC 4
(see description of Power System
Protection) 1
The 7SJ63 and the 6MD63 are designed
for larger volumes of information and thus
are also suitable for use in duplicate-busbar
substations. System control center or telecontrol node
SIPROTEC 4 units are preferably connect-
IEC 80 870-5-101
2
ed to the SICAM SAS via PROFIBUS FMS. GPS SINAUT 8-FW
Connection via IEC 60870-5-103 with re-
duced functionality (compared to the use SIMATIC plusTOOLS
of PROFIBUS FM) is also possible. Configuration
SICAM SC
The SIPROTEC 4 7SJ61 and 7SJ62 relays Substation 3
can also be used via Profibus FMS and Controller
IEC 60870-5-103 in SICAM SAS. These
two units support control of the feeder cir-
cuit-breaker.
10
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 6/113
Local and Remote Control
SICAM SAS – Human-Machine Interface
6/114 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Local and Remote Control
SICAM SAS – Human-Machine Interface
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 6/115
Local and Remote Control
SICAM SAS – Engineering Tools
SICAM Valpro
Curve and tabular display of archived
1 measured values and metered values is
carried out by means of the SICAM Valpro
program. Valpro provides the facility for us-
ing archived values for various evaluation
purposes, without altering them in the ar-
2 chive. The user decides at the time of eval-
uation (in a dialog) which values should be
displayed in which raster. In addition to the
variables to be displayed, he specifies the
time range, the color and if necessary the
mathematical function to be carried out.
3 One can have totals, averages, maximums,
minimums or the power factor formed and
displayed. The calculation interval can be
individually specified. Stored presets can
be altered at any time.
4
Engineering System SICAM plus TOOLS
With SICAM plusTOOLS, a versatile and Fig. 200: Example of curve evaluation using Valpro
powerful system solution is available,
which supports the user efficiently in con-
5 figuring and parameterizing the SICAM
SAS (SICAM Substation Automation Sys-
tem). SICAM plusTOOLS is based on
Windows 95 and Windows NT. Thus the
user moves within a familiar system envi-
ronment and can recur to the well-known,
6 convenient functionality of the Windows
technique.
SICAM plusTOOLS allows a flexible proce-
dure when configuring and parameterizing
a station, while providing consequent user
7 guidance at the same time.
Plausibility checks allow only operations
and combinations which are permissible in
the respective context.
■ Permissible input variables are displayed
8 in drop-down lists or scroll boxes.
■ The Drag & Drop function makes it easy
to group, separate or move data.
■ Context-sensitive help texts explain the
text boxes and the permissible input var-
iables.
9 ■ Copy functions on different levels opti- Fig. 201: Hardware Configuration of a demo station
mize the configuration procedure.
■ Help texts which are organized accord- SIMATIC Manager Hardware Configuration
ing to topics explain the configuration.
The SIMATIC Manager is the platform of The Hardware (HW) Configuration applica-
SICAM plusTOOLS. With the help of the tion serves for configuring the modules
10 The SICAM plusTOOLS Software SIMATIC Manager, the user defines and and their parameters. The configuration is
Package manages the project and calls the individ- represented as a table on the screen. The
The SICAM plusTOOLS configuration sys- ual applications. user chooses the components from a
tem is divided into individual, function-spe- The project structure is created automati- Hardware Catalog and places them into
cific applications. cally in the course of the configuration pro- the hardware configuration window using
cedure. The data areas are organized in Drag & Drop or double-clicks. The tabs for
separate containers. parameterizing the modules are already
In the navigation window of the SIMATIC filled with the default values, which can be
Manager, the project structure is repre- modified by the user.
sented similar to a Windows 95 directory
tree. Each container corresponds to a
folder on the respective hierarchical level.
6/116 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Local and Remote Control
SICAM SAS – Engineering Tools
COM IED
The COM IED application (Communication
to Intelligent Electronic Devices) serves for
1
configuring the connection of bay devices
in control and monitoring direction.
The bay devices are imported into COM
IED with their maximum information vol-
ume from an IED Catalog using Drag & 2
Drop. The information volume can be re-
duced later. If SIPROTEC 4 bay units with
Profibus FMS communication are used,
then the information parameterized with
DIGSI 4 will be taken over automatically.
3
COM TC
The COM TC application manages all pa-
rameters which are related to the informa-
tion exchange with higher-level control
centers. The telegrams are configured sep- 4
arately for control and monitoring direction.
For the transmission of the telegrams in
monitoring direction, these are assigned to Fig. 202: MCP Parameterizing
priority-specific and type-specific lists. The
list types are provided in a Telecontrol List
Catalog and are copied into COM TC using 5
Drag & Drop.
CFC
In the SICAM SAS System, automation
functions, such as: 6
■ Bay-related and cross-bay interlocks
■ Switching sequences (busbar changes,
etc.)
■ Status indication and command deriva-
tives (group indications, load shedding, 7
etc.)
■ Measured value and metered value
processing (limit value processing, com-
parative functions, etc.)
are projected graphically with the CFC 8
(Continuous Function Chart).
The scope of supply of SICAM plusTOOLS
includes a comprehensive library of SICAM Fig. 203: COM IED and bay units catalog
SAS components. The designer makes his
selection from this library, positions the se- 9
lected component by Drag and Drop on his
worksheet and interconnects the compo-
nents required for its function to one an-
other and to the process signals.
10
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 6/117
Local and Remote Control
SICAM PCC – System Design
Introduction
1 ICCP (ISO/IEC 870-6 TASE.2)
Changing requirements Link To Control Center SICAM PCC
The ongoing deregulation of the power (Optional)
supply industry has been creating a com-
petitive environment with new challenges
2 for the utilities:
■ The liberalized production, transmission Router
and distribution of electrical power call
for more flexible operation of the power Substation LAN
system resulting in more complex con-
trol, metering and accounting procedures.
3 ■ The deregulated system structure re-
quires the extension of load and quality
of supply monitoring, as well as event
and disturbance recording, to control the
business processes and to care for liabil-
4 ity cases. LAN-Enabled IEDs (Legacy) IEDs
■ Operation data that has traditionally
been used only within a given utility
must now be shared by a number of Fig. 205: Sample Substation with SICAM PCC
players in various locations, such as utili-
ties, independent power producers, sys-
5 tem operators and metering or billing
companies. More effective data acquisi- Legacy Protocol ICCP
tion, archiving and communication is (e.g., DNP, IEC 870-5) (ISO/IEC 870-6
therefore needed. Link To Control Center TASE.2)
■ Competition requires that costs have to
Link To Control
Center(Optional)
6 be reduced wherever possible. The opti-
mization of processes has consequently
been given high priority. System automa-
tion and in particular distribution automa- (Legacy)
tion including automatic meter reading IEDs
and customer load control can therefore SICAM Router
7 be observed as the future trend. Substation SICAM
The SICAM PCC meets these require- Controller PCC
ments by integrating modern PC-technolo-
gy and open communication.
Substation Substation
8 LAN “A” LAN “B”
9 (LAN-Enabled IEDs)
6/118 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Local and Remote Control
SICAM PCC – System Design
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 6/119
Local and Remote Control
SICAM PCC – System Design
6/120 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Local and Remote Control
SICAM PCC – System Design
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 6/121
Local and Remote Control
SICAM PCC – User Interface
User Interface User Interface for Configuration The navigation window has four elements:
The PCC user interface is started just like ■ A Systems folder: By opening this fold-
any other Windows 95 or Windows NT 4.0 er, one sees an icon for each computer
8 The user interface used to configure and
program: in the PCC configuration.
operate the PCC is very much influenced
1. Click on the Start button of the taskbar. ■ An Interfaces folder: By opening this
by de facto industry standards. Specifically,
folder, one sees the interfaces which are
the user interface has a ”look and feel” 2. Select Programs from the menu which
configured on the PCC.
established by Microsoft’s Windows 95. appears.
The great popularity of Windows 95 made ■ A Normalization folder: By opening this
3. Select the SICAM PCC folder from the
9 this an easy decision. The choice of a Win- menu which then appears.
folder, one is able to create custom nor-
dows 95 ”look and feel” means that the malize procedures.
4. Double-click on SICAM PCC.
user interface is familiar to anyone who has ■ A Tools icon: By opening this, one sees
Now a window appears like shown in a number of tools which may be used in
used Windows 95 software. The PCC de-
Fig. 209. configuration mode.
velopment team has worked with Siemens
human factors engineers to make the user It looks like the Windows Explorer of
10 interface as intuitive as possible. Windows 95 and Windows NT 4.0. On
Fig. 210 illustrates the PCC main window
(configuration mode) with several folders
the left is a navigation window. At the top open. In this case, the system is a distrib-
The PCC’s user interface is divided into
is a menu bar and a tool bar. The naviga- uted configuration with two computers.
two parts:
tion window can be undocked and then
■ User Interface for Configuration, also resized or moved around on your screen.
called the PCC Configuration Manager.
■ User Interface for Operation, also called
the PCC Operations Manager.
6/122 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Local and Remote Control
SICAM PCC – User Interface
If a mistake is made…
3
The user can change interface and device
parameters by double-clicking on the ap-
propriate folders and / or icons. For exam-
ple, by a double-click on the icon for a de-
vice, windows appear which are almost
identical to those used to initially configure 4
the device. By working with these win-
dows, one can make any necessary chang-
es to the PCC configuration.
Fig. 211: Working with an Existing Device
User Interface for Operation 5
The user interface for operation is very
much like what has already been shown.
One can switch between two modes by
clicking on toolbar buttons:
6
selects configuration mode.
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 6/123
Local and Remote Control
SICAM PCC – Application Example
6/124 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Local and Remote Control
Device Dimensions
6MB5515 1
Front view Side view Rear view
482.6 251
30
37.4
84 E = 426.72 182
2
7
57.15
6 U = 266.7
57.15 133.35
FP/LPII
…
AR
DE
DE
BA
BA
RK
RK
SC
AE
SV
BF
11
465.1
4
All dimensions in mm.
5
6MB5540
84 TE = 426.72 182
7
3 U m = 266.87
7
57.15
57.15 133.35
… … Subrack
FPI
AR
BA
BA
RK
AE
SV
8
11
9
471.2
10
Connection
board
90
45
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 6/125
Local and Remote Control
Device Dimensions
1 6MB5130
3 ø 5 or M4
266 244 245 255.8
4 ø6
277.5 221
5
All dimensions in mm.
6
6MB5140
8
ø5
266 245 255.8
9 ø6
277.5 446
10
6/126 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Local and Remote Control
Device Dimensions
4 2
ø 5 or M4
244 266 245 255.8
ø6 3
231.5
All dimensions in mm. 277 225 221
Fig. 218: Compact input/output device 6MB522 4
ø6
ø5
6
244 245 255.8
7
All dimensions in mm. 160 5.4
231.5 146
Fig. 219: Compact input/output device 6MB523
8
6MB524-0, 1, 2 Side view Rear view Panel cutout
29.5 30 225
172 9 7.3 206.5±0.3
220 13.2 180±0.5 5.4 9
8
7
6 ø 5 or M4
5
266 FE D C BA
245+1 255.8±0.3 10
244
4
3
2 ø6
1
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 6/127
Local and Remote Control
Device Dimensions
6MB5240-3, -4
1
8
7
6
3 5
266 244 245+1 255.8±0.3
ML K J H G F E D C BA
4
3 ø5 ø6
2
1
4
Terminal Terminal Optical-fiber 446+2
block block sockets
All dimensions in mm.
5 Fig. 221: Compact I/0 unit with local (bay) control, extended version 6MB5240-3
6MB525
6
Side view Rear view Panel cutout
Terminal
block ø6
9
All dimensions in mm.
6/128 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Local and Remote Control
Device Dimensions
ø 5 or M4/
0.2 diameter 3
266/10.47 244/9.61 245/ 255.8/
9.64 10.07
FO
2
0.07 SUB-D
Connector ø 6/0.24 diameter
4
RS232- 180/7.08
Mounting plate
port 206.5/8.12
Fig. 223: 6MD63 in 1/2 flush-mounting case for surface mounting with detachable operator panel 5
8
266/ 246.2/ 266/ 312/12.28 244/9.61
10.47 9.69 10.47 FO
2
0.07
9
Connection cable
RS232- 68 poles to basic SUB-D
port unit length 2.5 m/ Connector
Mounting plate
8 ft., 2.4 in
Detached 1M case 1/2 case1) 10
operator panel
1) applicable to 6MD631/632/633/634/637
1) applicable to 6MD635/636
Fig. 224: 6MD63 in 1/2 and 1/1 surface mounting case (only with detached operator panel, see Fig. 42, page 6/21)
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 6/129
Local and Remote Control
Device Dimensions
1 6MB552
3
Bus cover
ø 5 or M4
266 244 BNC socket for 1) 2) 255.8 ±0.3
antenna 245+1
4
ø6
Optical-fiber socket
FSMA for connection
of bay units
5 225 221+2
6MB5530-0 and -1
7
9 20 8.2
10
400
10 25 Section A-A
45
15 A
225
Cable bushing
6/130 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Power Quality
Measuring, Recording, Compensation
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 6/131
Power Quality
Measuring and Recording
Front view
75
10
90
105
All dimensions in mm
6/132 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Power Quality
Measuring and Recording
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 6/133
Power Quality
Measuring and Recording
6/134 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Power Quality
Measuring and Recording
Features
■ Online measurements in the system
4
with high accuracy
■ The meters for the 3 analog outputs
with the appropiate measuring range ap-
pear automatically when the program
part is called up 5
■ Easy addition or modification of meters
with measured quantity and measuring
range
■ Selection of measured quantities inde-
pendently of the analog outputs 6
■ Storage of the layout under a file name
■ Printing of the instantaneous values of
the displayed measured quantities
■ Recording and storage of measured val-
ues for the EVAL evaluation software
7
SIMEAS EVAL evaluation software
Fig. 236: SIMEAS EVAL, overview recorded values
Description
With a PC or a notebook with the SIMEAS T 8
PAR software installed on it, up to 25 meas-
ured quantities can be displayed and re-
corded online with the SIMEAS T digital
transducer. A maximum of one week can
be recorded. Every second, one complete
set of measured values is recorded with 9
time information. The complete recording
can then be saved under a chosen name.
Using the SIMEAS EVAL evaluation soft-
ware, the stored values can then be edit-
ed, evaluated and printed in the form of 10
a graphic or a table (Figs. 236 to 238).
Fig. 237: After setting cursors in the overview, the affiliated measurements and times are displayed in the table
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 6/135
Power Quality
Measuring and Recording
Features
■ Automatic diagram marking
3 ■ Graphic or tabular representation
■ Sampling frequency: 1 s
■ A measured value from the table can
be dragged to the graphic by simply
right-clicking it
4 ■ Add your own text to graphics
■ Select measured quantities and the
measuring range Fig. 238: When a cursor is moved by the mouse,
the measured values and times in the table are adapted automatically
■ Easy zooming with automatic adaption
of the diagram captions on the X and Y
5 axes
— — —
■ Up to 8 cursors can be set or moved 1000√ 3, 110√ 3, 200√ 3. The devices can
anywhere be pre-configured at the factory according
■ Tabular online display of the chosen to customer requirements or configuration
cursor positions with values and times can be performed by the customer himself.
■ Characteristics can be placed over one The latter possibility facilitates and consid-
6 another for improved analysis erably reduces the customer’s expense for
storage and spare parts service. All usual
■ The sequence of displayed measured
variants of connection (two, three or four-
quantities can be selected and modified
wire systems, constant/balanced or any/
■ The complete recording or edited unbalanced load 16 2/3, 50, 60 Hz) can be
graphic can be printed, including a possi- configured according to individual require-
7 bility of selecting the number of curves ments.
on each sheet
Please note that two different types are
■ The table can be printed with measured
available which differ in their types of inter-
values and times pertaining to the cursor
face: V.28 (RS 232C) and RS 458. The stand-
positions.
ard interface (V.28) is used for configuration.
8 It enables loading of the measured values
Information for SIMEAS T Project to a personal computer, whereby only one
Planning transducer can be connected to a com-
The transducer is suitable for low-voltage puter. Both versions are operated with
applications, 400 V three-phase and 230 V the SIMEAS PAR software. The RS 485
enables connection to a bus, i.e. up to
9 single-phase voltages, (max. measuring
31 transducers can be connected to a cen-
600 L-L) and currents of 1, 5, 10 A (max.
measurement 12 Ar.m.s), either directly or tral device (e.g. PC) simultaneously. Data
via current transformers, as well as for transmission is based on IEC 60 870-5-103
connection to voltage transformers of protocol.
The type of power supply is to be speci-
10 fied when ordering, either 24..60 V DC or
100..230 V AC/DC. Please note that analog
output 1 and the serial interface use the
same potential and can be operated simul-
taneously only under certain conditions.
6/136 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Power Quality
Measuring and Recording
Application
All systems used for the generation and 3
distribution of electrical power. The device
can be easily installed for stationary use.
96 (3.78")
Functions
Measuring instrument for all relevant
Side view measurands of a feeder. Combination of 4
several measuring instruments in one unit.
Special features
Dimensions for panel mounting according
to DIN (front frame 96 x 96 mm). Integrated 5
PROFIBUS as optional equipment. Data
86 (3.39") output is effected via the Profibus.
Measuring inputs
■ 3 voltage inputs up to 347 V (L-E), 600 V
(L-L),
6
■ 3 current inputs for 5 A rated current,
measuring range up to 10 A with an
162.2 (6.39") overload of 25%.
Communication 7
Fig. 239: Power Meter SIMEAS P, views and dimensions ■ LCD display with background illumina-
tion,
■ Simultaneous display of four measuring
values,
■ Parameter assignment by using the keys 8
on the front panel,
■ 1 serial interface type RS 485 for con-
nection to the Profibus (option).
10
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 6/137
Power Quality
Measuring and Recording
Auxiliary power
Two versions: 24 to 60 V DC and 85 to SIMEAS P
1 240 V AC/DC.
6/138 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Power Quality
Measuring and Recording
Application
Fig. 241: The SIMEAS Q quality recorder
Medium and low-voltage systems. 90 3
The device requires only little space and
can be easily installed for stationary use. Communication Side view
Functions ■ 2 optorelays as signaling output, availa- Terminal block
ble either for
Instrument for network quality measure-
ment. All relevant measurands and operands
– device in operation, 4
– energy pulse,
are continuously recorded at freely defina-
– signaling the direction of energy flow
ble intervals or, if a limit value is violated,
(import, export),
the values are averaged. This enables the
– value below min. limit for cos ϕ,
registration of all characteristics of voltage
– pulse indicating a voltage dip,
quality according to the relevant standards.
■ 3 LEDs indicating the operating status 5
The measured values can be automatically
transferred to a central computer system and PROFIBUS activity,
at freely definable intervals via a standard- ■ 1 RS 485 serial interface for connection
ized PROFIBUS DP interface and at a to the PROFIBUS.
transmission rate of up to 1.5 Mbit/s. Auxiliary power 90
105 6
Special features Two versions: 24 to 60 V DC and 110 to
■ Cost-effective solution. 250 V DC, as well as 100 to 230 V AC.
Connection terminals
■ Comprehensive measuring functions Measured and calculated quantities
which can also be used in the field of 20 21 22 23 24 25
■ R.m.s. values of the line-to-ground or
automatic control engineering.
line-to-line voltages,
7
■ Minimum dimensions. PROFIBUS-DP Aux. Volt.
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 6/139
Power Quality
Measuring and Recording
Operating modes
■ Continuous measurement with definable Single phase – alternating current
1 averaging intervals,
■ Event-controlled measurement with Connection terminals SIMEAS Q
definable averaging intervals. 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
Storage capacity
k l
2 Up to 20,000 measured and calculated val-
ues. Parameters for the measuring points L1
can be freely defined. The PROFIBUS DP K L
N
enables quick loading of the measured val-
ues, so that the apparently small storage
capacity is absolutely sufficient. Assuming
3 a usual parameter setting with regard to 4-wire – 3-phase with any load (low voltage network)
the measuring points and averaging inter-
vals for quality monitoring, the storage
Connection terminals SIMEAS Q
capacity will last for seven days in case
of a PROFIBUS failure. 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
4 Basic Functions
k l k l k l
In the course of continuous measurement,
the selected measuring data are stored in L1
K L
the memory or transferred directly via the L2
PROFIBUS. The averaging interval can be K L
L3
5 selected separately for the different meas- N
K L
urands.
In the event-controlled mode of operation,
the data will be stored only if a limit value
has been violated within an averaging inter- 3-wires – 3-phase with any load
6 val.
Apart from the mean values, the maximum Connection terminals SIMEAS Q
and minimum values within an averaging 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
interval can be stored, with the exception
of flicker irritability factors and the values
from energy measurement. k l k l u v u v
7
Parameter assignment and adjustment of
the device are performed via the Profibus U V U V
interface. L1
K L
L2
L3
8 Information for SIMEAS Q Project K L
Planning
Up to 400 V (L-L), the device is connected
directly, or, if higher voltages are applied, 4-wire – 3-phase with any load (high voltage network)
via a external transformer. The rated cur-
9 rent values are 1 and 5 A (max. 6 A can
Connection terminals SIMEAS Q
be measured) without switchover. Commu-
nication with the device is effected via 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
PROFIBUS DP or, as an option, via modem
(telephone network). u u u
k l k l k l
Auxiliary voltage is available in two vari-
10 ants: 24 to 60 V DC and 110 to 250 V DC
or 100 to 230 V AC. X X X
U U U
L1
K L
L2
K L
L3
K L
N
6/140 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Power Quality
Measuring and Recording
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 6/141
Power Quality
Measuring and Recording
Recording Equipment
1
The SIMEAS R Fault and Digital Recorder
Application
■ Stand-alone stationary recorder for extra-
high, high and medium-voltage systems.
2
■ Component of secondary equipment of
power stations and substations or indus-
trial plants.
Functions
3 Fault recorder, digital recorder, frequency/
power fault recorder, power quality record- Fig. 245: SIMEAS R Systems
er, event recorder. are used in power plants …
All functions can be performed simultane-
ously and are combined in one unit with no
4 need for additional devices to carry out the
different tasks.
Special features
Fig. 247: Fault record
■ The modular design enables the realiza-
tion of different variants starting from
5 systems with 8 analog and 16 binary in-
puts up to the acquisition of data from Fault detection is effected with the help of
any number of analog and binary chan- trigger functions. With analog quantities
nels. this refers to
■ Clock with time synchronization using
■ exceeding the limit values for voltage,
6 GPS or DCF77.
current and unbalanced load (positive
■ Data output via postscript printer, re- and negative phase sequence system).
mote data transmission with a modem
■ falling below the limit values for voltage,
via the telephone line, connection to Fig. 246: … and to monitor transmission lines current and unbalanced load (positive
LAN and WAN.
and negative phase sequence system).
7 ■ limit values for sudden changes in up or
Fault Recording (DFR) downward direction.
This function is used for the continuous Monitoring of the binary signals includes
monitoring of the AC voltages and cur- ■ signal status (high, low)
rents, binary signals and direct voltages or ■ status changes
8 currents with a high time resolution. If a
fault event, e.g. a short-circuit, occurs, the
specific fault will be registered including
its history. The recorded data are then ar-
chived and can either be printed directly in
the form of graphics or be transferred to a
9 diagnosis system which can, for example,
be used to identify the fault location.
10
6/142 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Power Quality
Measuring and Recording
Logical triggers In single-phase and three-phase systems, Sequence of Event (SOE) Recording
the following measurands are recorded:
Logical triggers can be defined by combin- Each status change occurring at the binary
ing any types of trigger event (analog or ■ R.m.s. values of voltages and currents inputs is registered with a resolution of 1
binary). They are used to avoid undesired ■ Active power, phase-segregated and 0.5 ms and is then provided with a time
recording by increasing the selectivity of overall stamp indicating the time information from
the trigger function. The device can distin- ■ Reactive power, phase-segregated and the year down to the millisecond.
guish between different causes of a fault, overall (displacement or total reactive 200 status changes per second can be
e.g. between a voltage dip caused by a power) stored for each group of 32 inputs. The 2
short-circuit (low voltage, high current) ■ Power factor, phase-segregated and mass memory of the device can be config-
which needs to be recorded, and the dis- overall ured according to requirements (a 5 MB
connection of a feeder (voltage low, cur- memory, for example, enables the storage
■ Frequency
rent low) which does not need to be re- of approx. 120,000 status changes). Mod-
corded. ■ Positive and negative sequence voltage
ules for signal voltages between 24 and
and current
250 V are available. 3
Sequential control ■ Weighted and unweighted total harmon-
ic distortion (THD) The time-synchronous output enables
An intelligent logic operation is used to the combined representation with analog
make sure that each record refers to the ■ 5 th to 50 th harmonics (depending on
the averaging time) curves, e.g. of alarm and command signals
actual duration of the fault event. This is to together with the course of relay voltages
■ DC signals, e.g. from transducers
prevent continuous violation of a limit value and currents. With the help of the OSCOP P 4
(e.g. undervoltage) from causing perma- Depending on the individual network con- program, the event signals can however
nent recording and blocking of the device. figuration, a three or four-wire connection also be displayed in the form of a text list
is used. in chronological order. The use of a sepa-
Analog measurands
rate sequence of event recorder will no
16-bit resolution for voltages and DC quan- longer be required.
tities and 2 x 16-bit resolution for AC volt-
Frequency/Power Recording (FPR) 5
ages. This function uses the same principle as a
The sampling frequency is 256 times the fault recorder. It continuously monitors the
period length, i.e. 12.8 kHz at 50 Hz and gradient of the frequency and/or power of
15.36 kHz at 60 Hz for each channel. one or more three-phase feeders. If major
A new current transformer concept ena- deviations are detected, e.g. caused by the 6
bles a measuring range between 0.5 mA outage of a power plant or when great loads
and 400 A r.m.s. with tolerances of <0.2% are applied, the profile of the measurands
at <7 Ar.m.s. and <1% at >7 Ar.m.s. Further- will be recorded including their history. The
more, direct current is registered in the recorder is also used for the registration of
range above 7 A; this enables a true image power swings.
of the transient DC component in the 7
Measurands
short-circuit current.
■ Frequency of one of the voltages,
Binary signals (limit of error ± 1 mHz)
The sampling frequency at the binary in- ■ Active power, reactive power
puts is 2 kHz. (reactive displacement power), 8
(limit of error ≤ 0.2%)
Data compression ■ Power factor
For best utilization of the memory space Averaging interval Fig. 248: SIMEAS R for 8 analog and 16 binary inputs,
and for high-speed remote transmission 1
/2 19'' design
the data can be compressed to as little as A value between 1 and 250 periods of the
2% of their original size. network frequency can be selected. 9
Fault diagnosis History
Performed with the OSCOP P software Depends on the averaging interval;
package. 10 s times the averaging periods.
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 6/143
Power Quality
Measuring and Recording
The OSCOP P Evaluation Program The individual diagrams can, of course, be Information for Project Planning
adjusted to individual requirements with with SIMEAS R
The OSCOP P software package is suitable
1 for use in personal computers provided with
the help of variable scaling and zoom func-
The secondary components of high or
tions. Records from different devices can
the operating systems MS WINDOWS 95/98 medium-voltage systems can either be
be combined in one diagram. The different
or WINDOWS NT. It is used for remote accommodated in a central relay room or
quantities measured can be immediately
transmission, evaluation and archiving (da- in the feeder dedicated low-voltage com-
calculated by marking a specific point in a
tabase system) of the data received from partments of switchgear panels. For this
diagram with the cursor (impedance, reac-
2 a SIMEAS R or OSCILLOSTORE and from
tance, active and reactive power, harmon-
reason, the SIMEAS R system has been
digital protection devices. The program designed in such a way as to allow both
ics, peak value, r.m.s. value, symmetry, etc.).
includes a parameterization function for centralized or decentralized installation.
remote configuration of SIMEAS R and Additional diagnosis modules can be used
The acquisition unit can be delivered in
OSCILLOSTORE units. to perform an automatic analysis of fault
two different widths, either 1/2 19" or 19"
events and to identify the fault location.
The program enables fully-automated data (full width). The first version is favorable
3 transmission of all recorded events from
The program also supports server/client
if measurands of only one feeder are to be
structures.
the acquisition units to one or more evalua- considered (8 analog and 16 binary signals).
tion stations via dedicated line, switched This often applies to high-voltage plants
line or a network; the received data can where each feeder is provided with an ex-
then be immediately displayed on a moni- tra relay kiosk for the secondary equipment.
4 tor and/or printed (Fig. 249). In all other cases, the full-width version of
The OSCOP P program is provided with 19" is more economical, since it enables the
a very convenient graphical evaluation pro- processing of up to 32 analog and 64 bina-
gram for the creation of a time diagram ry signals. The modular structure with a
with the curve profiles, diagrams of the variety of interface modules (DAUs) provides
r.m.s. values or vector diagrams (Fig. 252). a maximum of flexibility. The number of
5 DAUs which can be integrated in the ac-
quisition system is unlimited.
10
Stations
LAN
Fig. 249: Example of a distributed recording system realized with SIMEAS R recorders and data central unit DAKON
6/144 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Power Quality
Measuring and Recording
9
Fig. 250: Rear view of a SIMEAS R unit with terminals
for the signals and interfaces for data transmission
10
Fig. 252: OSCOP P Program, evaluation of a fault record
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 6/145
Compensation – Introduction Power Quality
10
6/146 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Power Quality
Passive Compensation – Power Factor Correction
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 6/147
Power Quality
Passive Compensation – Power Factor Control
6/148 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Power Quality
Passive Compensation – Power Factor Control
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 6/149
Power Quality
Passive Compensation – Harmonics Filter
ν = 6 · k ± 1, k = 1, 2, 3, …
2
Fig. 266
Iν =
1
· I1
4 ν
M
Fig. 267
Fig. 264: Three-phase bridge circuit Actually, the values are often slightly high-
5 er, since the DC current is not completely
smoothed. Harmonics of the fifth, seventh,
eleventh and thirteenth order may show
amplitudes which need to be reduced;
harmonics of a higher order can usually
be neglected.
6 Primary distribution network The effect of harmonic currents on the
system can be reduced considerably by the
use of filters. This is effected by generat-
Transformer ing a series resonant circuit from a capaci-
tor and an inductor which is then adjusted
7 Drive Low-voltage exactly to the corresponding frequency for
each harmonic to be absorbed. The two
impedances cancel each other out, so that
Filter
the remaining ohmic resistance is reduced
to a negligible amount, compared to the
network impedance. The harmonic currents
8 ν =5 ν =7 ν =11… are absorbed to a large extent; the rest
remains present in the supply network.
This results in a lower voltage distortion
and a considerable increase in voltage
M quality.
9 Reactive power
Referring to the fundamental component,
the filters form a capacitive load. This sup-
Active power ports the general reactive power compen-
sation. This measure enables the corre-
sponding equipment to be designed for
lower capacities (Fig. 265).
10
Fig. 265: Correction of the power factor with the help of filters
6/150 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Power Quality
Passive Compensation – Selection Guide
For technical data of SIPCON T Passive Filters and Com- Fig. 271: 4RF1 power factor correction unit
pensation Systems see Power Quality Catalog SR 10.6 250 kvar (5 x 50 kvar) in a cabinet 2275 x 625 mm
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 6/151
Power Quality
Passive Compensation – Selection Guide
Flowcharts
The flowcharts can be used as a reference
1 when selecting the suitable compensation Percentage of
equipment with regard to the individual non-linear load in
preconditions of the specific network. the network
< 20% of Sr*)
2
No Must resonances
with the higher-
level network be
avoided?
3
Yes
Ripple control in No No Ripple control in
the network? the network?
4
Yes Yes
Audio frequency No Audio frequency No
> 250 Hz > 250 Hz? 1
5
Go to
Yes flowchart 2
Yes
U5 < 3% No
U7 < 2% 2
6 present in the
network?
Yes
Capacitors and Special audio Capacitor type Equipment for
7 compensation frequency hold- 4RB, stationary power factor
units without off on request or compensation correction,
4RY. Audio fre- compensation equipm. type type 4RF17,
quency hold-off unit with reactor 4RD. Equipment reactors (7%).
on the supply (7%). for power factor Filtering of 5th
side. correction with- harmonic up
8 out reactors, approx. 30%
type 4RY.
9 Fig. 272: Flowchart 1: Power factor correction for low, non-linear load
10
6/152 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Power Quality
Passive Compensation – Selection Guide
Percentage of
No non-linear load Yes 1
in the network
≥ 20% of Sr *)
Improving the
power factor 2
Avoiding resonances
with higher level network
3
Partial filtering of self- Filtering a large amount
generated harmonics of self-generated
harmonics.
4
No Ripple control Ripple control present
present in the network? in the netwok?
Yes
No Yes No 5
Audio frequency
> 350 Hz?
Yes
No
1 Audio frequency
< 250 Hz? 6
2 Yes
Fig. 273: Flowchart 2: Power factor correction for large non-linear load 9
10
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 6/153
Power Quality
Active Compensation
SIPCON-DVR/SIPCON-DSTATCOM Advantages of Active There are two systems available, the DVR
Compensation Equipment (Dynamic Voltage Restorer) and the DSTAT-
1 Active Filter and Compensation ■ No capacitance, in order to exclude the
COM (Distributed Static Compensator)
Systems which differ in their specific design and ap-
generation of undesired resonances.
plication. DSTATCOM is designed for paral-
■ Reactive power and harmonics are lel and the DVR for serial connection.
A great number of industrial processes treated independently of each other; the
compensation of harmonics has no ef- The DSTATCOM is connected to the net-
based on the supply of electrical energy work between the incoming supply line
2 require a high degree of reliability in power fect on the power factor and vice versa.
and the consumer or a group of consum-
supply, including the constancy of the volt- ■ The audio frequency ripple control levels
ers as shown in Fig. 274. The compensa-
age applied and the waveshape. A short- remain unaffected.
tion unit functions as a current source and
time voltage failure or voltage dip may cau- ■ Stepless control avoids sudden changes sink. Correction includes all network char-
se the destruction of a component presently and enables compensation at any de- acteristics related to the reactive power.
being processed in an NC machine or of a gree of accuracy.
3 whole production lot in the semiconductor,
The DSTATCOM is used to compensate
■ Most rapid reaction to load changes with load reactions on the network.
chemical or steel industry. In the automo- a minimum delay.
tive and semiconductor industries, for ex- Connection of the DVR requires some more
■ No overvoltages caused by switching effort, since the system is to be looped
ample, the cost incurred by these losses operations.
may quickly accumulate to millions of dollars. into the line (Fig. 275) in series connection.
■ The equipment protects itself against In this connection, the DVR can influence
4 In return, some production processes cau-
overload. the line current flow which enables a com-
se unacceptable perturbations in the supply
network resulting from voltage dips (rolling ■ The functions will not be affected by plete compensation of voltage dips as
mills), flickers and asymmetries (steel mills). ageing of the power capacitors. occurring, for example, in the event of
■ The user can re-configure the system at short-circuits in the network. The DVR im-
Correction is possible with the help of proves the voltage quality of the supply
any time; this greatly enhances flexibility,
active compensation systems. These sys-
5 tems are capable of absorbing harmonics
even if the specific tasks have changed. system.
and of compensating voltage dips, reactive
power, imbalance in the three-phase sys-
tem and flicker problems. Their characteris-
tic features go far beyond the capabilities Net- Load
6 of passive systems (e.g. SIPCON T) and work
offer great advantages when compared
with other applications. The function princi-
ple is based on a pulse-width modulated,
IGBT
three-phase bridge-circuit rectifier, as used Converter
for example in variable-speed drives. The
7 switching elements – IGBTs (insulated gate
bipolar transistors) – are controlled by means Intermediate-
of pulses of a certain length and phase an- circuit capacitor
gle. These pulses initiate charging and dis-
charging of a capacitor, used as an energy Fig. 274: DSTATCOM
store, at periodical intervals in order to achie-
8 ve the desired effect of influencing the cur-
rent flow direction. The control function is
performed by means of a microprocessor- Net- Load
based, programmable control unit. work
10
Fig. 275: DVR
6/154 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Power Quality
Active Compensation
Intermediate-circuit capacitor 5
10
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 6/155
Power Quality
Active Compensation
Application of Variant 1
This is the standard design used to fulfill
1 the tasks as described below. All functions
can be performed simultaneously; they are
carried out completely independently and
do not affect each other, as occurs when
using solutions with passive components
2 (capacitors).
DSTATCOM protects itself against overload
by limiting the current. The individual tasks
can be allocated to different priority levels.
In case of overload, the tasks with the low-
est priority will then be skipped and the de-
3 vice will use its full capacity for the other
tasks. The control functions with the high-
est priority level will be the last ones re-
maining active.
In this operating mode the DSTATCOM
4 shows excellent dynamic behavior. Within
only a few network periods, the system
will reach the setpoint value. Operating var-
iant 1 is used for:
■ Absorption of Harmonics
5 A maximum of 4 harmonics up to the
13th order, e.g. 5, 7, 11 and 13, are com-
pensated. The remaining residual current
can be adjusted. This option avoids ex- Fig. 278: Example: SIPCON DSTATCOM LV
cessive system load, since the increas-
ing effect of correction causes a decline
6 in the internal resistance for the corre- Applications of Variant 2
sponding frequency. In return, the load- Variable loads require an even quicker reac- L1
caused current will considerably increase tion than can be realized with variant 1.
and with it the losses, which might re- Three-phase Active
Therefore, variant 2 has been optimized in
sult in a system overload. Therefore, it is system load
such a way as to enable reactive power
reasonable to correct the harmonics only
7 up to the limit specified by the supplier.
compensation and load balancing within
L2
the shortest time. Possible applications of
■ Reactive Power Compensation this variant are:
Reactive power compensation, i.e. cor-
■ Reduction of flickers
rection of the power factor, is possible
for both inductive and capacitive loads. Heavy load surges as occurring, for ex-
L3
8 The continuous control principle avoids ample, in welding machines, presses or
switching peaks and deviations which during the startup of drives, may cause
might occur when switching from one voltage line drops. Fluorescent lamps Fig. 279: Steinmetz compensator
step to the next. react to these voltage drops with varia-
tions in their brightness, called flickers.
■ Correction of Unbalanced Load ■ Correction of unbalanced load conditions
The reactive components of the load
9 Loads in single and two-phase connec- current have usually a greater effect in The DSTATCOM is suitable to fully cor-
tion cause voltage imbalance in the this case. The DSTATCOM can be oper- rect unbalanced loads of the three phas-
three-phase system which may also ated in the flicker mode which provides es. Until now, this was achieved with
have negative effects on other consum- an optimized reaction within the shortest the help of stepwise controlled inductors
ers. Especially three-phase motors may time in order to reduce these voltage and capacitors, but now correction can
then be exposed to overheat. variations to a large extent. The delay be performed continuously and very
10 An active load can be symmetrized by time of the system is only 1/60 of the precisely. The quick reaction of the
means of a Steinmetz compensator. period length and control is completed DSTATCOM in the flicker mode enables
While this compensator can correct only within one network period. control within only one network period.
constant loads, the SIPCOM is capable Consumers in single or two-phase con-
of adjusting its correction dynamically to nection, such as welding devices, will
the load, even if this load is changing no longer affect symmetry.
quickly.
6/156 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Power Quality
Active Compensation
5
ISN = √ I12+ I52+ I72+ I112+ I132
I1 = Reactive component of
the fundamental current 6
component
I5…I13 = Current harmonics
inductive
SIPCON Permanent
DSTATCOM compensation 10
Control range
DSTATCOM
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 6/157
Power Quality
Active Compensation
4 Voltage dips
Net- Voltage overshoots Load
work Harmonics
Imbalance
Fig. 282: Improving the quality in power supply Fig. 283: Block diagram – DVR
6
Function Principle
The DVR is used as a voltage source
which is integrated in the feeder line be-
tween the supply system and the consum-
7 er in series connection. The voltage ap-
plied to the consumer is measured and if it
deviates from the ideal values, the missing
components will be injected, so that the
consumer voltage remains constant. Apart
from the prevention of voltage dips, the
8 DVR is also used to correct overvoltages
and unsymmetries. The highly dynamic
system is capable of realizing the full com-
pensation of voltage dips within a period of
2 to 3 milliseconds.
9
10
6/158 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Power Quality
Active Compensation
The signals from audio frequency ripple Information for Project Planning
control systems are not affected. An audio
In contrast to the principle of SIPCON
frequency hold-off is not required.
DSTATCOM, which corrects the reactive
1
Application power only for the parallel-connected load,
the whole load current flows through the
The DVR is basically used to improve the DVR system. Therefore, all preconditions
quality of the voltage supplied by the pow- and marginal conditions are to be consid-
er supply system. ered to enable correct configuration. Basi- 2
■ Correction of voltage variations cally, the following points should be taken
Remote short-circuits in the supply net- into account:
work occasionally result in voltage dips ■ Fault characteristics:
of different strength and of a duration of What kind of network faults are to be
only few tenths of a second. In weak corrected (single, two or three-phase)
networks it may also occur that the usu- and up to which residual voltage value
3
al voltage limits cannot be held over a and fault duration shall correction be-
long period of time or that sensitive con- come effective.
sumers require smaller tolerances than ■ Load:
offered by the power supply company.
Nominal value of the apparent power,
With the DVR, single, two and three- type of load, e.g. what types of drive, 4
phase voltage dips up to a certain inten- resistance load, etc. are to be supplied
sity can be compensated independently with the help of the DVR.
of their duration. Additional power is tak-
■ Corrective behavior:
en from the rectifier part from the net-
work, even if the voltage is too low; this What degree of accuracy is to be ob-
power is then supplied to the series served for the voltage on the load side. 5
transformer on the load side via the con- It will often be sufficient if the DVR sup-
verter. The value of the nominal power plies only part of the nominal load. To en-
of the DVR is reciprocal to the voltages sure correct project planning, a Siemens
to be corrected. Statistics show that expert should be consulted.
most of the short-time voltage dips have
a residual voltage of at least 70 to 80%.
6
The power to be generated by the DVR
must be sufficient to compensate the
missing part.
■ Compensation of unbalanced load Further information:
The DVR can be used to inject a positive www.powerquality.de 7
phase-sequence voltage which enables
the compensation of imbalance in the
supply voltage in order to avoid exces-
sive temperatures of three-phase ma-
chines.
■ Absorption of harmonics
8
The quick-action control of the DVR ena-
bles elimination of harmonics by correct-
ing distortions of the voltage waveshape.
Since the system can be configured for
different tasks, it can also be used to 9
process harmonics of the fifth, seventh,
eleventh and thirteenth order, either sep-
arately or as a whole.
10
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 6/159
1
10
6/160 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Power Systems Control
and
Energy Management
Contents Page
Energy Management Solutions
Introduction ....................................... 7/2
SINAUT Spectrum ........................... 7/2
EMS from Siemens –
a key to success .............................. 7/3
Available Services ........................... 7/3
Integrated IT Solutions
for Utilities ........................................ 7/4
7
Energy Management Solutions
7/2 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Energy Management Solutions
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 7/3
Integrated IT Solutions for Energy Companies
7/4 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Power Network Telecommunication
Introduction As shown in the block diagram below, All systems and network elements de-
we are offering systems and network scribed meet the relevant international
elements for analog transmission as well recommendations and are designed, devel- 1
Safe, reliable and economical energy as systems for digital transmission. oped and manufactured in accordance with
supply is also a matter of fast, efficient The systems and network elements the requirements of the quality systems
and reliable transmission of information shown in this survey of products have of DIN EN ISO 9001.
and data. been specially developed for power in-
International operation, automation and dustry applications and therefore fulfill 2
computer-controlled optimization of net- the requirements with regard to quality
work operations, as well as changing com- and workmanship as well as reliability
munications requirements and the rapid and security.
progress in technology have considerably
increased the demands placed on systems up to 500 km
and components of communications net-
Line trap 3
works.
The same careful planning and organizing
of communications networks are as neces- PLC
CC or CVT
sary in the power industry as for the gener-
ation and distribution of energy itself. 4
AKE
Siemens offers a wide range of systems
and network elements specifically de-
signed to solve communications problems
in this area. Distance protection SWT F6
All systems and network elements are 50 ... 2400 Bd 5
adapted to one another in such a way that FWT
the power industry’s future communica- 64 kbit/s
tions requirements can be satisfied opti-
mally both technically and economically. ESB
Siemens is offering advice, planning,
production, delivery, installation, operation 6
and training – one source for the customer.
Siemens provides expertise and commit-
ment as the complexity of the problem
requires.
Hicom
Put your trust in the extensive know-how
O.F.
7
of our specialists and in the solidity of the
internationally proven Siemens communi-
Dig. current SWT D
cations systems.
comparison and
distance protection
Flexible network configuration 8
with communications systems and Data
network elements 50 Bd ... n x 64 kbit/s
The gradual transition from analog to digital MUX
information networks in the power industry Speech
and other privately operated networks re- 9
quires a great variety of systems and net-
LFH
work elements for widely differing uses.
Prior to a decision as to which system
could be used for the best technical and AKE Coupling unit
economical solution, it is first necessary to PLC Power line carrier communication
clarify such requirements as quantity of CC Coupling capacitor 10
speech, data and teleprotection channels CVT Capacitive voltage transformer
to be transmitted, length of transmission SWT F6 Teleprotection signaling system for analog transmission links
link, existing transmission media, infra- FWT Telecontrol – and data transmission system
structure, reliability, etc. ESB Power line carrier system
Hicom ISDN telephone system
Depending on those clarifications the most SWT 2 D Teleprotection signaling system for digital transmission links
cost-efficient and best technical solution MUX Multiplex system
can be chosen. LFH Fiber optic transmission system
O.F. Optical fiber cable
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 7/5
Power Network Telecommunication
7/6 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Power Network Telecommunication
2
PAX/
PABX 64 kbit/s
MUX
SDH
PDH
3
DEE
Communi-
cation
system
e. g. Hicom
So 64 kbit/s Line trap 4
Coupling
capacitor
DATA PMX
Coupling
PAX/ unit
PABX
SPEECH 5
Remote Service
2/4-wire subscriber telephone
E&M
Protection
relay
Distance protection
7
SWT 2000 F6
8
Data
Data V.28 up to
2400 Bd or via MODEM
9
Modem, ≤ 19,2 kbits/s ESB 2000i
Power
system
Data V.28
10
control
up to 2400 Bd
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 7/7
Power Network Telecommunication
Application
7
The ESB 2000i PLC system permits carrier
transmission of speech, fax, data, tele-
control and teleprotection signals in the
frequency range from 24 kHz to 500 kHz
via:
8 ■ Overhead power lines and
■ Cables
in high- and medium-voltage systems.
The information is transmitted using the
single-sideband (SSB) method with sup-
9 pressed carrier. This method permits:
■ Large ranges due to maximum utiliza-
tion of the transmitter energy for signal Fig. 11: ESB 2000i PLC System with 40 W amplifier
transmission
■ The smallest possible bandwidth and
10 therefore optimum utilization of the
spectrum space of the frequency range
permitted for the transmission
■ Improved privacy due to carrier
suppression
7/8 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Power Network Telecommunication
Fig. 13: Transmission rates of the digital interface of the PLC system according to the available bandwidth
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 7/9
Power Network Telecommunication
Application
5 The SWT 2000 F6 system is for fast and Distance
IF 4 Electrical line
reliable transmission of one or more pro- protection connection
tection commands and / or special switch- CLE
ing functions in power networks.
■ Protection
6 – Protection commands can be trans- Optical line
mitted for the protection of two connection
PU OMA
three-phase systems or one three-
phase system with individual-phase
protection.
– High-voltage circuit-breakers can be IF 4M
7 Annunciations
actuated either in conjunction with
selective protection relays or directly.
PS
■ Special switching functions
– When the system is used for special
switching functions, it is possible to
8 transmit four signals. Each signal is
assigned a priority.
Transmission paths
Depending on the type of supply network, 24 ... 60 V dc
the following transmission paths can be Service PC Alarms 110/220 V dc/ac
9 utilized:
■ High and medium-voltage overhead lines
Fig. 15: Block diagram of the SWT 2000 F6
■ High and medium-voltage cables
■ Aerial and buried cables
■ Radio relay links
10
7/10 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Power Network Telecommunication
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 7/11
Power Network Telecommunication
7
Fig. 17: KS 2000i channel unit
10
7/12 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Power Network Telecommunication
4
OLE 2
SWT
MUX
5
O
D MDF
F
LWL
34 Mbit/s
34
Protection 6
Mbit/s
PABX LSA
Energy Communi-
management cations network
system management center
7
4 x 2 Mbit/s
34 Mbit/s 2 Mbit/s
4 x 2 Mbit/s 8
Office
LAN 9
34 Mbit/s
4 x 2 Mbit/s 4 x 2 Mbit/s 4 x 2 Mbit/s
Fig. 18: The LFH 2000 fiber optic transmission system – Telecommunication requirements in power utilities
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 7/13
Power Network Telecommunication
LFH 2000 fiber optic The incorporation of the SWT 2000 D digit- LFH 2000 is provided with internationally
transmission system al protection data system provides addi- standardized interfaces so that transmis-
1 Flexible network configuration and future
tional functions required for most applica- sion systems of other manufacturers
tions in power companies. which are also equipped with internation-
communications requirements of private
The basic version can be optionally ally standardized interfaces can communi-
network users, such as power companies,
equipped with service telephone units, cate with LFH 2000. This also makes it
call for universal network elements for
optical line terminating units with higher possible to combine LFH 2000 with digital
transmission in digital communications net-
transmission speeds or with other service transmission system of other manufactur-
2 works.
channel modules so that the system can ers.
LFH 2000 has been designed and devel-
be conveniently adapted to the individual The incorporation of LFH 2000 with the
oped on the basis of extensive experience
transmission requirements. expansion element (e.g. flexible multiplex
gained with fiber optic transmission sys-
Further network elements may be con- system) into a network hierarchy with
tems in public networks and transmission
nected to LFH 2000 via internationally differing transmission rates as currently
elements specially developed for such sys-
3 tems. It was tailored to the needs of pow- standardized interfaces if the number of planned and implemented by private net-
required channels and the types of inter- work operator can be easily achieved
er companies and other private network
faces, i.e. the capacity of the system, using the compatible network elements
users.
have to be extended. available today.
In its basic version LFH 2000 consists of
Depending on the number and type of the The call for a user-friendly network man-
a 19-inch subrack equipped with an optical
4 transmission interfaces required, LFH 2000 agement can be fulfilled by adding the
line terminating unit TRCV2 and a service
can be expanded by connecting flexible required hardware and software.
channel module. Even in its simplest con-
figuration, LFH 2000 offers various types multiplex systems. LFH 2000 meets the requirements of the
of interfaces for the transmission of power companies and private network
speech and data channels such as: operators due to its flexibility, availability
of internationally standardized interfaces
5 ■ Line interfaces up to 34 Mbit/s
and compatibility with regard to its incor-
■ So-interface for networking digital poration into existing private networks.
telephone systems (e.g. Hicom)
■ QD 2-interface for network manage-
ment
6
7
DPU Digital processor unit
IF4 Interface module for
distance protection relays
8
OM Optomodule for connection
of digital current comparison
protection system
DPU IF 4 IF 4 PS Service
PS Power supply TRCV 2 or telephone
or or TRCV 8 or ST-A or
9 ST-A Module for service tele- OM OM TRCV 34 ST-B
phone with DTMF signaling
ST-B Module for nondialing O.F.
service telephone
10 AUX Service channel unit
Alarm Distance OFC TRCV 2 or AUX or
AUX 1+1 Service channel unit with and protection (Fiber- TRCV 8 or AUX 1+1 or
protection switching event or optic TRCV 34 AUX BUS
re- digital current cables)
AUXBUS Bus channel unit corder comparison
PABX
Fig. 19: LFH 2000 fiber optic transmission system
7/14 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Power Network Telecommunication
Uses
The SWT 2000 D system is used for fast
and secure transmission of one or several 4
independent binary signals for protection
and special switching functions in power
networks and/or the transmission of serial
protection data.
The system is avaliable in versions for the
transmission of protection data on sepa- 5
rate fibers and on 64 kbit/s PCM channels.
As an optimized solution between these
two possibilities, the system offers trans-
mission of the protection data in the serv- Fig. 20: SWT 2000 D for flush panel mounting with integrated TRCV2 optical line equipment
ice channel of an optical line termination 6
system (e. g. OLTS, OLTE 8) which en-
sures maximum independence of the pro-
tection data from voice and data transmis-
sion despite the common use of fibers in 2 Mbit/s 40/60 V dc
PCM
fiber optic cables.
7
Applications
■ All types of distance protection
TRCV O.F.
(permissive tripping, blocking, etc.)
Digital
■ Direct transfer tripping 1300 nm
longitudinal O.F.
1500 nm
■ Special switching functions differential 820 nm 8
■ Digital current comparison protection protection n x 64 kbit/s OM O.F.
(differential protection) with optical serial (7SD51) X.21/V.11
interface ≤ 19.2 kBd (e. g. with 7SD511). G.703
DPU
Features
■ Up to 8 parallel (binary) commands, Distance IF 4 9
Alter-
bi-directional protection
native
■ Up to 2 serial protection data, route
bi-directional IF 4
■ Simultaneous transmission of serial
PS
protection data and up to 4 binary pro- 10
tection commands
■ High-performance microcontroller
■ Permanent self-supervision
■ Automatic loop testing
■ Event recorder with real-time clock 24 ... 60 V dc
(readable via hand-held terminal or PC). Service PC Alarms 110/220 V dc/ac
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 7/15
Power Network Telecommunication
7/16 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Power Network Telecommunication
2
EMOS QD2 Network
management system 34
34
Mbit/s Mbit/s
EMS Energy 3
management system
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 7/17
1
10
7/18 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Metering
Contents Page
General ............................................... 8/2
Overview ............................................ 8/3
Electricity Meters ............................ 8/4
Gas and Heat Meters ...................... 8/6
Demand Side Management ........... 8/7
Energy Data Acquisition ................. 8/8
Payment Systems .......................... 8/10
Business & Consulting Services 8/11
8
Metering
General
1
The Metering Division provides support for
energy supply utilities, with particular em-
phasis on network and account manage-
ment.
Energy meters are used for measuring the
2 consumption of electricity, gas, heat and
water for purposes of billing. In this regard,
modern energy meters should be able to
handle differing regional tariff structures as
well as complex tariffs in industrial applica-
3 tions.
Siemens makes a decisive contribution
to the increased competitiveness of their
customers, leading to tangible improve-
ments in the control of energy flows, in the
acquisition and processing of meter data,
4 in meter management and in customer
communications. Siemens Metering sup-
plies integrated solutions, from energy
metering to billing. From a single meter
to a complete billing system.
5 We supply tailored solutions for market
sectors as diverse as production, transport,
industry, services, retail and residential.
Examples:
6
Making energy pay
After metering, the data is collected, the bill
is sent, and finally, the receipt of payment
is recorded. Siemens Metering Division im-
7 proves efficiency by optimizing business
processes.
Protecting investment
The compatibility of the products and sys-
tems provides for subsequent functional
8 enhancements. Their functionality can be
adapted to emerging requirements at any
time. Take DLMS (DLMS Device Language
Message Specification), for example:
Siemens co-developed this new common
9 standard which will be the meter reading
protocol of the future.
Environmental certification
Siemens supplemented the quality man-
agement system with an environmental
10 management system. Siemens Metering
has ISO 14001 certification.
8/2 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Metering
Portfolio
1
Energy Generation
ce Tran
suran spo
rt
eA
s 3
enu
v
Re
Page 8/11
Di
str
ibu
tio
4
n
ng
Power t
Billi
o the
P
oin
t…
Retailer
Customer
… and w
P a y me nt -S
Needs
6
eb
ri n
eters
yst e m
th
g
em
on e y
yM
b a ck
s
i c it
7
ct r
De
El e
ma
nd
Si
eM
rs
e
d
an et
ag t- M
a 8
em He
en t -&
Gas
Energy
Data Acquisition
Page 8/10 Page 8/4
9
10
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 8/3
Metering
Electricity meters
Introduction
For the last hundred years Siemens and
Landis & Gyr have been producing high-
quality electricity meters. In 1971 we were
the first manufacturer in the world to pro-
duce solid-state meters, securing our posi-
tion as market leader in this field as well.
The latest generation of meters sets new
standards in economy and efficiency.
E.g. the Dialog range is already equipped
to communicate with the equipment and
systems of other manufacturers.
Area of Applications
Fig. 2: Landis & Gyr Dialog meter Fig. 3: Ferraris poly-phase meter 7CA54
The meters supports all applicable stand-
ards worldwide and practically all applica-
tions in the field of energy measurement.
Fig. 7 provides an general overview about
electricity meters and their applications.
They are used for residential, commercial,
industrial, transmission and generation
(grid metering) applications.
Requirements
Accurate measuring on its own is not
enough. A forward-looking meter must
be equipped for future modifications and
enhancements. Meter reading is another
major area where energy supply processes
can be considerably simplified. Here, too,
Siemens offer specific solutions for reduc-
ing operating costs.
Fig. 4: Meter for ANSI standards Fig. 5: High precision meter Z.U
Industry ■ ■
Households ■ ■ ■
Payment Systems ■ ■
Fig. 6: Siemens Meters satisfy the various standards around the world.
8/4 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Poly-phase ■ ■ ■ ■
Direct connection ■ ■ ■ 3
Transformer connection ■ ■ ■ ■
Active energy ■ ■ ■ ■
Active+reactive energy ■ ■ ■ 4
Import ■ ■ ■ ■
Import+export ■ ■ ■
IEC 60870 ■ ■ ■ ■
Class 1.0 ■ ■
Class 2.0 ■ ■ ■
8
Additional Prepayment ■ ■ ■
functions
RC Receiver ■ ■ ■
Interfaces Optical ■ ■ ■ 9
CS ■ ■ ■
RS232 ■ ■ ■
RS485 ■ ■ ■ 10
Int. Modem ■ ■ ■
■ = Options
Fig. 7: Overview
Electricity meters – functions and applications
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 8/5
Metering
10
Fig. 8: Ultrasonic Heat Meter Ultraheat 2WR4 Fig. 11: Availability of standard flow tube lengths and flow rates
8/6 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Metering
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 8/7
Metering
1 Measuring, Metering
Managing the energy data ■ Electronic Polyphase Meters
To improve logistics and accounts in a de- ■ Polyphase Ferraris Meters
regulate environment energy data acquisi- ■ Electronic High-Precision Polyphase Measuring metering
tion and processing is used in energy data Meters
2 management system. ■ Multi-functional, electronic polyphase
Local Data Processing and Control meters (series ZMB)
The careful utilization of energy requires
■ Encoders ■ Electromechanical polyphase meters
meticulous acquisition of all relevant data –
(type MM 2000)
and then proper interpretation. Siemens ■ Universal Telemetering Devices
telemetering systems help people in all ■ Electronic combimeters with housings for sur-
■ Metcom Modems
sectors of energy supply and industry to face (type Z.U/Z.W) mounting or chassis for
3 utilize the available energy sparingly and Communication 19" rack mounting
selectively. ■ Communication sets with VFT Channels ■ Hand-held terminal for meter reading and
ripple-control receiver programming
Central Stations and Software
High demands on technology Local data processing/control
■ Landis & Gyr® DG C300/ C2000
4 Metering points form the interface between ■ Encoder (type FBC)
the individual market players. Measuring ■ Universal telemetering device (type FAG)
accuracy and long-term durability are taken ■ Tariff device (type EKM640)
for granted. Logging of load profiles creates ■ Ripple-Control Receiver
the necessary clarity. Depending on the
field of application, whether in the high or ■ METCOM modems
5 medium voltage range or in industry, differ- Communication
ent technologies are required and quality
features are becoming increasingly signifi- ■ Communication sets with VFT channels
cant. and modems
The use of cheap communication channels
6 places high demands on communication
systems. High transfer rates, multiple pro-
tocol capability and compatibility with a va-
riety of media are a must. The data simply
has to be made available for billing and eval- Central station
uation as quickly as possible.
7 ■ DG C300/C500/C2000
10
8/8 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Metering
Z.U/Z.W
Metcom
4
FAG FBC Datacard EKM
Communication
5
System platform
6
EDP 7
10
Fig. 15: High-Precision Polyphase Meters and Univer- Fig. 16: ZMB Polyphase Meters Fig. 17: Central station analyses and displays the col-
sal Telemetering device Landis & Gyr FAG with Metcom Modem lected data in graphic or numeric form
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 8/9
Metering
Payment Systems
1
Payment Systems increase efficiency
and simplify account management.
10
Fig. 21: Cash Power 2000 Fig. 22: Smart Card System
8/10 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Metering
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 8/11
Metering
10
8/12 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Services for 1
Power Transmission 2
and Distribution 3
10
Contents Page
Introduction ....................................... 9/2
From Initial Planning
to Integrated Solutions ................... 9/3
Financial Solutions .......................... 9/3
Service and Training ....................... 9/4
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 9/1
9
Services
10
Fig. 1
9/2 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Services
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 9/3
Services
Service and Training for Expert surveys for economical answers Training for any task
Substations, Switchgear and Whether it be task planning, status evalua- Just as important as good service are good
1 tion or damage analysis, we will be happy operating staff. Only someone who has
System Components – to arrange expert surveys for you at any been properly trained can recognize early
Customized Concepts time. Such results are an important prereq- on the need for service attention, plan it
uisite for economical future planning and properly when it is needed and respond
for skilled repairs or maintenance. correctly to any operational disturbances
2 Every plant, every installation, every system that might occur.
and every product associated with electrici- In order to cover this aspect of demand we
ty supplies can gain in value from skilled Arranging for waste disposal
offer an extensive range of training programs
expert service, whether it be through opti- When installations, plants or parts of them that have been tailored specifically to the
mum availability, long service life, economi- have come to the end of their useful life, needs of our customers. Various courses,
cal operation or fast help in the event of a you will have to dispose of them properly based on theory but practical in nature, are
3 problem. and in an environmentally compatible man- held for small groups of participants.
Whatever the task – we have the experts ner. We will be happy to give you full back-
to deal with it. They are on the spot almost up and take care for arrangements by dis-
immediately after you call and you can rely posal experts. Overall training program
on them to get the job done properly. As well as the actual training itself, we can
4 On-call service and failure analysis also take care of all your training manage-
ment needs. This means the organization
From a single service to total care Our hotline gives you access to immediate and implementation of individual training
You can choose from a truly comprehensive help. One call is enough to get you all the activities as a package including all the as-
range of services. Whether you want a sin- support and backup you need – over the sociated tasks of booking hotels, designing
gle-contract relationship with us or a long- telephone or by specialist staff on-site. programs and looking after participants from
5 term maintenance concept offering optimum the time they arrive to the time they leave.
availability, we have the right one for you.
9/4 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
System Planning
Contents Page
Overall Solutions for
Electrical Power Supply ............. 10/2
10
Ohne Namen-1 1 27.09.1999, 18:04 Uhr
System Planning
Overall Solutions for ■ System design and creative system lay- behavior has to be analyzed or a postfault
out, based on the load center require- clarification done, the System Planning
1 Electrical Power Supply ments and the geographical situation Division, certified to DIN ISO 9001, is com-
■ Component layout, according to tech- petent and has the know-how needed to
nical and economic assumptions and find the right answer. The investigations
Integral power system solutions are far
standards cover all voltage levels, from high voltage
more than just a combination of switch-
■ Operation performance, analyzing and to low voltage, and comprise system stud-
gear, transformers, lines or cables, togeth-
simulation of system behavior under ies for long-distance transmission systems
2 er with equipment for protection, supervi-
normal and fault conditions and urban power networks, as well as for
sion, control, communication and whatever
particular distribution systems in industrial
more. Of crucial importance for the quality ■ Protection design and coordination,
plants and large-scale installations for build-
of power transmission and distribution is matched to the power system.
ing centers. In addition the protection de-
the integration of different components in
sign must be optimized for all transmission
an optimized overall solution in terms of: Siemens System Planning
3 and distribution systems for highest and
Whether a new system has to be planned efficient power quality. In all these tasks,
or an existing system extended or updat- System Planning works in close coopera-
ed, whether normal or abnormal system tion with its customers and other Siemens
Groups (Fig. 1).
10/2 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 10/3
System Planning, a complex activity intended for special load situations, such Protection
as single loads with great fluctuations or
System planning and configuration are The increasing demand from consumers in
1 comparable with architectural work, finding
welding systems.
industry and utility systems and in distribu-
the best technical and economical solution. Medium-voltage systems are primarily tion and transmission networks in terms of
System planning has therefore to start governed in their configuration by the loca- power quality imposes strong requirements
with a thorough task definition and system tions of the system and consumer stations on system protection. Short tripping times,
analysis of the present status, based on to be supplied. high functionality, communication, fault re-
2 the given quality requirements. Alternative The most suitable arrangements for public cording etc. will be provided by state-of-
system concepts (system architecture) supplies are open-ring systems or line sys- the-art numerical relays. To come from pure
in several expansion stages ensure the tems to a remote substation. equipment protection to selective and co-
dynamic development of the system, ordinated system protection, the responsible
For industrial and building power supply
adapted to structure and load requirements staff have to be well trained.
systems, the higher load densities result
of the subposed voltage level. Component
3 in shorter distances between substations.
design and the infeed from the super- To get the fastest tripping schemes with
This leads for reasons of economy to the
posed voltage level have to be considered the highest selectivity, knowledge of the
spot system with radial-operated trans-
as well. Technical calculations and eco- research and development is necessary. For
formers.
nomic investigations complete the plan- the optimization of protection under diffi-
ning work and are essential for the choice Industrial power supplies differ from public cult system conditions, online simulation
of the solution (Fig. 4). networks inasmuch as they have a high like RTDS systems (Real-Time Digital Sys-
4 proportion of motor loads and often inplant tem Simulators) must be available.
Load Development generation. Depending on the capacity,
units will be connected to normal low-volt-
The load analysis and estimation in the Tools
age level, intermediate low-voltage level or
distribution system are always a matter
medium-voltage. Besides great experience and know-how
of distributed loads in a certain area.
5 In urban and rural areas, natural borders – The technically and economically optimal Siemens System Planning applies powerful
such as rivers, railway lines or major roads configuration of distribution systems calls tools to assist the engineers in their highly
and parks or woodlands – allow the whole for wide-ranging practical experience from responsible work.
supply district to be subdivided into a a large number of different projects and
number of subareas. must determine switchgear configuration SINCAL
as well. (Siemens Network Calculation) for analysis
6 In large commercial complexes, such as
airports or university and hospital centers and planning purposes. Any size of system
Transmission with line and cable routing is simulated,
as well as in industrial areas, the load esti-
mation is based on the individual buildings The design of transmission systems is to displayed and evaluated with the SINCAL
and workshops. a great extent individually tailored to the program system. With the help of an inte-
location of generating plants and bulk sub- grated database and easy-to-use graphics
Different methods are used for load esti-
7 mation, such as annual growth rates for
stations feeding the subtransmission sys- system, schematic and topological equiva-
tem. Planning of high-voltage interconnected lent systems can be digitized or converted
existing public areas, load density for new to other systems.
networks and transmission networks is
developing residential areas, installed
a complex matter since they operate over
capacity and simultaneity factor for com- NETOMAC
several different voltage levels and mostly
mercial and industrial supply.
meshed systems are used. This and the (Network Torsion Machine Control) is a
8 Distribution regional and seasonal difference of genera- program for simulation and optimization
tion input and consumer demand as well of electrical systems which consist of net-
Network configuration for power distribu- as the many different sizes of lines, cables work, machines and closed-loop and open-
tion is a matter of visualization and will not and transformers, make load-flow distribu- loop control equipment. Two modes of
be executed successfully without the geo- tion complicated and require detailed calcu- time simulation, instantaneous value mode
graphical information of load and source lations of system behavior and the operat- and stability mode, can be used separately
9 location for public supply and industrial or ing conditions of power generation during or in combination. The program serves for
large building supply as well. Thus, each planning work. As well as the actual plan-
distribution system must be planned indi- ■ Simulation of electromechanical
ning, the work includes numerous investi-
vidually. But, for the basic design, a certain and magnetic phenomena
gations, for instance, to determine the con-
standard configuration has proved optimal figuration of switchgear and various equip- ■ Special load-flow calculations
in terms of ■ Frequency-range analysis
10 ment. This also entails detailed studies of
■ Uncomplicated configuration the reactive power, voltage stability, insu- ■ Analysis of eigenvalues
■ Ease of operation and lation coordination, and testing of the dy- ■ Simulation of torsional systems
■ Economical installation
namic and transient behavior in the net- ■ Parameter identification
work resul-ting from faults. Connection of
Low-voltage systems are usually operated ■ Reduction of passive systems
neighboring transmission systems via AC/
as open radial networks. Industrial systems ■ Optimization
DC coupling, the implementation of HVDC
in particular contain facilities for transfer to transmission or superposing a new volt-
standby. Meshed operation is usually only age level need comprehensive planning
and investigation work (Fig. 5).
10/4 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
DISCHU
Simulation and testing of numerical pro-
Technical standards, Task definitions, Weak point tection relays. 1
Reliability require- System analysis of determination
ments present status Immediate action CTDIM
is a program for protective current trans-
former dimensioning. Main task is techni-
Expansion project cal and economical optimization. 2
Load development PRIMUS
Superposed Subposed voltage level
voltage level Load structure works out the most suitable voltage for
Infeed a DC transmission project together with
System architecture the most important electrical data and
Alternative system the costs.
3
concepts for stages
Protectivecoordination SECOND
Component design Method of neutral
grounding is used to calculate the electrical character-
Technical/economical istics and costs of a given AC transmission
calculations and project. 4
evaluations
FELD
permits calculation of electrical and mag-
Proposal for netic fields which occur during operation
system layout
and fault conditions in the environment of 5
one, two and three-phase systems (e.g.
Fig. 4: Steps for network planning overhead lines and railway lines) in a two-
dimensional way.
LEIKA
Tasks permits calculation of the electrical charac- 6
Load development and teristics of overhead lines and cables.
power plant schedules
TERRA
Voltage steps and
transformer substation is for calculating the potential fields of
sizes grounding installations. 7
Installation type
and configuration KABEIN
Voltage-control is used for calculating the inductive inter-
and reactive-power ference to which telecommunication lines
compensation
and pipelines are subjected by the operat- 8
Load-flow control
and stability criteria ing currents or fault currents of high-volt-
age overhead lines or cables at any levels
Dynamic and
transient behavior of exposure.
System management SUNICO
(normal and faulted)
calculates how to make optimum use of 9
power stations. It indicates the best choice
Existing system from among the available power units and
Planned the best way of dividing up the system load
among the individual units used.
Fig. 5: Planning tasks for interconnected transmission system
HADICA 10
is used for calculating harmonic voltages
DISTAL CUSS and currents in electrical systems.
(Distance Protection Grading) calculates (Computer-Aided Protective Grading) indi-
ACFilt
the setting values of the impedance for cates grading paths and grading diagrams,
the three steps and for the overreach zones checks the interaction of the current-time (Filter-circuit design) is for dealing effi-
(automatic reclosing and signal compari- characteristics with regard to selectivity ciently with harmonic compensation.
son) of distance protection equipment in and generates setting tables for the pro-
any kind of meshed network. tection equipment.
Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition 10/5
3
8 Test Stations 1…6 7 8 Measuring, Protection
and Control
…
4
HVDC/FACTS Protection Custom Power
Since 1996
Fig. 6: Advanced AC/DC Real-Time Simulator facilities – Overview
7
10/6 Siemens Power Engineering Guide · Transmission and Distribution · 4th Edition
Temperature
°F °C 5
9 (ϑF – 32) = ϑC
°F K 5
9
ϑF + 255.37 = T
°C °F 9
5 ϑC + 32 = ϑF
K °F 9
5
ϑ T – 459.67 = ϑF
Note:
Quantity Symbol Unit
Fahrenheit ϑF* °F
temperature
Celsius (Centigrade) ϑC* °C
temperature
Thermodynamic T K
temperature (Kelvin)
* The letter t may be used instead of ϑ